US20150051202A1 - Triazolopyrazine derivatives - Google Patents

Triazolopyrazine derivatives Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20150051202A1
US20150051202A1 US14/382,678 US201314382678A US2015051202A1 US 20150051202 A1 US20150051202 A1 US 20150051202A1 US 201314382678 A US201314382678 A US 201314382678A US 2015051202 A1 US2015051202 A1 US 2015051202A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
triazolo
pyrazin
methyl
phenyl
amine
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US14/382,678
Inventor
Kai Schiemann
Carl Deutsch
Guenter Hoelzemann
Daniel Kuhn
Ansgar Wegener
Dominique Swinnen
Horacio Comas
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Merck Patent GmbH
Original Assignee
Merck Patent GmbH
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Merck Patent GmbH filed Critical Merck Patent GmbH
Assigned to MERCK PATENT GMBH reassignment MERCK PATENT GMBH ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: DEUTSCH, CARL, HOELZEMANN, GUENTER, KUHN, DANIEL, SCHIEMANN, KAI, WEGENER, ANSGAR, COMAS, HORACIO, SWINNEN, DOMINIQUE
Publication of US20150051202A1 publication Critical patent/US20150051202A1/en
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D487/00Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D477/00
    • C07D487/02Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D477/00 in which the condensed system contains two hetero rings
    • C07D487/04Ortho-condensed systems
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/4985Pyrazines or piperazines ortho- or peri-condensed with heterocyclic ring systems
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/535Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with at least one nitrogen and one oxygen as the ring hetero atoms, e.g. 1,2-oxazines
    • A61K31/53751,4-Oxazines, e.g. morpholine
    • A61K31/53771,4-Oxazines, e.g. morpholine not condensed and containing further heterocyclic rings, e.g. timolol
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/04Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system for ulcers, gastritis or reflux esophagitis, e.g. antacids, inhibitors of acid secretion, mucosal protectants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/16Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system for liver or gallbladder disorders, e.g. hepatoprotective agents, cholagogues, litholytics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/18Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system for pancreatic disorders, e.g. pancreatic enzymes
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • A61P11/06Antiasthmatics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P13/00Drugs for disorders of the urinary system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P13/00Drugs for disorders of the urinary system
    • A61P13/08Drugs for disorders of the urinary system of the prostate
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P13/00Drugs for disorders of the urinary system
    • A61P13/10Drugs for disorders of the urinary system of the bladder
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P13/00Drugs for disorders of the urinary system
    • A61P13/12Drugs for disorders of the urinary system of the kidneys
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P15/00Drugs for genital or sexual disorders; Contraceptives
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P17/00Drugs for dermatological disorders
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P17/00Drugs for dermatological disorders
    • A61P17/06Antipsoriatics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P19/00Drugs for skeletal disorders
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P19/00Drugs for skeletal disorders
    • A61P19/02Drugs for skeletal disorders for joint disorders, e.g. arthritis, arthrosis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/14Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating abnormal movements, e.g. chorea, dyskinesia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/28Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating neurodegenerative disorders of the central nervous system, e.g. nootropic agents, cognition enhancers, drugs for treating Alzheimer's disease or other forms of dementia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P29/00Non-central analgesic, antipyretic or antiinflammatory agents, e.g. antirheumatic agents; Non-steroidal antiinflammatory drugs [NSAID]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P3/00Drugs for disorders of the metabolism
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P3/00Drugs for disorders of the metabolism
    • A61P3/08Drugs for disorders of the metabolism for glucose homeostasis
    • A61P3/10Drugs for disorders of the metabolism for glucose homeostasis for hyperglycaemia, e.g. antidiabetics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/04Antibacterial agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/04Antibacterial agents
    • A61P31/06Antibacterial agents for tuberculosis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/04Antibacterial agents
    • A61P31/08Antibacterial agents for leprosy
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • A61P31/14Antivirals for RNA viruses
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • A61P31/14Antivirals for RNA viruses
    • A61P31/18Antivirals for RNA viruses for HIV
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • A61P31/20Antivirals for DNA viruses
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P33/00Antiparasitic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P33/00Antiparasitic agents
    • A61P33/02Antiprotozoals, e.g. for leishmaniasis, trichomoniasis, toxoplasmosis
    • A61P33/06Antimalarials
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • A61P35/02Antineoplastic agents specific for leukemia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • A61P37/06Immunosuppressants, e.g. drugs for graft rejection
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/08Antiallergic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P5/00Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P9/00Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P9/00Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system
    • A61P9/10Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system for treating ischaemic or atherosclerotic diseases, e.g. antianginal drugs, coronary vasodilators, drugs for myocardial infarction, retinopathy, cerebrovascula insufficiency, renal arteriosclerosis
    • YGENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
    • Y02TECHNOLOGIES OR APPLICATIONS FOR MITIGATION OR ADAPTATION AGAINST CLIMATE CHANGE
    • Y02ATECHNOLOGIES FOR ADAPTATION TO CLIMATE CHANGE
    • Y02A50/00TECHNOLOGIES FOR ADAPTATION TO CLIMATE CHANGE in human health protection, e.g. against extreme weather
    • Y02A50/30Against vector-borne diseases, e.g. mosquito-borne, fly-borne, tick-borne or waterborne diseases whose impact is exacerbated by climate change

Definitions

  • the invention had the object of finding novel compounds having valuable properties, in particular those which can be used for the preparation of medicaments.
  • the present invention relates to compounds and to the use of compounds in which the inhibition, regulation and/or modulation of signal transduction by protein kinases, in particular immune-modulatory or stress response kinases, furthermore to pharmaceutical compositions which comprise these compounds, and to the use of the compounds for the treatment of kinase-induced diseases.
  • protein kinases regulate nearly every cellular process, including metabolism, cell proliferation, cell differentiation, and cell survival, they are attractive targets for therapeutic intervention for various disease states.
  • cell-cycle control, immune modulation, stress response and angiogenesis in which protein kinases play a pivotal role are cellular processes associated with numerous disease conditions such as but not limited to cancer, inflammatory diseases, neurodegenerative diseases, chronic infections, abnormal angiogenesis and diseases related thereto, atherosclerosis, macular degeneration, diabetes, obesity, and pain.
  • GCN2 general control nonderepressible 2
  • IDO indoleamine 2,3-dioxygenase
  • ARG arginase I
  • IDO is a single-chain oxidoreductase that catalyzes the degradation of tryptophan to kynurenine. IDO is not responsible for catabolizing excess dietary tryptophan but to modulate tryptophan level in a local environment. Elevations in tryptophan catabolism in cancer patients manifest in significantly altered serum concentration of tryptophan or catabolites and this was correlated to IDO which is commonly elevated in tumors and draining lymph nodes. According to several publications IDO over-expression is associated with poor prognosis in cancer [Okamoto et al 2005; Brandacher et al, 2006].
  • T cells appear to be preferentially sensitive to IDO activation, such that when starved for tryptophan they cannot divide and as a result cannot become activated by an antigen presented to them.
  • Munn and Mellor and their colleagues revealed that IDO modulates immunity by suppressing T-cell activation and by creating peripheral tolerance to tumor antigens (Mellor and Munn, 2004). These mechanism encompass the subversion of immune cells recruited by the tumor cell to its immediate microenvironment or to the tumor-draining lymph nodes Here the tumor antigens that were scavenged by antigen-presenting cells are cross-presented to the adaptive immune system.
  • mature DCs In addition to being directly toleragenic, mature DCs have the capacity to expand regulatory Tcells (Tregs) [Moser 2003].
  • arginine is converted by arginase I (ARG1), arginase II (ARG2) to urea and ornithine and oxidized by the inducible form of nitric oxide synthase (NOS2) to citrulline and nitric oxide (NO).
  • ARG1 arginase I
  • ARG2 arginase II
  • NOS2 nitric oxide synthase
  • ARG activity is frequently observed in patients with colon, breast, lung, and prostate cancer [Cederbaum 2004] correlating with the over-expression of ARG and NOS found in prostate cancers [Keskinege et al. 2001, Aaltoma et al. 2001, Wang et al. 2003]. It was shown that ARG activity in infiltrating macrophages impairs antigen-specific T cell responses and the expression of the CD3 receptor. Moreover the cumulative activity of ARG and NOS in tumor associated myeloid cells can generate inhibitory signals to antigen-specific T lymphocytes that eventually lead to apoptosis [Bronte 2003a; 2003b].
  • GCN2 general control nonderepressible 2
  • ATF4 activating transcription factor 4
  • the cell By expressing the respective stress response proteins, e.g. enzymes in the in amino acid metabolism, the cell tries to compensate the particular cell stress [Wek et al. 2006]. If the stress persists, the same pathway will switch to promoting cell death via transcription of the pro-apoptotic transcription factor, CCAAT/enhancer-binding protein homologous protein (CHOP) [Oyadomari 2004].
  • CCAAT/enhancer-binding protein homologous protein CCAAT/enhancer-binding protein homologous protein (CHOP) [Oyadomari 2004].
  • the GCN2 pathway is not only important for the tumoral immune escape but also plays an active role in modulating tumor survival directly.
  • Ye et al [2010] found that the aforementioned transcription factor ATF4 is over-expressed inhuman solid tumors, suggesting an important function in tumour progression. Amino acid and glucose deprivation are typical stresses found in solid tumours and activated the GCN2 pathway to up-regulate ATF4 target genes involved in amino acid synthesis and transport.
  • GCN2 activation/overexpression and increased phospho-eIF2a were observed in human and mouse tumors compared with normal tissues and abrogation of ATF4 or GCN2 expression significantly inhibited tumor growth in vivo. It was concluded that the GCN2-eIF2a-ATF4 pathway is critical for maintaining metabolic homeostasis in tumor cells.
  • the interference of GCN2 function is here of particular interest as it is a merging point of the two pathways, the IDO and ARG, as well as it provides additional opportunities to impede with the tumor metabolism directly.
  • Orally administered NO aspirin normalized the immune status of tumor-bearing hosts, increased the number and function of tumor-antigen-specific T lymphocytes, and enhanced the preventive and therapeutic effectiveness of the antitumor immunity elicited by cancer vaccination (DeSanto 2005).
  • the substrate analogue 1 methyl-tryptophan (1MT) and related molecules have been used widely to target IDO in the cancer context and other settings.
  • 1MT was unable to elicit tumor regression in several tumor models, suggesting only modest antitumor efficacy when IDO inhibition was applied as a monotherapy.
  • the combinatory treatment with 1MT and a variety of cytotoxic chemotherapeutic agents elicited regression of established MMTV-neu/HER2 tumors, which responded poorly to any single-agent therapy [Muller et al 2005a].
  • the eIF2 kinase GCN2 is activated by interacting with deacylated tRNA that is accumulating as direct consequence of nutritional deprivation stress.
  • Other cellular stress factors like UV irridation, redox stress or proteasome inhibition can induce GCN2 activation indirectly [Wek et al 2006].
  • eIF2a becomes phosphorylated and this induces the specific expression of stress related target genes mainly by cap-independent initiation via the activating transcription factor 4 (ATF4).
  • the autophagy-lysosomal system is discussed as a vital modulator of ⁇ -secretase activity through GCN2, leading to A ⁇ accumulation in autophagy deterioration, which may be a possible therapeutic target for reducing A ⁇ production.
  • ⁇ -Secretase plays an important role in the development of Alzheimer disease (AD).
  • AD Alzheimer disease
  • ⁇ -Secretase activity is enriched in autophagic vacuoles and it augments amyloid- ⁇ (A ⁇ ) synthesis.
  • Senile plaques are primarily composed of ⁇ -amyloid peptides (A ⁇ ) derived from amyloid precursor protein (APP) that has undergone proteolytic processing by ⁇ -secretase (BACE-1) and ⁇ -secretase.
  • a ⁇ ⁇ -amyloid peptides
  • APP amyloid precursor protein
  • BACE-1 ⁇ -secretase
  • IDO indoleamine 2,3 dioxygenase
  • the present invention relates to compounds and to the use of compounds in which the inhibition, regulation and/or modulation of signal transduction by GCN2 plays a role.
  • aim of this invention is the synthesis of new compounds for the prevention and treatment of neoplastic malignancies including, but without being limited to, solid tumor cancers, cancers of the lymphatic or blood system, of neurodegenerative diseases and chronic infections.
  • the compounds of the formula I can furthermore be used for the isolation and investigation of the activity or expression of GCN2. In addition, they are particularly suitable for use in diagnostic methods for diseases in connection with unregulated or disturbed GCN2 activity.
  • Compounds of formula I can also inhibit tyrosine kinases FMS (CSF1R), FLT3 or FLT4 or combinations of these kinases, preferentially in addition to inhibitory activity towards GCN2.
  • FMS tyrosine kinases
  • FLT3 FLT3
  • FLT4 tyrosine kinases
  • Fms-like tyrosine kinase 3 FLT3
  • FLK-2 fetal liver kinase 2
  • STK-I stem cell kinase 1
  • FLT3 receptor kinase is expressed at very high levels on the cells of more than 80% of myelogenous patients and of a fraction of acute lymphoblastic leukemia cells. Furthermore, the enzyme can also be found on cells from patients with chronic myelogenous leukemia in lymphoid blast crisis.
  • FLT3 kinase is mutated in 30% of acute myeloid leukemia (AML) and in a subset of acute lymphoblastic leukemia (ALL) as well (Gilliland et al, Blood 100, 1532-1542 (2002); Stirewalt et al., Nat. Rev. Cancer, 3, 650-665 (2003).
  • Activating mutations in FLT3 mutations have been associated with a poor prognosis (Malempati et al., Blood, 104, 11 (2004).
  • FLT3 inhibitors are being developed and some have shown promising clinical effects against AML (Levis et al Int. J. Hematol, 52, 100-107 (2005).
  • US patent application 20090054358 describes Flt3 inhibitors for immune suppression and in particular for the treatment of immune related disorders like organ rejection, bone marrow transplant rejection, non-myeloablative bone marrow transplant rejection, ankylosing spondylitis, arthritis, aplastic anemia, Behcet's disease, type 1 diabetes mellitus, graft-versus-host disease, Graves' disease, autoimmune hemolytic anemia, Wegener's granulomatosis, hyper IgE syndrome, idiopathic thrombocytopenia purpura, rheumatoid arthritis, Crohn's disease, multiple sclerosis, Myasthenia gravis, psoriasis, and lupus, among other autoimmune diseases.
  • immune related disorders like organ rejection, bone marrow transplant rejection, non-myeloablative bone marrow transplant rejection, ankylosing spondylitis, arthritis, aplastic anemia, Behcet's disease, type 1 diabetes mellitus,
  • Flt3 Inhibitors might also be used to treat neurological disorder as neurodegenerative disease, for example a disease caused by axonal degeneration.
  • Neurodegenerative diseases include, for example, multiple sclerosis; demyelinating core disorders, such as multiple sclerosis, acute transverse myelitis without being limited thereto.
  • CSF-1R is a member of the class III receptor tyrosine kinases.
  • Colony stimulatory factor 1 also known as macrophage/monocyte colony stimulatory factor (M-CSF)
  • M-CSF macrophage/monocyte colony stimulatory factor
  • 1 CSF-1/CSF-1R signaling is essential for normal monocyte development.
  • pro-tumorigenic macrophages have been identified and linked to poor prognosis in breast, ovarian, and prostate cancers.
  • CSF-1 and CSF-1R have been reported in several tumor types, including breast, ovarian, and endometrial cancers, and have also been linked to invasion and metastasis. Inhibition of CSF-1R activity could therefore have multiple effects on the tumor through reduction in the levels of tumor-associated macrophages (TAMs) and have direct effects on the tumor itself (C. E. Lewis, J. W. Pollard, Cancer Res., 66 (2006), p. 605; I. Bingle, N. et al., J. Pathol., 196 (2002), p. 254; B.M. Kacinski, Ann. Med., 27 (1995), p. 79; E. Garwood et al. J Clin Oncol 26: 2008).
  • TAMs tumor-associated macrophages
  • VEGF-C/Flt-4 axis promotes invasion and metastasis of cancer cells.
  • Flt-4 a VEGF receptor
  • the resultant signaling pathway promotes angiogenesis and/or lymphangiogenesis.
  • VEGF-C/Flt-4 axis enhances cancer cell mobility and invasiveness and contributes to the promotion of cancer cell metastasis.
  • Examination of tumor tissues from various types of cancers revealed high levels of Flt-4 and VEGF-C expression that correlated closely with clinical metastasis and patient survival. Inhibition of Flt-4 kinase could reduce the invasive capacity in different types of cancer
  • Combining the inhibitory specificity towards GCN2 with that towards FMS (CSF1R), FLT3 or FLT4 or combinations of these kinases can be of particular advantages for the treatment of neoplastic malignancies at different disease stages. It could combine the effects of stimulating the immune response towards cancer/tumor cells, to reduce the levels of tumor-associated macrophages as well as the invasive capacity of cancers for metastasis formation.
  • the combination of inhibitory activities on GCN2 particularly with inhibition of FLT3 could be advantageous for the treatment of neurodegenerative disorders as it could synergize suppressive effects on inflammatory processes with the modulation of protein deposits generation in the brain.
  • the combination of inhibitory activities on GCN2 particularly with inhibition of FLT3 could provide advantages for modulating the immune response to treat immune related disorders and inflammatory or auto-immune diseases.
  • the present invention specifically relates to compounds of the formula I which inhibit, regulate and/or modulate signal transduction by GCN2, FMS (CSF1R), FLT3 or FLT4 or combinations of these kinases, to compositions which comprise these compounds, and to processes for the use thereof for the treatment of diseases and complaints that are induced or modulated by GCN2, FMS (CSF1R), FLT3 or FLT4 or combinations of these kinases.
  • neoplastic malignancies including, but without being limited to, solid tumor cancers, cancers of the lymphatic or blood system, of neurodegenerative diseases, immune related disorders like arthritis, psoriasis, lupus, multiple sclerosis or other autoimmune diseases as well as chronic infections.
  • the compounds of the formula I can furthermore be used for the isolation and investigation of the activity or expression of Syk, GCN2, FMS (CSF1R), FLT3 or FLT4. In addition, they are particularly suitable for use in diagnostic methods for diseases in connection with unregulated or disturbed Syk, GCN2, FMS (CSF1R), FLT3 or FLT4 activity.
  • the host or patient can belong to any mammalian species, for example a primate species, particularly humans; rodents, including mice, rats and hamsters; rabbits; horses, cows, dogs, cats, etc. Animal models are of interest for experimental investigations, providing a model for treatment of human disease.
  • the susceptibility of a particular cell to treatment with the compounds according to the invention can be determined by in vitro tests.
  • a culture of the cell is combined with a compound according to the invention at various concentrations for a period of time which is sufficient to allow active agents such as anti IgM to induce a cellular response such as expression of a surface marker, usually between about one hour and one week.
  • In vitro testing can be carried out using cultivated cells from blood or from a biopsy sample. The amount of surface marker expressed are assessed by flow cytometry using specific antibodies recognising the marker.
  • the dose varies depending on the specific compound used, the specific disease, the patient status, etc.
  • a therapeutic dose is typically sufficient considerably to reduce the undesired cell population in the target tissue while the viability of the patient is maintained.
  • the treatment is generally continued until a considerable reduction has occurred, for example an at least about 50% reduction in the cell burden, and may be continued until essentially no more undesired cells are detected in the body.
  • Suitable models or model systems for example cell culture models (for example Khwaja et al., EMBO, 1997, 16, 2783-93) and models of transgenic animals (for example White et al., Oncogene, 2001, 20, 7064-7072).
  • interacting compounds can be utilised in order to modulate the signal (for example Stephens et al., Biochemical J., 2000, 351, 95-105).
  • the compounds according to the invention can also be used as reagents for testing kinase-dependent signal transduction pathways in animals and/or cell culture models or in the clinical diseases mentioned in this application.
  • Measurement of the kinase activity is a technique which is well known to the person skilled in the art.
  • Generic test systems for the determination of the kinase activity using substrates for example histone (for example Alessi et al., FEBS Lett. 1996, 399, 3, pages 333-338) or the basic myelin protein, are described in the literature (for example Campos-Gonzalez, R. and Glenney, Jr., J. R. 1992, J. Biol. Chem. 267, page 14535).
  • kinase inhibitors For the identification of kinase inhibitors, various assay systems are available. In scintillation proximity assay (Sorg et al., J. of. Biomolecular Screening, 2002, 7, 11-19) and flashplate assay, the radioactive phosphorylation of a protein or peptide as substrate with ⁇ ATP is measured. In the presence of an inhibitory compound, a decreased radioactive signal, or none at all, is detectable. Furthermore, homogeneous time-resolved fluorescence resonance energy transfer (HTR-FRET) and fluorescence polarisation (FP) technologies are suitable as assay methods (Sills et al., J. of Biomolecular Screening, 2002, 191-214).
  • HTR-FRET time-resolved fluorescence resonance energy transfer
  • FP fluorescence polarisation
  • phospho-ABs phospho-antibodies
  • the phospho-AB binds only the phosphorylated substrate. This binding can be detected by chemiluminescence using a second peroxidase-conjugated anti-sheep antibody (Ross et al., 2002, Biochem. J.).
  • the present invention relates to compounds and to the use of compounds in which the inhibition, regulation and/or modulation of signal transduction by Syk plays a role.
  • mast cells play a critical role in asthma and allergic disorders by releasing pro-inflammatory mediators and cytokines.
  • mediators cause increased vascular permeability, mucus production, bronchoconstriction, tissue degradation and inflammation, thus playing key roles in the etiology and symptoms of asthma and allergic disorders.
  • Syk kinase acts as a central initiator of all subsequent signaling leading to mediator release.
  • the critical role of Syk kinase in the signaling path was demonstrated by the complete inhibition of mediator release by a protein containing the SH2 domains of Syk kinase that functioned as an inhibitor of Syk kinase (J. A. Taylor et al, Molec. and Cell Biol, 15: 4149-4157 (1995)).
  • Syk (Spleen-Tyrosine-Kinase) is a 72 kDa non-receptor tyrosine kinase belonging to the subfamily of intracellular tyrosine kinases that comprises ZAP70, Pyk2, Abl, Tie2, KDR and HER, among others. Syk is a major regulator of FcR (Fc ⁇ RI, II, III, Fc ⁇ RI, Fc ⁇ R) and BCR signaling and is expressed throughout hematopoietic lineage, as well as in fibroblasts, osteoclasts, hepatocytes, epithelial and neuronal cells. In addition to the C terminal kinase domain, SYK exhibits two SH2 domains and over 10 autophosphorylation sites′.
  • SYK is specifically recruited to phosphorylated ITAMs (Immunoreceptor Tyrosine-based Activation Motifs present in immunoreceptors such as Fc ⁇ RI, IIA, IIIA, Fc ⁇ R, Fc ⁇ RI and BCR, expressed by monocytes, macrophages, mast cells, neutrophils and B cells) and specifically mediates immunoreceptor signaling triggered by activation of those receptors in mast cells, B cells, macrophages, monocytes, neutrophils, eosinophils, NK cells, DC cells platelets and osteoclasts 1,2 .
  • ITAMs Immunoreceptor Tyrosine-based Activation Motifs present in immunoreceptors such as Fc ⁇ RI, IIA, IIIA, Fc ⁇ R, Fc ⁇ RI and BCR, expressed by monocytes, macrophages, mast cells, neutrophils and B cells
  • immunoreceptor signaling triggered by activation of those receptors in mast cells, B cells, macrophage
  • tyrosine residues at the ITAM motifs of the cytosolic tail of the Ig ⁇ /Ig ⁇ are phosphorylated by the Src-family kinase Lyn, generating docking sites for SYK that is thus recruited to the BCR immunocomplex.
  • SYK is then phosphorylated and activated by the Src-family kinase Lyn.
  • SYK will phosphorylate the adaptor protein BLNK allowing its interaction with both BTK and PLC ⁇ 2 via their respective SH2 domains.
  • SYK phosphorylated—and thus activated—BTK will in turn phosphorylate and activate PLC ⁇ 2 leading to IP 3 formation, Ca 2+ mobilization, PKC and MAPK activation and consequent NFAT, AP-1 and NF ⁇ B transcription factor activation, resulting in activation and surface marker expression, cytokine release, survival and proliferation of B cells 3 .
  • allergen activated Fc ⁇ RI is phosphorylated by LYN and FYN and recruits SYK which is in turn phosphorylated by LYN and further autophosphorylated, becoming fully activated.
  • SYK Activated SYK phosphorylates the two adaptor molecules NTAL and LAT creating more docking sites for SH2 containing proteins such as PLC ⁇ 1 , vav, and the p85 regulatory subunit of PI3K, resulting in mast cell degranulation and cytokine production 4 .
  • Syk's critical role in signal transduction of mast cells is confirmed by reproducible observation that the 10-15% of basophils (circulating mast cells) from human donors that cannot degranulate have reduced amounts of Syk protein 5,6 .
  • SYK is required for the bone resorption activity of osteoclasts.
  • SYK Upon stimulation of osteoclasts by ⁇ v ⁇ 3 integrin, SYK becomes phosphorylated, most likely by c-Src, in a DAP-12 Fc ⁇ RII dependent mechanism, leading to SPL-76 and Vav3 phosphorylation and subsequent cytoskeletal reorganisation. SYK deficient osteoclasts are inactive and show defective cytoskeletal reorganisation. In correlation with this, SYK deficient embryos show defective skeletal mass 7,8 .
  • BCR-mediated activation of B-cells in the lymph nodes as well as FcR-mediated activation of dendritic cells, monocytes, macrophages, neutrophils and mast cells in the joints, are essential components of the cellular pathophysiological mechanisms taking place during rheumaoid arthritis (RA).
  • RA rheumaoid arthritis
  • activation of osteoclasts leads to the bone and cartilage destruction which are hallmarks of this pathology 9 .
  • SYK signaling should therefore play a pivotal role during the development of arthritis, both at the periphery and on the site of inflammation 10 .
  • Syk inhibitor R406 developed by Rigel—induced a significant improvement of clinical scores and significantly reduced serum cytokine concentrations, as well as bone erosion, in a murine model of RA 11,12 . Moreover, this inhibitor has shown efficacy (ACR scores improvement) and good tolerability in RA Phase II studies in humans 13,14,15 .
  • SLE B cells contribute essentially towards pathogenesis via production of autoanibodies resulting in immune complex formation, stimulation of Fc receptors and finally in an excessive and chronic activation of inflammation.
  • a murine model of SLE treatment with a Syk inhibitor resulted in a reduction of numbers of class-switched germinal center, marginal zone, newly formed and follicular B cells and therefore in disease mitigating effects 18 .
  • TCR signals are transmitted by the intracellular tyrosine kinase ZAP-70 in thymocytes and na ⁇ ve T cells
  • differentiated effector T cells such as those involved in the pathophysiology of Multiple sclerosis (MS) or systemic lupus erythematosus (SLE)
  • MS Multiple sclerosis
  • SLE systemic lupus erythematosus
  • Those studies show that the TCR/CD3/FcRgamma complex in effector cells recruits and activates Syk, instead of ZAP-70, tyrosine kinase.
  • SYK inhibitors may also find a use in asthma, allergy, multiple sclerosis and other diseases such as thrombocytopenia purpura and T or B cell lymphomas 1,10,14,22-35.
  • Treatment of prediseased NZB/W mice with a Syk inhibitor prevented the development of renal disease demonstrated by reduced glomerular sclerosis, tubular damage, proteinuria and BUN levels 18 .
  • B cells In addition to mast cells, Syk is expressed in other hematopoietic cells including B cells, where it is thought to play an essential role in transducing signals required for the transition of immature B cells into mature recirculating B cells (M. Turner et al, Immunology Today, 21: 148 (2000)). B cells are reported to play an important role in some inflammatory conditions such as lupus (0. T. Chan et al., Immunological Rev, 169: 107-121 (1999)) and rheumatoid arthritis (A. Cause et al, Biodrugs, 15(2): 73-79 (2001)).
  • Syk was also reported to be an element of the signaling cascade in beta-amyloid and prion fibrils leading to production of neurotoxic products (C. K. Combs et al., J. Neuroscl, 19: 928-939 (1999)). Furthermore, an inhibitor of Syk blocked the production of these neurotoxic products. Thus furopyridine derivatives would potentially be useful in the treatment of Alzheimer's disease and related neuroinflammatory diseases.
  • Another report (Y. Kuno et al., Blood, 97, 1050-1055 (2001)) demonstrates that Syk plays an important role in malignant progression. A TEL-Syk fusion protein was found to transform hematopoietic cells suggesting a role in the pathogenesis of hematopoietic malignancies. Therefore compounds presently claimed may be useful in the treatment of certain types of cancers.
  • Triazolopyrimidine derivatives are described as GSK3 inhibitors for the treatment of diseases like Alzheimer or diabtes in WO 2005/012307 A1 and in WO 2006/075023 A2.
  • the invention relates to compounds of the formula I
  • Cyc denotes cyclic alkyl with 3-7 C-atoms, which is unsubstituted or monosubstituted by [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p OH or CN,
  • the invention also relates to the optically active forms (stereoisomers), the enantiomers, the racemates, the diastereomers and the hydrates and solvates of these compounds.
  • the invention also relates to the solvates of the salts of the compounds of formula I, e.g. the mono- or dihydrate of the hydrochloride.
  • the invention relates to pharmaceutically acceptable derivatives of compounds of formula I.
  • solvates of the compounds is taken to mean adductions of inert solvent molecules onto the compounds which form owing to their mutual attractive force.
  • Solvates are, for example, mono- or dihydrates or alcoholates.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable derivatives is taken to mean, for example, the salts of the compounds according to the invention and also so-called prodrug compounds.
  • prodrug means a derivative of a compound of formula I that can hydrolyze, oxidize, or otherwise react under biological conditions (in vitro or in vivo) to provide an active compound, particularly a compound of formula I.
  • prodrugs include, but are not limited to, derivatives and metabolites of a compound of formula I that include biohydrolyzable moieties such as biohydrolyzable amides, biohydrolyzable esters, biohydrolyzable carbamates, biohydrolyzable carbonates, biohydrolyzable ureides, and biohydrolyzable phosphate analogues.
  • prodrugs of compounds with carboxyl functional groups are the lower alkyl esters of the carboxylic acid.
  • the carboxylate esters are conveniently formed by esterifying any of the carboxylic acid moieties present on the molecule.
  • Prodrugs can typically be prepared using well-known methods, such as those described by Burger's Medicinal Chemistry and Drug Discovery 6th ed. (Donald J. Abraham ed., 2001, Wiley) and Design and Application of Prodrugs (H. Bundgaard ed., 1985, Harwood Academic Publishers Gmfh).
  • the expression “effective amount” denotes the amount of a medicament or of a pharmaceutical active ingredient which causes in a tissue, system, animal or human a biological or medical response which is sought or desired, for example, by a researcher or physician.
  • terapéuticaally effective amount denotes an amount which, compared with a corresponding subject who has not received this amount, has the following consequence:
  • terapéuticaally effective amount also encompasses the amounts which are effective for increasing normal physiological function.
  • the invention also relates to the use of mixtures of the compounds of the formula I, for example mixtures of two diastereomers, for example in the ratio 1:1, 1:2, 1:3, 1:4, 1:5, 1:10, 1:100 or 1:1000.
  • Tautomers refers to isomeric forms of a compound that are in equilibrium with each other. The concentrations of the isomeric forms will depend on the environment the compound is found in and may be different depending upon, for example, whether the compound is a solid or is in an organic or aqueous solution.
  • the invention relates to the compounds of the formula I and salts thereof and to a process for the preparation of compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically usable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, characterised in that a compound of the formula II
  • a base or acid of the formula I is converted into one of its salts.
  • A denotes alkyl, this is unbranched (linear) or branched, and has 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 or 10 C atoms.
  • A preferably denotes methyl, furthermore ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, isobutyl, sec-butyl or tert-butyl, furthermore also pentyl, 1-, 2- or 3-methylbutyl, 1,1-, 1,2- or 2,2-dimethylpropyl, 1-ethylpropyl, hexyl, 1-, 2-, 3- or 4-methylpentyl, 1,1-, 1,2-, 1,3-, 2,2-, 2,3- or 3,3-dimethylbutyl, 1- or 2-ethylbutyl, 1-ethyl-1-methylpropyl, 1-ethyl-2-methylpropyl, 1,1,2- or 1,2,2-trimethylpropyl, furthermore preferably, for example, trifluoromethyl.
  • A denotes e.g. CH 2 OCH 3 , CH 2 CH 2 OH, OCH 2 CH 2 NH 2 , CH 2 NHCH 2 or NHCH 2 CH 3
  • Cyc preferably denotes cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl or cycloheptyl.
  • A′ preferably denotes methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl or butyl.
  • R 2 preferably denotes furyl, thienyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, thiazolyl, triazolyl or tetrazolyl which is unsubstituted or monosubstituted by A, [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p Cyc, [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p Ar, [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p Het 1 , CN or [C(R3) 2 ] p COOR 3 .
  • R 3 preferably denotes H or alkyl having 1, 2, 3 or 4 C atoms, particularly preferably H or methyl.
  • Ar denotes, for example, o-, m- or p-tolyl, o-, m- or p-ethylphenyl, o-, m- or p-propylphenyl, o-, m- or p-isopropylphenyl, o-, m- or p-tert-butylphenyl, o-, m- or p-hydroxyphenyl, o-, m- or p-nitrophenyl, o-, m- or p-aminophenyl, o-, m- or p-(N-methylamino)phenyl, o-, m- or p-(N-methylaminocarbonyl)phenyl, o-, m- or p-methoxyphenyl, o-, m- or p-ethoxyphenyl, o-, m- or p-ethoxycarbonylphen
  • Ar furthermore preferably denotes phenyl which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, A, Cyc, [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p OA, [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p OH, CN, NHCOHet 1 , NHCOA, NHCO[C(R 3 ) 2 ] p Cyc, CONH[C(R 3 ) 2 ] p Cyc, [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p Het 1 , SO 2 N(R 3 ) 2 , NR 3 SO 2 A, O[C(R 3 ) 2 ] p Het 1 , COHet 1 , and/or S(O) n A.
  • Ar 1 preferably denotes phenyl which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, A, phenyl, CONH 2 , [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p CN, [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p OR 3 and/or [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p Het 1 .
  • Het preferably denotes furyl, thienyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, thiazolyl, triazolyl, tetrazolyl, pyridyl, pyrimidyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazinyl, indolyl, isoindolyl, benzimidazolyl, indazolyl, quinolyl, 1,3-benzodioxolyl, benzothiophenyl, benzofuranyl, imidazopyridyl, dihydroindolyl, 2,3-dihydro-benzo[1,4]dioxinyl or furo[3,2-b]pyridyl which is unsubstituted or mono-, di- or trisubstituted by A, [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p N(
  • Het particularly preferably denotes pyrazolyl, pyridyl, benzimidazolyl, indazolyl, quinolyl or dihydroindolyl which is unsubstituted or mono-, di- or trisubstituted by A, [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p Het 1 , [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p N(R 3 ) 2 and/or ⁇ O.
  • Het 1 preferably denotes dihydropyrrolyl, pyrrolidinyl, azetidinyl, oxetanyl, tetrahydroimidazolyl, dihydropyrazolyl, tetrahydropyrazolyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, dihydropyridyl, tetrahydropyridyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, hexahydropyridazinyl, hexahydropyrimidinyl, [1,3]dioxolanyl, tetrahydropyranyl, pyridyl or piperazinyl, which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by A.
  • Het 1 particularly preferably denotes morpholinyl or piperazinyl, which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by A.
  • Hal preferably denotes F, Cl or Br, but also I, particularly preferably F or Cl.
  • radicals which occur more than once may be identical or different, i.e. are independent of one another.
  • the compounds of the formula I may have one or more chiral centres and can therefore occur in various stereoisomeric forms.
  • the formula I encompasses all these forms.
  • the invention relates, in particular, to the compounds of the formula I in which at least one of the said radicals has one of the preferred meanings indicated above.
  • Some preferred groups of compounds may be expressed by the following sub-formulae Ia to Ie, which conform to the formula I and in which the radicals not designated in greater detail have the meaning indicated for the formula I, but in which
  • Ar denotes phenyl which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, A, Cyc, [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p OA, [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p OH, CN, NHCOHet 1 , NHCOA, NHCO[C(R 3 ) 2 ] p Cyc, CONH[C(R 3 ) 2 ] p Cyc, [C(R 3 ) 2 ] p Het 1 , SO 2 N(R 3 ) 2 , NR 3 SO 2 A, O[C(R 3 ) 2 ] p Het 1 , COHet 1 , and/or S(O) n A,
  • the starting compounds of the formulae II and III are generally known. If they are novel, however, they can be prepared by methods known per se.
  • Compounds of the formula I can preferably be obtained by reacting a compound of the formula II with a compound of the formula III.
  • the reaction is generally carried out under Buchwald-conditions known to the skilled artisan and which are known and suitable for the said reaction.
  • the reaction time is between a few minutes and 14 days
  • the reaction temperature is between about 0° and 140°, normally between 20° and 120°, in particular between about 60° and about 110°.
  • suitable inert solvents are hydrocarbons, such as hexane, petroleum ether, benzene, toluene or xylene; chlorinated hydrocarbons, such as trichloroethylene, 1,2-dichloroethane, carbon tetrachloride, chloroform or dichloromethane; alcohols, such as methanol, ethanol, isopropanol, n-propanol, n-butanol or tert-butanol; ethers, such as diethyl ether, diisopropyl ether, tetrahydrofuran (THF) or dioxane; glycol ethers, such as ethylene glycol monomethyl or monoethyl ether, ethylene glycol dimethyl ether (diglyme); ketones, such as acetone or butanone; amides, such as acetamide, dimethylacetamide or dimethylformamide (DMF); nitriles, such as acet
  • aprotic solvents particularly preferably to THF.
  • Free amino groups can furthermore be acylated in a conventional manner using an acid chloride or anhydride or alkylated using an unsubstituted or substituted alkyl halide, advantageously in an inert solvent, such as dichloromethane or THF, and/or in the presence of a base, such as triethylamine or pyridine, at temperatures between ⁇ 60 and +30°.
  • an inert solvent such as dichloromethane or THF
  • a base such as triethylamine or pyridine
  • the said compounds according to the invention can be used in their final non-salt form.
  • the present invention also encompasses the use of these compounds in the form of their pharmaceutically acceptable salts, which can be derived from various organic and inorganic acids and bases by procedures known in the art.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable salt forms of the compounds of the formula I are for the most part prepared by conventional methods. If the compound of the formula I contains a carboxyl group, one of its suitable salts can be formed by reacting the compound with a suitable base to give the corresponding base-addition salt.
  • Such bases are, for example, alkali metal hydroxides, including potassium hydroxide, sodium hydroxide and lithium hydroxide; alkaline earth metal hydroxides, such as barium hydroxide and calcium hydroxide; alkali metal alkoxides, for example potassium ethoxide and sodium propoxide; and various organic bases, such as piperidine, diethanolamine and N-methylglutamine.
  • alkali metal hydroxides including potassium hydroxide, sodium hydroxide and lithium hydroxide
  • alkaline earth metal hydroxides such as barium hydroxide and calcium hydroxide
  • alkali metal alkoxides for example potassium ethoxide and sodium propoxide
  • organic bases such as piperidine, diethanolamine and N-methylglutamine.
  • the aluminium salts of the compounds of the formula I are likewise included.
  • acid-addition salts can be formed by treating these compounds with pharmaceutically acceptable organic and inorganic acids, for example hydrogen halides, such as hydrogen chloride, hydrogen bromide or hydrogen iodide, other mineral acids and corresponding salts thereof, such as sulfate, nitrate or phosphate and the like, and alkyl- and monoarylsulfonates, such as ethanesulfonate, toluenesulfonate and benzenesulfonate, and other organic acids and corresponding salts thereof, such as acetate, trifluoroacetate, tartrate, maleate, succinate, citrate, benzoate, salicylate, ascorbate and the like.
  • organic and inorganic acids for example hydrogen halides, such as hydrogen chloride, hydrogen bromide or hydrogen iodide, other mineral acids and corresponding salts thereof, such as sulfate, nitrate or phosphate and the like, and alkyl- and monoarylsul
  • pharmaceutically acceptable acid-addition salts of the compounds of the formula I include the following: acetate, adipate, alginate, arginate, aspartate, benzoate, benzenesulfonate (besylate), bisulfate, bisulfite, bromide, butyrate, camphorate, camphorsulfonate, caprylate, chloride, chlorobenzoate, citrate, cyclopentanepropionate, digluconate, dihydrogenphosphate, dinitrobenzoate, dodecylsulfate, ethanesulfonate, fumarate, galacterate (from mucic acid), galacturonate, glucoheptanoate, gluconate, glutamate, glycerophosphate, hemisuccinate, hemisulfate, heptanoate, hexanoate, hippurate, hydrochloride, hydrobromide, hydroiodide, 2-hydroxyethane
  • the base salts of the compounds according to the invention include aluminium, ammonium, calcium, copper, iron(III), iron(II), lithium, magnesium, manganese(III), manganese(II), potassium, sodium and zinc salts, but this is not intended to represent a restriction.
  • Salts of the compounds of the formula I which are derived from pharmaceutically acceptable organic non-toxic bases include salts of primary, secondary and tertiary amines, substituted amines, also including naturally occurring substituted amines, cyclic amines, and basic ion exchanger resins, for example arginine, betaine, caffeine, chloroprocaine, choline, N,N′-dibenzylethylenediamine(benzathine), dicyclohexylamine, diethanolamine, diethylamine, 2-diethylaminoethanol, 2-dimethylaminoethanol, ethanolamine, ethylenediamine, N-ethylmorpholine, N-ethylpiperidine, glucamine, glucosamine, histidine, hydrabamine, isopropylamine, lidocaine, lysine, meglumine, N-methyl-D-glucamine, morpholine, piperazine, piperidine, polyamine resins, procaine
  • Compounds of the present invention which contain basic nitrogen-containing groups can be quaternised using agents such as (C 1 -C 4 )alkyl halides, for example methyl, ethyl, isopropyl and tert-butyl chloride, bromide and iodide; di(C 1 -C 4 )alkyl sulfates, for example dimethyl, diethyl and diamyl sulfate; (C 10 -C 18 )alkyl halides, for example decyl, dodecyl, lauryl, myristyl and stearyl chloride, bromide and iodide; and aryl(C 1 -C 4 )alkyl halides, for example benzyl chloride and phenethyl bromide. Both water- and oil-soluble compounds according to the invention can be prepared using such salts.
  • the above-mentioned pharmaceutical salts which are preferred include acetate, trifluoroacetate, besylate, citrate, fumarate, gluconate, hemisuccinate, hippurate, hydrochloride, hydrobromide, isethionate, mandelate, meglumine, nitrate, oleate, phosphonate, pivalate, sodium phosphate, stearate, sulfate, sulfosalicylate, tartrate, thiomalate, tosylate and tromethamine, but this is not intended to represent a restriction.
  • hydrochloride dihydrochloride, hydrobromide, maleate, mesylate, phosphate, sulfate and succinate.
  • the acid-addition salts of basic compounds of the formula I are prepared by bringing the free base form into contact with a sufficient amount of the desired acid, causing the formation of the salt in a conventional manner.
  • the free base can be regenerated by bringing the salt form into contact with a base and isolating the free base in a conventional manner.
  • the free base forms differ in a certain respect from the corresponding salt forms thereof with respect to certain physical properties, such as solubility in polar solvents; for the purposes of the invention, however, the salts otherwise correspond to the respective free base forms thereof.
  • the pharmaceutically acceptable base-addition salts of the compounds of the formula I are formed with metals or amines, such as alkali metals and alkaline earth metals or organic amines.
  • metals are sodium, potassium, magnesium and calcium.
  • Preferred organic amines are N,N′-dibenzylethylenediamine, chloroprocaine, choline, diethanolamine, ethylenediamine, N-methyl-D-glucamine and procaine.
  • the base-addition salts of acidic compounds according to the invention are prepared by bringing the free acid form into contact with a sufficient amount of the desired base, causing the formation of the salt in a conventional manner.
  • the free acid can be regenerated by bringing the salt form into contact with an acid and isolating the free acid in a conventional manner.
  • the free acid forms differ in a certain respect from the corresponding salt forms thereof with respect to certain physical properties, such as solubility in polar solvents; for the purposes of the invention, however, the salts otherwise correspond to the respective free acid forms thereof.
  • a compound according to the invention contains more than one group which is capable of forming pharmaceutically acceptable salts of this type, the invention also encompasses multiple salts.
  • Typical multiple salt forms include, for example, bitartrate, diacetate, difumarate, dimeglumine, diphosphate, disodium and trihydrochloride, but this is not intended to represent a restriction.
  • the expression “pharmaceutically acceptable salt” in the present connection is taken to mean an active ingredient which comprises a compound of the formula I in the form of one of its salts, in particular if this salt form imparts improved pharmacokinetic properties on the active ingredient compared with the free form of the active ingredient or any other salt form of the active ingredient used earlier.
  • the pharmaceutically acceptable salt form of the active ingredient can also provide this active ingredient for the first time with a desired pharmacokinetic property which it did not have earlier and can even have a positive influence on the pharmacodynamics of this active ingredient with respect to its therapeutic efficacy in the body.
  • a compound of the formula I includes isotope-labelled forms thereof.
  • An isotope-labelled form of a compound of the formula I is identical to this compound apart from the fact that one or more atoms of the compound have been replaced by an atom or atoms having an atomic mass or mass number which differs from the atomic mass or mass number of the atom which usually occurs naturally.
  • isotopes which are readily commercially available and which can be incorporated into a compound of the formula I by well-known methods include isotopes of hydrogen, carbon, nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorus, fluorine and chlorine, for example 2 H, 3 H, 13 C, 14 C, 15 N, 18 O, 17 O, 31 P, 32 P, 35 S, 18 F and 36 Cl, respectively.
  • a compound of the formula I, a prodrug, thereof or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt of either which contains one or more of the above-mentioned isotopes and/or other isotopes of other atoms is intended to be part of the present invention.
  • An isotope-labelled compound of the formula I can be used in a number of beneficial ways.
  • an isotope-labelled compound of the formula I into which, for example, a radioisotope, such as 3 H or 14 C, has been incorporated is suitable for medicament and/or substrate tissue distribution assays.
  • radioisotopes i.e. tritium ( 3 H) and carbon-14 ( 14 C)
  • 3 H tritium
  • 14 C carbon-14
  • Incorporation of heavier isotopes, for example deuterium ( 2 H) into a compound of the formula I has therapeutic advantages owing to the higher metabolic stability of this isotope-labelled compound. Higher metabolic stability translates directly into an increased in vivo half-life or lower dosages, which under most circumstances would represent a preferred embodiment of the present invention.
  • An isotope-labelled compound of the formula I can usually be prepared by carrying out the procedures disclosed in the synthesis schemes and the related description, in the example part and in the preparation part in the present text, replacing a non-isotope-labelled reactant by a readily available isotope-labelled reactant.
  • Deuterium ( 2 H) can also be incorporated into a compound of the formula I for the purpose in order to manipulate the oxidative metabolism of the compound by way of the primary kinetic isotope effect.
  • the primary kinetic isotope effect is a change of the rate for a chemical reaction that results from exchange of isotopic nuclei, which in turn is caused by the change in ground state energies necessary for covalent bond formation after this isotopic exchange.
  • Exchange of a heavier isotope usually results in a lowering of the ground state energy for a chemical bond and thus cause a reduction in the rate in rate-limiting bond breakage. If the bond breakage occurs in or in the vicinity of a saddle-point region along the coordinate of a multi-product reaction, the product distribution ratios can be altered substantially.
  • a compound of the formula I which has multiple potential sites of attack for oxidative metabolism for example benzylic hydrogen atoms and hydrogen atoms bonded to a nitrogen atom, is prepared as a series of analogues in which various combinations of hydrogen atoms are replaced by deuterium atoms, so that some, most or all of these hydrogen atoms have been replaced by deuterium atoms.
  • Half-life determinations enable favourable and accurate determination of the extent of the extent to which the improvement in resistance to oxidative metabolism has improved. In this way, it is deter-mined that the half-life of the parent compound can be extended by up to 100% as the result of deuterium-hydrogen exchange of this type.
  • Deuterium-hydrogen exchange in a compound of the formula I can also be used to achieve a favourable modification of the metabolite spectrum of the starting compound in order to diminish or eliminate undesired toxic metabolites.
  • a toxic metabolite arises through oxidative carbon-hydrogen (C—H) bond cleavage
  • C—H oxidative carbon-hydrogen
  • the deuterated analogue will greatly diminish or eliminate production of the unwanted metabolite, even if the particular oxidation is not a rate-determining step.
  • Further information on the state of the art with respect to deuterium-hydrogen exchange may be found, for example in Hanzlik et al., J. Org. Chem. 55, 3992-3997, 1990, Reider et al., J.
  • the invention furthermore relates to medicaments comprising at least one compound of the formula I and/or pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, and optionally excipients and/or adjuvants.
  • compositions can be administered in the form of dosage units which comprise a predetermined amount of active ingredient per dosage unit.
  • a unit can comprise, for example, 0.5 mg to 1 g, preferably 1 mg to 700 mg, particularly preferably 5 mg to 100 mg, of a compound according to the invention, depending on the condition treated, the method of administration and the age, weight and condition of the patient, or pharmaceutical formulations can be administered in the form of dosage units which comprise a predetermined amount of active ingredient per dosage unit.
  • Preferred dosage unit formulations are those which comprise a daily dose or part-dose, as indicated above, or a corresponding fraction thereof of an active ingredient.
  • pharmaceutical formulations of this type can be prepared using a process which is generally known in the pharmaceutical art.
  • compositions can be adapted for administration via any desired suitable method, for example by oral (including buccal or sublingual), rectal, nasal, topical (including buccal, sublingual or transdermal), vaginal or parenteral (including subcutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous or intradermal) methods.
  • oral including buccal or sublingual
  • rectal nasal
  • topical including buccal, sublingual or transdermal
  • vaginal or parenteral including subcutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous or intradermal
  • parenteral including subcutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous or intradermal
  • compositions adapted for oral administration can be administered as separate units, such as, for example, capsules or tablets; powders or granules; solutions or suspensions in aqueous or non-aqueous liquids; edible foams or foam foods; or oil-in-water liquid emulsions or water-in-oil liquid emulsions.
  • the active-ingredient component in the case of oral administration in the form of a tablet or capsule, can be combined with an oral, non-toxic and pharmaceutically acceptable inert excipient, such as, for example, ethanol, glycerol, water and the like.
  • an oral, non-toxic and pharmaceutically acceptable inert excipient such as, for example, ethanol, glycerol, water and the like.
  • Powders are prepared by comminuting the compound to a suitable fine size and mixing it with a pharmaceutical excipient comminuted in a similar manner, such as, for example, an edible carbohydrate, such as, for example, starch or mannitol.
  • a flavour, preservative, dispersant and dye may likewise be present.
  • Capsules are produced by preparing a powder mixture as described above and filling shaped gelatine shells therewith.
  • Glidants and lubricants such as, for example, highly disperse silicic acid, talc, magnesium stearate, calcium stearate or polyethylene glycol in solid form, can be added to the powder mixture before the filling operation.
  • a disintegrant or solubiliser such as, for example, agar-agar, calcium carbonate or sodium carbonate, may likewise be added in order to improve the availability of the medicament after the capsule has been taken.
  • suitable binders include starch, gelatine, natural sugars, such as, for example, glucose or beta-lactose, sweeteners made from maize, natural and synthetic rubber, such as, for example, acacia, tragacanth or sodium alginate, carboxymethylcellulose, polyethylene glycol, waxes, and the like.
  • the lubricants used in these dosage forms include sodium oleate, sodium stearate, magnesium stearate, sodium benzoate, sodium acetate, sodium chloride and the like.
  • the disintegrants include, without being restricted thereto, starch, methylcellulose, agar, bentonite, xanthan gum and the like.
  • the tablets are formulated by, for example, preparing a powder mixture, granulating or dry-pressing the mixture, adding a lubricant and a disintegrant and pressing the entire mixture to give tablets.
  • a powder mixture is prepared by mixing the compound comminuted in a suitable manner with a diluent or a base, as described above, and optionally with a binder, such as, for example, carboxymethylcellulose, an alginate, gelatine or polyvinylpyrrolidone, a dissolution retardant, such as, for example, paraffin, an absorption accelerator, such as, for example, a quaternary salt, and/or an absorbant, such as, for example, bentonite, kaolin or dicalcium phosphate.
  • a binder such as, for example, carboxymethylcellulose, an alginate, gelatine or polyvinylpyrrolidone
  • a dissolution retardant such as, for example, paraffin
  • an absorption accelerator such as, for example, a quaternary salt
  • an absorbant such as, for example, bentonite, kaolin or dicalcium phosphate.
  • the powder mixture can be granulated by wetting it with a binder, such as, for example, syrup, starch paste, acadia mucilage or solutions of cellulose or polymer materials and pressing it through a sieve.
  • a binder such as, for example, syrup, starch paste, acadia mucilage or solutions of cellulose or polymer materials
  • the powder mixture can be run through a tabletting machine, giving lumps of non-uniform shape, which are broken up to form granules.
  • the granules can be lubricated by addition of stearic acid, a stearate salt, talc or mineral oil in order to prevent sticking to the tablet casting moulds. The lubricated mixture is then pressed to give tablets.
  • the compounds according to the invention can also be combined with a free-flowing inert excipient and then pressed directly to give tablets without carrying out the granulation or dry-pressing steps.
  • a transparent or opaque protective layer consisting of a shellac sealing layer, a layer of sugar or polymer material and a gloss layer of wax may be present. Dyes can be added to these coatings in order to be able to differentiate between different dosage units.
  • Oral liquids such as, for example, solution, syrups and elixirs, can be prepared in the form of dosage units so that a given quantity comprises a pre-specified amount of the compound.
  • Syrups can be prepared by dissolving the compound in an aqueous solution with a suitable flavour, while elixirs are prepared using a non-toxic alcoholic vehicle.
  • Suspensions can be formulated by dispersion of the compound in a non-toxic vehicle.
  • Solubilisers and emulsifiers such as, for example, ethoxylated isostearyl alcohols and polyoxyethylene sorbitol ethers, preservatives, flavour additives, such as, for example, peppermint oil or natural sweeteners or saccharin, or other artificial sweeteners and the like, can likewise be added.
  • the dosage unit formulations for oral administration can, if desired, be encapsulated in microcapsules.
  • the formulation can also be prepared in such a way that the release is extended or retarded, such as, for example, by coating or embedding of particulate material in polymers, wax and the like.
  • the compounds of the formula I and salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof can also be administered in the form of liposome delivery systems, such as, for example, small unilamellar vesicles, large unilamellar vesicles and multilamellar vesicles.
  • liposomes can be formed from various phospholipids, such as, for example, cholesterol, stearylamine or phosphatidylcholines.
  • the compounds of the formula I and the salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof can also be delivered using monoclonal antibodies as individual carriers to which the compound molecules are coupled.
  • the compounds can also be coupled to soluble polymers as targeted medicament carriers.
  • Such polymers may encompass polyvinylpyrrolidone, pyran copolymer, polyhydroxypropylmethacrylamidophenol, polyhydroxyethylaspartamidophenol or polyethylene oxide polylysine, substituted by palmitoyl radicals.
  • the compounds may furthermore be coupled to a class of biodegradable polymers which are suitable for achieving controlled release of a medicament, for example polylactic acid, poly-epsilon-caprolactone, polyhydroxybutyric acid, polyorthoesters, polyacetals, polydihydroxypyrans, polycyanoacrylates and crosslinked or amphipathic block copolymers of hydrogels.
  • a class of biodegradable polymers which are suitable for achieving controlled release of a medicament, for example polylactic acid, poly-epsilon-caprolactone, polyhydroxybutyric acid, polyorthoesters, polyacetals, polydihydroxypyrans, polycyanoacrylates and crosslinked or amphipathic block copolymers of hydrogels.
  • compositions adapted for transdermal administration can be administered as independent plasters for extended, close contact with the epidermis of the recipient.
  • the active ingredient can be delivered from the plaster by iontophoresis, as described in general terms in Pharmaceutical Research, 3(6), 318 (1986).
  • Pharmaceutical compounds adapted for topical administration can be formutated as ointments, creams, suspensions, lotions, powders, solutions, pastes, gels, sprays, aerosols or oils.
  • the formulations are preferably applied as topical ointment or cream.
  • the active ingredient can be employed either with a paraffinic or a water-miscible cream base.
  • the active ingredient can be formulated to give a cream with an oil-in-water cream base or a water-in-oil base.
  • compositions adapted for topical application to the eye include eye drops, in which the active ingredient is dissolved or suspended in a suitable carrier, in particular an aqueous solvent.
  • compositions adapted for topical application in the mouth encompass lozenges, pastilles and mouthwashes.
  • compositions adapted for rectal administration can be administered in the form of suppositories or enemas.
  • compositions adapted for nasal administration in which the carrier substance is a solid comprise a coarse powder having a particle size, for example, in the range 20-500 microns, which is administered in the manner in which snuff is taken, i.e. by rapid inhalation via the nasal passages from a container containing the powder held close to the nose.
  • suitable formulations for administration as nasal spray or nose drops with a liquid as carrier substance encompass active-ingredient solutions in water or oil.
  • compositions adapted for administration by inhalation encompass finely particulate dusts or mists, which can be generated by various types of pressurised dispensers with aerosols, nebulisers or insufflators.
  • compositions adapted for vaginal administration can be administered as pessaries, tampons, creams, gels, pastes, foams or spray formulations.
  • compositions adapted for parenteral administration include aqueous and non-aqueous sterile injection solutions comprising antioxidants, buffers, bacteriostatics and solutes, by means of which the formulation is rendered isotonic with the blood of the recipient to be treated; and aqueous and non-aqueous sterile suspensions, which may comprise suspension media and thickeners.
  • the formulations can be administered in single-dose or multidose containers, for example sealed ampoules and vials, and stored in freeze-dried (lyophilised) state, so that only the addition of the sterile carrier liquid, for example water for injection purposes, immediately before use is necessary.
  • Injection solutions and suspensions prepared in accordance with the recipe can be prepared from sterile powders, granules and tablets.
  • formulations may also comprise other agents usual in the art with respect to the particular type of formulation; thus, for example, formulations which are suitable for oral administration may comprise flavours.
  • a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of the formula I depends on a number of factors, including, for example, the age and weight of the animal, the precise condition that requires treatment, and its severity, the nature of the formulation and the method of administration, and is ultimately determined by the treating doctor or vet.
  • an effective amount of a compound according to the invention is generally in the range from 0.1 to 100 mg/kg of body weight of the recipient (mammal) per day and particularly typically in the range from 1 to 10 mg/kg of body weight per day.
  • the actual amount per day for an adult mammal weighing 70 kg is usually between 70 and 700 mg, where this amount can be administered as a single dose per day or usually in a series of partdoses (such as, for example, two, three, four, five or six) per day, so that the total daily dose is the same.
  • An effective amount of a salt, solvate, tautomer and stereoisomer thereof can be determined as the fraction of the effective amount of the compound according to the invention per se. It can be assumed that similar doses are suitable for the treatment of other conditions mentioned above.
  • the disclosed compounds of the formula I can be administered in combination with other known therapeutic agents including agents for the treatment of RA (rheumatoid arthritis).
  • agents for the treatment of RA relates to any agent which is administered to a patient with RA for the purposes of treating the RA.
  • the medicaments below are preferably, but not exclusively, combined with the compounds of the formula I:
  • NSAIDs non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs
  • analgesics analgesics
  • BRMs Biologic response modifiers
  • a combined treatment of this type can be achieved with the aid of simultaneous, consecutive or separate dispensing of the individual components of the treatment.
  • Combination products of this type employ the compounds according to the invention.
  • the invention furthermore relates to medicaments comprising at least one compound of the formula I and/or pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, and at least one further medicament active ingredient.
  • the invention also relates to a set (kit) consisting of separate packs of
  • the set comprises suitable containers, such as boxes, individual bottles, bags or ampoules.
  • the set may, for example, comprise separate ampoules, each containing an effective amount of a compound of the formula I and/or pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, and an effective amount of a further medicament active ingredient in dissolved or lyophilised form.
  • Treating means an alleviation, in whole or in part, of symptoms associated with a disorder or disease, or slowing, or halting of further progression or worsening of those symptoms, or prevention or prophylaxis of the disease or disorder in a subject at risk for developing the disease or disorder.
  • ⁇ ективное ⁇ ество in connection with a compound of formula (I) can mean an amount capable of alleviating, in whole or in part, symptoms associated with a disorder or disease, or slowing or halting further progression or worsening of those symptoms, or preventing or providing prophylaxis for the disease or disorder in a subject having or at risk for developing a disease disclosed herein, such as inflammatory conditions, immunological conditions, cancer, metabolic conditions, neurodegenerative conditions, chronic infections or conditions treatable or preventable by inhibition of a kinase or a kinase pathway, in one embodiment, the GCN2 pathway.
  • a disease disclosed herein such as inflammatory conditions, immunological conditions, cancer, metabolic conditions, neurodegenerative conditions, chronic infections or conditions treatable or preventable by inhibition of a kinase or a kinase pathway, in one embodiment, the GCN2 pathway.
  • an effective amount of a compound of formula (I) is an amount that inhibits a kinase in a cell, such as, for example, in vitro or in vivo. In some embodiments, the effective amount of the compound of formula (I) inhibits the kinase in a cell by 10%, 20%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 90% or 99%, compared to the activity of the kinase in an untreated cell.
  • the effective amount of the compound of formula (I), for example in a pharmaceutical composition may be at a level that will exercise the desired effect; for example, about 0.005 mg/kg of a subject's body weight to about 10 mg/kg of a subject's body weight in unit dosage for both oral and parenteral administration.
  • the present compounds are suitable as pharmaceutical active ingredients for mammals, especially for humans, in the treatment of immune modulatory and stress response kinase-induced diseases.
  • diseases include neoplastic malignancies including, but without being limited to, solid tumor cancers, cancers of the lymphatic or blood system, the proliferation of tumour cells, pathological neovascularisation (or angiogenesis) which promotes the growth of solid tumours, neurodegenerative diseases (Alzheimer, demyelinating core disorders multiple sclerosis and the like), immune related disorders like arthritis, psoriasis, lupus, or other autoimmune diseases as well as chronic infections.
  • neoplastic malignancies including, but without being limited to, solid tumor cancers, cancers of the lymphatic or blood system, the proliferation of tumour cells, pathological neovascularisation (or angiogenesis) which promotes the growth of solid tumours, neurodegenerative diseases (Alzheimer, demyelinating core disorders multiple sclerosis and the like), immune related disorders like arthritis, ps
  • the present invention encompasses the use of the compounds of the formula I and/or physiologically acceptable salts and solvates thereof for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prevention of cancer.
  • Preferred carcinomas for the treatment originate from the group cerebral carcinoma, urogenital tract carcinoma, carcinoma of the lymphatic system, stomach carcinoma, laryngeal carcinoma and lung carcinoma.
  • a further group of preferred forms of cancer are monocytic leukaemia, lung adenocarcinoma, small-cell lung carcinomas, pancreatic cancer, glioblastomas, melanomas and breast carcinoma.
  • a further group of preferred forms of cancer include, but is not limited to, cervical cancer, neuroblastoma, testicular cancer, macroglobulinemia and sarcomas.
  • Neurodegenerative diseases include, for example, demyelinating core disorders, such as multiple sclerosis, acute transverse myelitis, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis, Creutzfeldt-Jakob disease or Alzheimer disease.
  • Such a disease in which angiogenesis is implicated is an ocular disease, such as retinal vascularisation, diabetic retinopathy, age-induced macular degeneration and the like.
  • the present invention encompasses the use of the compounds of the formula I and/or physiologically acceptable salts and solvates thereof for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prevention of immune related disorder like ankylosing spondylitis, arthritis, aplastic anemia, Behcet's disease, type 1 diabetes mellitus, graft-versus-host disease, Graves' disease, autoimmune hemolytic anemia, Wegener's granulomatosis, hyper IgE syndrome, idiopathic thrombocytopenia purpura, rheumatoid arthritis, Crohn's disease, multiple sclerosis, Myasthenia gravis, psoriasis, and lupus, among other autoimmune diseases. It might also be used treat organ rejection, bone marrow transplant rejection, non-myeloablative bone marrow transplant rejection, enhance bone marrow engraftment after non-myeloablative conditioning regimens, and combinations thereof
  • the therapeutic amount varies according to the specific disease and can be determined by the person skilled in the art without undue effort.
  • the present invention also encompasses the use compounds of the formula I and/or physiologically acceptable salts and solvates thereof for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prevention of retinal vascularisation.
  • immune-modulatory or stress response kinase-induced diseases or conditions refers to pathological conditions that depend on the activity of one or more immune-modulatory or stress response kinases.
  • immune-modulatory or stress response kinases either directly or indirectly participate in the signal transduction pathways of a variety of cellular activities, including proliferation, adhesion and migration and differentiation.
  • Diseases associated with immune-modulatory or stress response kinase activity include neoplastic malignancies (solid tumor cancers, cancers of the lymphatic or blood system and the like), of neurodegenerative diseases, immune related disorders like arthritis, psoriasis, lupus, multiple sclerosis or other autoimmune diseases as well as chronic infections.
  • the present invention specifically relates to compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, for the use for the treatment of diseases in which the inhibition, regulation and/or modulation inhibition of GCN2 plays a role.
  • the present invention specifically relates to compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, for the use for the inhibition of GCN2.
  • the present invention specifically relates to compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, for the use for the treatment of neoplastic malignancies (solid tumor cancers, cancers of the lymphatic or blood system and the like), of neurodegenerative diseases, immune related disorders like arthritis, psoriasis, lupus, multiple sclerosis or other autoimmune diseases as well as chronic infections.
  • neoplastic malignancies solid tumor cancers, cancers of the lymphatic or blood system and the like
  • neurodegenerative diseases like arthritis, psoriasis, lupus, multiple sclerosis or other autoimmune diseases as well as chronic infections.
  • the neoplastic malignancies is preferably selected from the group of tumours of the lung, squamous epithelium, the bladder, the stomach, the kidneys, of head and neck, the oesophagus, the cervix, the thyroid, the intestine, the liver, the brain, the prostate, the urogenital tract, the lymphatic system, the stomach and/or the larynx.
  • the neoplastic malignancies is furthermore preferably selected from the group lung adenocarcinoma, small-cell lung carcinomas, pancreatic cancer, glioblastomas, colon carcinoma and breast carcinoma.
  • the present invention specifically relates to methods for treating or preventing an inflammatory condition, immunological condition, autoimmune condition, allergic condition, rheumatic condition, thrombotic condition, cancer, infection, neurodegenerative disease, neuroinflammatory disease, cardiovascular disease or metabolic condition, comprising administering to a subject in need thereof an effective amount of a compound of formula I or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, tautomer, stereoisomer or solvate thereof.
  • kinase in another aspect provided herein are methods of inhibiting a kinase in a cell expressing said kinase, comprising contacting said cell with an effective amount of a compound of formula I or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, tautomer, stereoisomer or solvate thereof.
  • the kinase is GCN2 or mutants or isoforms thereof, or combinations of two or more thereof.
  • Representative immunological conditions that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, Behcet's syndrome, non-allergy mast cell diseases (e.g., mastocytosis and treatment of anaphylaxis), ankylosing spondylitis, osteoarthritis, rheumatoid arthritis (RA), multiple sclerosis, lupus, inflammatory bowel disease, ulcerative colitis, Crohn's disease, myasthenia gravis, Grave's disease, transplant rejection, humoral transplant rejection, non-humoral transplant rejection, cellular transplant rejection, immune thrombocytopenic purpura (ITP), idiopathic thrombocytopenic purpura, diabetes, immunological response to bacterial, parasitic, helminth infestation or viral infection, eczema, dermatitis, graft versus host disease, Goodpasture's disease, hemolytic disease of the newborn, autoimmune hemolytic anemia, anti-phospholipid syndrome, ANCA-associated vasculitis
  • autoimmune conditions that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, autoimmune hemolytic anemia (A1HA), Behcet's syndrome, Crohn's disease, type I diabetes, Goodpasture's disease, Grave's disease, Hashimoto's thyroiditis, idiopathic thrombocytopenic purpura, lupus, multiple sclerosis, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis, myasthenia gravis, pemphigus vulgaris, primary biliary cirrhosis, rheumatoid arthritis, scleroderma, Sjogren's syndrome, ulcerative colitis, or Wegeners granulomatosus.
  • A1HA autoimmune hemolytic anemia
  • Behcet's syndrome Crohn's disease
  • type I diabetes Goodpasture's disease
  • Grave's disease Hashimoto's thyroiditis
  • idiopathic thrombocytopenic purpura lupus
  • multiple sclerosis amy
  • Representative allergic conditions that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, anaphylaxis, hay fever, allergic conjunctivitis, allergic rhinitis, allergic asthma, atopic dermatitis, eczema, urticaria, mucosal disorders, tissue disorders and certain gastrointestinal disorders.
  • Representative rheumatic conditions that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, rheumatoid arthritis, gout, ankylosing spondylitis, or osteoarthritis.
  • Representative inflammatory conditions that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, non-ANCA (anti-neutrophil cytoplasmic autoantibody) vasculitis (e.g., wherein GCN2 function is associated with neutrophil adhesion, diapedesis and/or activation), psoriasis, asthma, allergic rhinitis, allergic conjunctivitis, chronic urticaria, hives, anaphylaxis, bronchitis, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease, cystic fibrosis, inflammatory bowel disease, irritable bowel syndrome, gout, Crohn's disease, mucous colitis, ulcerative colitis, allergy to intestinal antigens (such as gluten enteropathy), diabetes (e.g., Type I diabetes and Type II diabetes) and obesity.
  • non-ANCA anti-neutrophil cytoplasmic autoantibody
  • vasculitis e.g., wherein GCN2 function is associated with neutrophil adhesion,
  • the inflammatory condition is a dermatologic condition, such as, for example, psoriasis, urticaria, hives, eczema, scleroderma, or dermatitis.
  • the inflammatory condition is an inflammatory pulmonary condition, such as, for example, asthma, bronchitis, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease (COPD), or adult/acute respiratory distress syndrome (ARDS).
  • the inflammatory condition is a gastrointestinal condition, such as, for example, inflammatory bowel disease, ulcerative colitis, Crohn's disease, idiopathic inflammatory bowel disease, irritable bowel syndrome, or spastic colon.
  • Representative infections that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, bacterial, parasitic, prion, viral infections or helminth infestation.
  • cancers that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, cancer of the head, neck, eye, mouth, throat, esophagus, bronchus, larynx, pharynx, chest, bone, lung, colon, rectum, stomach, prostate, urinary bladder, uterine, cervix, breast, ovaries, testicles or other reproductive organs, skin, thyroid, blood, lymph nodes, kidney, liver, pancreas, brain, central nervous system, solid tumors and blood-borne tumors.
  • cardiovascular diseases that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, restenosis, atherosclerosis and its consequences such as stroke, myocardial infarction, ischemic damage to the heart, lung, gut, kidney, liver, pancreas, spleen or brain.
  • Representative metabolic conditions that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, obesity and diabetes (e.g., Type I and II diabetes).
  • methods for the treatment or prevention of insulin resistance include, but are not limited to, obesity and diabetes (e.g., Type I and II diabetes).
  • methods for the treatment or prevention of insulin resistance include, but are not limited to, obesity and diabetes (e.g., Type I and II diabetes).
  • methods for the treatment or prevention of insulin resistance include, but are not limited to, obesity and diabetes (e.g., Type I and II diabetes).
  • methods for the treatment or prevention of insulin resistance e.g., insulin resistance that leads to diabetes (e.g., Type II diabetes).
  • methods for the treatment or prevention of syndrome X or metabolic syndrome include, but are not limited to, obesity and diabetes (e.g., Type I and II diabetes).
  • diabetes insipidus e.g., neurogenic diabetes insipidus, nephrogenic diabetes insipidus, dipsogenic diabetes insipidus, or gestagenic diabetes insipidus
  • diabetes mellitus gestational diabetes mellitus
  • polycystic ovarian syndrome maturity-onset diabetes, juvenile diabetes, insulin-dependant diabetes, non-insulin dependant diabetes, malnutrition-related diabetes, ketosis-prone diabetes, pre-diabetes (e.g., impaired glucose metabolism), cystic fibrosis related diabetes, hemochromatosis and ketosis-resistant diabetes.
  • Representative neurodegenerative and neuroinflammatory diseases that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, Huntington's disease, Alzheimer's disease, viral (e.g., HIV) or bacterial-associated encephalitis and damage.
  • provided herein are methods for the treatment or prevention of fibrotic diseases and disorders.
  • methods for the treatment or prevention of idiopathic pulmonary fibrosis, myelofibrosis, hepatic fibrosis, steatofibrosis and steatohepatitis are provided herein.
  • provided herein are methods for the treatment or prevention of diseases associated with thrombotic events such as but not limited to atherosclerosis, myocardial infarction and ischemic stroke.
  • the present invention specifically relates to compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, for the use for the treatment and/or prevention of inflammatory conditions, immunological conditions, autoimmune conditions, allergic conditions, rheumatic conditions, thrombotic conditions, cancer, infections, neurodegenerative diseases, neuroinflammatory diseases, cardiovascular diseases, and metabolic conditions, the methods comprising administering to a subject in need thereof an effective amount of a compound of claim 1 .
  • the present invention specifically relates to compounds for the use for the treatment and/or prevention of cancer, where the cancer to be treated is a solid tumour or a tumour of the blood and immune system.
  • the present invention specifically relates to compounds, for the use for the treatment and/or prevention of cancer, where the where the tumour originates from the group of acute myeloid leukaemia, chronic myeloid leukaemia, acute lymphatic leukaemia and/or chronic lymphatic leukaemia.
  • the present invention specifically relates to compounds, for the use for the treatment and/or prevention of cancer, where the solid tumour originates from the group of tumours of the epithelium, the bladder, the stomach, the kidneys, of head and neck, the esophagus, the cervix, the thyroid, the intestine, the liver, the brain, the prostate, the uro-genital tract, the lymphatic system, the stomach, the larynx, the bones, including chondosarcoma and Ewing sarcoma, germ cells, including embryonal tissue tumours, and/or the lung, from the group of monocytic leukaemia, lung adenocarcinoma, small-cell lung carcinomas, pancreatic cancer, glioblastomas, neurofibroma, angiosarcoma, breast carcinoma and/or maligna melanoma.
  • the solid tumour originates from the group of tumours of the epithelium, the bladder, the stomach, the kidneys, of head and neck, the es
  • the present invention specifically relates to for the use for the treatment and/or prevention of diseases selected from the group rheumatoid arthritis, systemic lupus, asthma, multiple sclerosis, osteoarthritis, ischemic injury, giant cell arteritis, inflammatory bowel disease, diabetes, cystic fibrosis, psoriasis, Sjögrens syndrom and transplant organ rejection.
  • diseases selected from the group rheumatoid arthritis, systemic lupus, asthma, multiple sclerosis, osteoarthritis, ischemic injury, giant cell arteritis, inflammatory bowel disease, diabetes, cystic fibrosis, psoriasis, Sjögrens syndrom and transplant organ rejection.
  • the present invention specifically relates to compounds for the use for the treatment and/or prevention of diseases selected from the group
  • Alzheimer's disease Down's syndrome, hereditary cerebral hemorrhage with amyloidosis-Dutch Type, cerebral amyloid angiopathy, Creutzfeldt-Jakob disease, frontotemporal dementias, Huntington's disease, Parkinson's disease.
  • the present invention specifically relates to compounds for the use for the treatment and/or prevention of diseases selected from the group
  • leishmania mycobacteria, including M. leprae, M. tuberculosis and/or M. avium, leishmania, plasmodium , human immunodeficiency virus, Epstein Barr virus, Herpes simplex virus, hepatitis C virus.
  • anticancer agent relates to any agent which is administered to a patient with cancer for the purposes of treating the cancer.
  • anti-cancer treatment may be applied as a sole therapy or may involve, in addition to the compound of the invention, conventional surgery or radiotherapy or chemotherapy.
  • chemotherapy may include one or more of the following categories of anti-tumour agents:
  • antiproliferative/antineoplastic/DNA-damaging agents and combinations thereof, as used in medical oncology such as alkylating agents (for example cis-platin, carboplatin, cyclophosphamide, nitrogen mustard, melphalan, chloroambucil, busulphan and nitrosoureas); antimetabolites (for example antifolates such as fluoropyrimidines like 5-fluorouracil and tegafur, raltitrexed, methotrexate, cytosine arabinoside, hydroxyurea and gemcitabine); antitumour antibiotics (for example anthracyclines, like adriamycin, bleomycin, doxorubicin, daunomycin, epirubicin, idarubicin, mitomycin-C, dactinomycin and mithramycin); antimitotic agents (for example vinca alkaloids, like vincristine, vinblastine, vindesine and vin
  • cytostatic agents such as antioestrogens (for example tamoxifen, toremifene, raloxifene, droloxifene and iodoxyfene), oestrogen receptor downregulators (for example fulvestrant), antiandrogens (for example bicalutamide, flutamide, nilutamide and cyproterone acetate), LHRH antagonists or LHRH agonists (for example goserelin, leuprorelin and buserelin), progesterones (for example megestrol acetate), aromatase inhibitors (for example as anastrozole, letrozole, vorazole and exemestane) and inhibitors of 5 ⁇ -reductase, such as finasteride;
  • antioestrogens for example tamoxifen, toremifene, raloxifene, droloxifene and iodoxyfene
  • agents which inhibit cancer cell invasion for example metalloproteinase inhibitors, like marimastat, and inhibitors of urokinase plasminogen activator receptor function;
  • inhibitors of growth factor function include growth factor antibodies, growth factor receptor antibodies (for example the anti-erbb2 antibody trastuzumab [HerceptinTM] and the anti-erbbI antibody cetuximab [C225]), farnesyl transferase inhibitors, tyrosine kinase inhibitors and serine/threonine kinase inhibitors, for example inhibitors of the epidermal growth factor family (for example EGFR family tyrosine kinase inhibitors, such as N -(3-chloro-4-fluorophenyl)-7-methoxy-6-(3-morpholinopropoxy) quinazolin-4-amine (gefitinib, AZD1839), N -(3-ethynylphenyl)-6,7-bis(2-methoxyethoxy)quinazolin-4-amine (erlotinib, OSI-774) and 6-acrylamido- N -
  • antiangiogenic agents such as those which inhibit the effects of vascular endothelial growth factor, (for example the anti-vascular endothelial cell growth factor antibody bevacizumab [AvastinTM], compounds such as those disclosed in published international patent applications WO 97/22596, WO 97/30035, WO 97/32856 and WO 98/13354) and compounds that work by other mechanisms (for example linomide, inhibitors of integrin ⁇ v ⁇ 3 function and angiostatin);
  • vascular endothelial growth factor for example the anti-vascular endothelial cell growth factor antibody bevacizumab [AvastinTM]
  • vastinTM anti-vascular endothelial cell growth factor antibody bevacizumab
  • compounds that work by other mechanisms for example linomide, inhibitors of integrin ⁇ v ⁇ 3 function and angiostatin
  • vessel-damaging agents such as combretastatin A4 and compounds disclosed in international patent applications WO 99/02166, WO 00/40529, WO 00/41669, WO 01/92224, WO 02/04434 and WO 02/08213;
  • antisense therapies for example those which are directed to the targets listed above, such as ISIS 2503, an anti-Ras antisense;
  • gene therapy approaches including, for example, approaches for replacement of aberrant genes, such as aberrant p53 or aberrant BRCA1 or BRCA2, GDEPT (gene-directed enzyme pro-drug therapy) approaches, such as those using cytosine deaminase, thymidine kinase or a bacterial nitroreductase enzyme, and approaches for increasing patient tolerance to chemotherapy or radiotherapy, such as multi-drug resistance gene therapy; and
  • immunotherapy approaches including, for example, ex-vivo and in-vivo approaches for increasing the immunogenicity of patient tumour cells, such as transfection with cytokines, such as interleukin 2, interleukin 4 or granulocyte-macrophage colony stimulating factor, approaches for decreasing T-cell anergy, approaches using transfected immune cells, such as cytokine-transfected dendritic cells, approaches using cytokine-transfected tumour cell lines, and approaches using anti-idiotypic antibodies.
  • cytokines such as interleukin 2, interleukin 4 or granulocyte-macrophage colony stimulating factor
  • the medicaments from Table 1 below are preferably, but not exclusively, combined with the compounds of the formula I.
  • the disclosed compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically acceptable solvates, salts, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, preferably can be administered in combination with immunmodulators, preferably with anti-PDL-1- or IL-12.
  • the present invention relates to compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, for the use for the inhibition of Syk.
  • the present invention specifically relates to compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, for the use for the treatment of rheumatoid arthritis, systemic lupus, asthma, allergic rhinitis, ITP, multiple sclerosis, leukemia, breast cancer, maligna melanoma.
  • the present invention specifically relates to methods for treating or preventing an inflammatory condition, immunological condition, autoimmune condition, allergic condition, rheumatic condition, thrombotic condition, cancer, infection, neurodegenerative disease, neuroinflammatory disease, cardiovascular disease or metabolic condition, comprising administering to a subject in need thereof an effective amount of a compound of formula I or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, tautomer, stereoisomer or solvate thereof.
  • This assay can quantificate the activity of the serin kinase GCN2 (general control non-derepressible-2).
  • This kinase is involved in the stress metabolism of cells. It is activated upon starvation (amino acid depletion). Its natural substrate is eIF2a (eukaryotic initiation factor 2 alpha subunit), a translation factor, which gets activated (phosphorylated) by GCN2 in case of an amino acid bottleneck in the cells. This in turn leads to a halt of the protein synthesis. Inhibition of GCN2 results in stopping this mechanism: The cell can not stop protein production upon “starvation” stress.
  • eIF2a eukaryotic initiation factor 2 alpha subunit
  • the assay is run in two steps: the enzymatic reaction and the detection step.
  • GCN2 is incubated with 10 ⁇ M ATP and 80 nM of the GFP-labelled substrate eIF2alpha at room temperature.
  • TR-FRET Lanthascreen
  • Human U2OS cells (2000 cells/well) are seeded into 384-well plates and incubated for 20 hours.
  • the cells are treated with the test compounds and incubated for 2 hours. Then, tryptophanol, at a final concentration of 600 ⁇ M, is added to the cells and those are incubated for 30 minutes.
  • the analysis and quantification of phosphorylated GCN2 is done by scanning the plates in the Acumen Explorer system (TTPLabtech). The obtained data are normalised against the untreated control wells (DMSO only) and expressed as % effect values. The determination of IC 50 values is done by using the Graph Pad Prism software.
  • the kinase assay is performed either as 384-well Flashplate assay (for e.g. Topcount measurement) or as 384-well Image-Flashplate assay (for LEADseeker measurement).
  • Radioactivity is measured with Topcount (when using Flashplates) or with LEADseeker (when using Image-Flashplates) respectively.
  • Results e.g. IC50-values
  • program tools provided by the IT-department (e.g. Symyx Assay Explorer, Genedata Screener).
  • the assays described here are performed on the Caliper Life Sciences LC3000 system This technology provides data on enzyme activity via measurement of the relative amounts of phosphorylated or unphosphorylated fluorescently labelled substrate peptide at the end of an enzymatic reaction.
  • a TTP Mosquito liquid handling instrument is used to place 0.25 ul of the appropriate concentration of inhibitor in 100% DMSO (for a dose response curve calculation) into each well of a 384-well plate. To this reaction components are added to a final volume of 25 ul.
  • Standard components are 1 mM DTT (Sigma, D0632), 1 mM MgCl2 (Sigma, M1028), 100 mM HEPES pH 7.5 (Calbiochem, 391338), 0.015% Brij-35 (Sigma, B4184).
  • Stop buffer 100 mM HEPES pH 7.5, 0.015% Brij-35, 10 mM EDTA (Sigma, E7889)
  • the plate is read on a Caliper LC 3000 in an Off-Chip mobility shift assay format, on a 12-sipper chip. Unphosphorylated substrate and phosphorylated product peptide resolve as separate peaks allowing direct measurement of percentage of conversion of substrate to product. The percent conversion can be plotted against concentration of inhibitor to produce a sigmoidal dose response curve, from which an IC50 can be calculated using GeneData Condoseo or a similar product.
  • Ramos cells incubated overnight in IMDM medium containing 5% FCS were resuspended in IMDM medium without serum (3.3 ⁇ 10 6 cells/nil).
  • 90 ⁇ l of cell suspension 300,000 cells
  • 10 ⁇ l of SYK inhibitors in 3% DMSO
  • cells were activated with 10 ⁇ g/ml of goat antihuman anti-IgM for 10 minutes at 37° C.
  • cells were fixed by addition of 80 ⁇ l of 4% paraformaldehyde followed by a 10 minutes incubation at RT and fixed in 0.1% Triton X-100 in PBS.
  • BLNK phosphorylation was detected by flow cytometry after staining of the cells with anti-BLNK-pY84-PE antibodies from BD pharmingen, for 45 minutes at RT.
  • BLNK phosphorylation in CD19 + peripheral blood mononuclear cells (PBMC) isolated from buffy coats of healthy volunteers was performed using the same protocol and staining the cells with a mixture of anti-BLNK-pY84-PE, anti CD-19 PerCp and Anti-IgM APC antibodies from BD Pharmingen.
  • PBMC peripheral blood mononuclear cells
  • mice For induction of collagen-induced arthritis (CIA) male DBA/1 mice are injected with 500 ⁇ l pristane i.p. on day—21. On day 0 mice are immunized with 100 ⁇ g chicken collagen type II (CII) in Complete Freund's Adjuvant (CFA) intradermally, distributed over pinnae and one site on the back on day 0. On day 21, mice will receive an i.p. booster immunization (100 ⁇ g) with soluble CII in PBS. Dosing of Syk inhibitor will be prophylactic: starting day 0 and continued until day 10 and before boost starting on day 20 and continued until day 30. Compounds will be administered orally twice a day at doses of 3, 10 and 30 mg/kg.
  • CII chicken collagen type II
  • CFA Complete Freund's Adjuvant
  • Body weight and clinical score will be recorded on a daily basis. Arthritis severity is graded using a clinical scoring system based on the assessment of inflammation in individual paws. The scale for this clinical score ranges from 0-4 for each individual paw.
  • G6PI Glucose-6-phosphate isomerase-induced arthritis
  • CFA Complete Freund's Adjuvant
  • Body weight and clinical score will be recorded on a daily basis. Arthritis severity is graded using a clinical scoring system based on the assessment of inflammation in individual paws. The scale for this clinical score ranges from 0-4 for each individual paw.
  • “conventional work-up” means: water is added if necessary, the pH is adjusted, if necessary, to values between 2 and 10, depending on the constitution of the end product, the mixture is extracted with ethyl acetate or dichloromethane, the phases are separated, the organic phase is dried over sodium sulfate and evaporated, and the residue is purified by chromatography on silica gel and/or by crystallisation. Rf values on silica gel; eluent: ethyl acetate/methanol 9:1.
  • reaction mixture After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 75 mL), the filtrate is concentrated to get the crude product.
  • the crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, MEOH/DCM gradient elution); yield: 42% (1.3 g, yellow solid);
  • reaction mixture is filtered through celite washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 50 mL), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by flash column chromatography (silica gel, MEOH/DCM gradient elution); yield: 5% (7.7 mg, light brown solid);
  • the reaction mixture is concentrated at high vacuum, the residue is taken in ethylacetate (75 mL), washed with water (2 ⁇ 75 mL), brine, dried over MgSO 4 and concentrated to get the crude product.
  • the crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, EA/PE gradient elution); yield: 80% (4.7 g, light orange solid);
  • the reaction mixture is concentrated at high vacuum, the residue is taken in ethylacetate (30 mL), washed with water (2 ⁇ 30 mL), brine, dried over MgSO 4 and concentrated to get the crude product.
  • the crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, EA/PE gradient elution); yield: 91% (0.8 g, brown oil);
  • reaction mixture After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is quenched with cold water and concentrated at high vacuum, the residue is taken in ethylacetate, washed with water (2 ⁇ 25 mL), brine (1 ⁇ 25 mL), dried over MgSO 4 and concentrated to get the crude product.
  • the crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, MeOH/DCM gradient elution) to get the mixture of regioisomers;
  • the compound is prepared analogously to “A1”;
  • reaction mixture is concentrated and the residue is taken in dichloromethane (15 mL), washed with aqueous NaHCO 3 (20%, 15 mL), water (1 ⁇ 15 mL), brine (1 ⁇ 15 mL), dried over MgSO 4 and concentrated to get the crude product.
  • the crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, MeOH/DCM gradient elution);
  • reaction mixture After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 75 mL), the filtrate is concentrated to get the crude product.
  • the crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, MEOH/DCM gradient elution);
  • the compound is prepared analogously to “A1”;
  • the compound is prepared analogously to “A1”;
  • the compound is prepared analogously to “A6”;
  • the compound is prepared analogously to “A1”;
  • the compound is prepared analogously to “A6”;
  • the compound is prepared analogously to “A1”;
  • N-(t-butoxy carbonyl)-O-(mesitylsulfonyl)-hydroxylamine 2.1 g, 0.0066 mol
  • trifluoroacetic acid 20 ml
  • water 60 mL
  • the precipitate is filtered and washed several times with water until the pH of the filtrate is neutral.
  • the white solid 1. g, 98%) is dried in the Buchner funnel and used immediately for the next reaction.
  • the reaction mixture is concentrated and diluted with 50% dichloromethane in methanol and passed through celite, the filtrate is concentrated.
  • the crude product is purified by column using silica gel(60-120) mesh to get the product as off white solid(0.052 g, 50.9%);
  • reaction mixture is passed through celite and washed with 30% methanol in dichloromethane (20 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by column chromatography using silica gel (230-400) mesh to get the product as off white solid (0.144 g, 43.8%);
  • reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as off white solid (0.09 g, 96.77%);
  • reaction mixture is filtered through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 10 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.05 g, 37.59%);
  • reaction mixture is concentrated and the crude mass is taken in water (15 ml), neutralized with Na 2 CO 3 and adjusted to pH-8, extracted with dichloromethane, dried over anhydrous MgSO 4 , concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.004 g, 16.66%);
  • reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.25 g, 49.61%);
  • reaction mixture is filtered through celite washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 10 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.017 g, 21.6%);
  • reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.51 g, 59.44%); TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) R f —0.2;
  • reaction mixture is filtered through celite washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 10 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as orange solid (0.024 g, 16.62%);
  • reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.63 g, 69.28%); TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) R f —0.2;
  • reaction mixture is filtered through celite washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 10 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.04 g, 25.39%); TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) R f —0.3;
  • reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.51 g, 75.44%);
  • reaction mixture is concentrated and the crude mass is taken in water and filtered, washed with water, cold acetonitrile and diethylether to get the product as pale yellow solid (0.05 g, 8%); TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) R f —0.2;
  • reaction mixture is filtered through celite washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 10 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.012 g, 13.8%); TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) R f —0.3;
  • reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.3 g, 63.02%);
  • reaction mixture is filtered through celite washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 10 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.009 g, 11.76%);
  • reaction mixture After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 75 mL), the filtrate is concentrated to get the crude product.
  • the crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, MEOH/DCM gradient elution); yield: 42% (1.3 g, yellow solid);
  • reaction mixture After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 ml), the filtrate is concentrated to get the crude product.
  • the crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, PE/EA gradient elution); yield: 69% (0.63 g, yellow solid);

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Oncology (AREA)
  • Communicable Diseases (AREA)
  • Virology (AREA)
  • Urology & Nephrology (AREA)
  • Diabetes (AREA)
  • Pulmonology (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Tropical Medicine & Parasitology (AREA)
  • Neurosurgery (AREA)
  • Neurology (AREA)
  • Biomedical Technology (AREA)
  • Molecular Biology (AREA)
  • Hematology (AREA)
  • Endocrinology (AREA)
  • Cardiology (AREA)
  • Physical Education & Sports Medicine (AREA)
  • Dermatology (AREA)
  • Heart & Thoracic Surgery (AREA)
  • Rheumatology (AREA)
  • Obesity (AREA)
  • Biotechnology (AREA)
  • Gastroenterology & Hepatology (AREA)
  • Psychology (AREA)
  • Pain & Pain Management (AREA)

Abstract

Compounds of the formula I
Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00001
in which R1, R2 and R4 have the meanings indicated in Claim 1,
are inhibitors of GCN2, and can be employed, inter alia, for the treatment of cancer.

Description

    BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
  • The invention had the object of finding novel compounds having valuable properties, in particular those which can be used for the preparation of medicaments.
  • The present invention relates to compounds and to the use of compounds in which the inhibition, regulation and/or modulation of signal transduction by protein kinases, in particular immune-modulatory or stress response kinases, furthermore to pharmaceutical compositions which comprise these compounds, and to the use of the compounds for the treatment of kinase-induced diseases.
  • Because protein kinases regulate nearly every cellular process, including metabolism, cell proliferation, cell differentiation, and cell survival, they are attractive targets for therapeutic intervention for various disease states. For example, cell-cycle control, immune modulation, stress response and angiogenesis, in which protein kinases play a pivotal role are cellular processes associated with numerous disease conditions such as but not limited to cancer, inflammatory diseases, neurodegenerative diseases, chronic infections, abnormal angiogenesis and diseases related thereto, atherosclerosis, macular degeneration, diabetes, obesity, and pain.
  • Compounds of formula I inhibit the stress response eIF2 kinase EIF2AK4 called general control nonderepressible 2 (GCN2).
  • Many strategies of cancer treatment of solid tumors focus on the surgically removal of the tumor mass as far as possible and the subsequent eradication of any residual tumor cells by radiotherapy and chemotherapy with cytotoxic agents or inhibitors that target cancer cell pathways more specifically. However, the success of such approach is limited and often does not persist. This is mainly due to the narrow therapeutic window for such cytotoxic agents (specificity and side effects) and to the capability of cancer calls to adapt to the selective pressure applied by cytotoxic or other inhibitory agents. The survival of a small number of tumor (stem) cells that acquired resistance to the initial treatment can be sufficient to seed the regrowth of a tumor. These relapses are in most cases more difficult to treat compared to that of the initial tumors. As a consequence the more successful targeting of tumor cells may require targeting multiple survival and escape mechanism of tumor cells in parallel (Muller & Prendegast 2007).
  • Development of malignancies is accompanied by a major roll up of the cellular physiology. During this process several qualities are acquired by the cancer cells that are basis for immortalization or insensitivity to growth inhibitory signals. In addition the tumor cells also modify the interaction with the microenvironment and beyond. The latter area includes the strategies of tumor cells to escape from the immunological surveillance (Muller & Prendegast 2007). The immune surveillance limits malignant growth but also provides a selective pressure triggering the evolution of mechanisms for evading the immune response as reviewed by [Dunn et al. 2004]. Essentially it has been frequently observed that ablation of T cell immunity is sufficient to increase tumor incidence [Shankaran et al. 2001] and it is believed that immune escape is affecting tumor dormancy versus progression, promoting invasion and metastasis and negatively impacts on therapeutic response.
  • Several mechanistic studies discovered that immune escape has an important interface with metabolic alterations within the tumor microenvironment. Here important roles in mediating immune tolerance to antigens have been associated to the catabolism of the essential amino acids tryptophan and arginine, carried out by the enzymes indoleamine 2,3-dioxygenase (IDO) and arginase I (ARG), respectively (Bronte and Zanovello, 2005; Muller et al., 2005b; Muller and Prendergast, 2007; Munn and Mellor, 2007; Popovic et al., 2007).
  • IDO is a single-chain oxidoreductase that catalyzes the degradation of tryptophan to kynurenine. IDO is not responsible for catabolizing excess dietary tryptophan but to modulate tryptophan level in a local environment. Elevations in tryptophan catabolism in cancer patients manifest in significantly altered serum concentration of tryptophan or catabolites and this was correlated to IDO which is commonly elevated in tumors and draining lymph nodes. According to several publications IDO over-expression is associated with poor prognosis in cancer [Okamoto et al 2005; Brandacher et al, 2006].
  • T cells appear to be preferentially sensitive to IDO activation, such that when starved for tryptophan they cannot divide and as a result cannot become activated by an antigen presented to them. Munn and Mellor and their colleagues, revealed that IDO modulates immunity by suppressing T-cell activation and by creating peripheral tolerance to tumor antigens (Mellor and Munn, 2004). These mechanism encompass the subversion of immune cells recruited by the tumor cell to its immediate microenvironment or to the tumor-draining lymph nodes Here the tumor antigens that were scavenged by antigen-presenting cells are cross-presented to the adaptive immune system. In addition to being directly toleragenic, mature DCs have the capacity to expand regulatory Tcells (Tregs) [Moser 2003].
  • Beside tryptophan catabolism the conversion of arginine is increased in a tumor-conditioned microenvironment, and numerous reports indicate a role for the activation of arginases during tumor growth and development. In tumor-infiltrating myeloid cells, arginine is converted by arginase I (ARG1), arginase II (ARG2) to urea and ornithine and oxidized by the inducible form of nitric oxide synthase (NOS2) to citrulline and nitric oxide (NO).
  • Increased ARG activity is frequently observed in patients with colon, breast, lung, and prostate cancer [Cederbaum 2004] correlating with the over-expression of ARG and NOS found in prostate cancers [Keskinege et al. 2001, Aaltoma et al. 2001, Wang et al. 2003]. It was shown that ARG activity in infiltrating macrophages impairs antigen-specific T cell responses and the expression of the CD3 receptor. Moreover the cumulative activity of ARG and NOS in tumor associated myeloid cells can generate inhibitory signals to antigen-specific T lymphocytes that eventually lead to apoptosis [Bronte 2003a; 2003b]. Both, the IDO and the ARG related mechanism merge at the point of sensing the depleted concentration of the respective amino acid concentration. During amino acid deprivation, the eIF2 kinase EIF2AK4 called general control nonderepressible 2 (GCN2) is interacting with the intracellular accumulating deacylated tRNA. As a consequence the GCN2 is assumed to change from an auto-inhibited to an active conformation and further activate by auto-phosphorylation. Then the only known substrate protein eIF2a becomes phosphorylated and as a consequence the complex for translation initiation is inhibited [Harding et al. 2000,]. This diminishes the general Cap-dependent translation initiation and by this the corresponding protein production. On the other hand this induces the specific expression of stress related target genes mainly by cap-independent initiation via the activating transcription factor 4 (ATF4). By expressing the respective stress response proteins, e.g. enzymes in the in amino acid metabolism, the cell tries to compensate the particular cell stress [Wek et al. 2006]. If the stress persists, the same pathway will switch to promoting cell death via transcription of the pro-apoptotic transcription factor, CCAAT/enhancer-binding protein homologous protein (CHOP) [Oyadomari 2004]. It was shown that, tryptophan starvation triggers a GCN2-dependent stress signaling pathway In T cells altering eIF2aphosphorylation and translational initiation leading to a cell growth arrest (Munn et al. 2005). Sharma, et al. [2007] published on the direct IDO-induced and GCN2-dependent activation of mature Tregs. Similarly Fallarino et al[2006] found a GCN2-dependent conversion of CD4+CD25-cells to CD25+FoxP3+ Tregs producing IL-10 and TGFβ. Rodriguez et al. [2007] identified that activation of the GCN2 pathway via tryptophan or arginine depletion in combination with TCR signaling leads to CD3ζ chain down regulation, cell cycle arrest and anergy.
  • Importantly the GCN2 pathway is not only important for the tumoral immune escape but also plays an active role in modulating tumor survival directly. Ye et al [2010] found that the aforementioned transcription factor ATF4 is over-expressed inhuman solid tumors, suggesting an important function in tumour progression. Amino acid and glucose deprivation are typical stresses found in solid tumours and activated the GCN2 pathway to up-regulate ATF4 target genes involved in amino acid synthesis and transport. GCN2 activation/overexpression and increased phospho-eIF2a were observed in human and mouse tumors compared with normal tissues and abrogation of ATF4 or GCN2 expression significantly inhibited tumor growth in vivo. It was concluded that the GCN2-eIF2a-ATF4 pathway is critical for maintaining metabolic homeostasis in tumor cells.
  • Over all the present biology makes an interference with the ARG/IDO pathway attractive for braking up the tumoral immune escape by adaptive mechanism. The interference of GCN2 function is here of particular interest as it is a merging point of the two pathways, the IDO and ARG, as well as it provides additional opportunities to impede with the tumor metabolism directly.
  • Several pathway inhibitors are already considered as immune modulators. These inhibitors address mainly the enzymatic function of the IDO or ARG proteins (Muller and Scherle, 2006). The application of the arginase inhibitor, N-hydroxy-nor-L-Arg blocks growth of s.c. 3 LL lung carcinoma in mice [Rodriguez 2004]. The NO-donating aspirins like NCX 4016 (2-(acetyloxy)benzoic acid 3-(nitrooxymethyl) phenyl ester) have been reported to interfere with the inhibitory enzymatic activities of myeloid cells. Orally administered NO aspirin normalized the immune status of tumor-bearing hosts, increased the number and function of tumor-antigen-specific T lymphocytes, and enhanced the preventive and therapeutic effectiveness of the antitumor immunity elicited by cancer vaccination (DeSanto 2005).
  • The substrate analogue 1 methyl-tryptophan (1MT) and related molecules have been used widely to target IDO in the cancer context and other settings. Studies by Friberg et al. (2002) and Uyttenhove et al. (2003) demonstrated that 1MT can limit the growth of tumors over-expressing IDO. However 1MT was unable to elicit tumor regression in several tumor models, suggesting only modest antitumor efficacy when IDO inhibition was applied as a monotherapy. In contrast, the combinatory treatment with 1MT and a variety of cytotoxic chemotherapeutic agents elicited regression of established MMTV-neu/HER2 tumors, which responded poorly to any single-agent therapy [Muller et al 2005a]. Immunodepletion of CD4+ or CD8+ T cells from the mice, before treatment abolished the combinatorial efficacy observed in this model, confirming the expectation that 1MT acted indirectly through activation of T cell-mediated antitumor immunity. Important evidence that IDO targeting is essential to 1MT action was provided by the demonstration that 1MT lacks antitumor activity in mice that are genetically deficient for IDO [Hou et al., 2007] The inhibition of GCN2 would enable to combine the two pathway branches of amino acid starvation induced immunoediting and would reduce the options for the tumor to circumvent the inhibition of either branch. Moreover, as detailed above, the GCN2 inhibition provides the opportunity for interfering with the tumor metabolism at the same time what may enhance the efficacy of a monotherapy or a combination therapy with other anticancer approaches.
  • As mentioned above, the eIF2 kinase GCN2 is activated by interacting with deacylated tRNA that is accumulating as direct consequence of nutritional deprivation stress. Other cellular stress factors like UV irridation, redox stress or proteasome inhibition can induce GCN2 activation indirectly [Wek et al 2006]. In all known cases eIF2a becomes phosphorylated and this induces the specific expression of stress related target genes mainly by cap-independent initiation via the activating transcription factor 4 (ATF4).
  • Mitsuda et al (2007) showed that presenilin-1 is induced by activating transcription factor 4 (ATF4), regulated by GCN2. Accumulation of amyloid-β (Aβ), which is generated from amyloid precursor protein by γ-secretase, in cerebral cortex is common and critical incident in Alzheimer disease. Specifically, presenilin is an essential for γ-secretase activity. Ohata et al. (2010) describe a role of GCN2-eIF2α-ATF4 signaling in the regulation of γ-secretase activity in autophagy impaired cells: The impairment of the autophagy-lysosomal system may cause amino acid imbalance in the cell because autophagy is required for maintenance of amino acid level. The autophagy-lysosomal system is discussed as a vital modulator of γ-secretase activity through GCN2, leading to Aβ accumulation in autophagy deterioration, which may be a possible therapeutic target for reducing Aβ production. γ-Secretase plays an important role in the development of Alzheimer disease (AD). γ-Secretase activity is enriched in autophagic vacuoles and it augments amyloid-β (Aβ) synthesis.
  • Senile plaques are primarily composed of β-amyloid peptides (Aβ) derived from amyloid precursor protein (APP) that has undergone proteolytic processing by β-secretase (BACE-1) and γ-secretase. O'Connor et al. (2008) found that BACE-1 levels are translationally increased by phosphorylation of eIF2α.
  • Inhibition of GCN2 under such disease conditions that promote activation of γ-secretase or induction of BACE-1 with consequence of accumulation of Aβ and plaque formation in the brain would provide a valuable avenue to temper or even stop the progression of neurodegenerative diseases.
  • It was described that persistent, not acute, parasite or viral infections are associated to the establishment of immune privileged conditions of even immune competent host towards the infectious organism or particles. This has been associated to the local induction of IDO expression. Makala et al (J Infect Dis. 2011 Mar. 1; 203(5):715-25) show that cutaneous Leishmania major infection stimulated expression of the immune regulatory enzyme indoleamine 2,3 dioxygenase (IDO) in local lymph nodes. Induced IDO attenuated the T cell stimulatory functions of dendritic cells and suppressed local T cell responses to exogenous and nominal parasite antigens. IDO ablation reduced local inflammation and parasite burdens, as did pharmacologic inhibition of IDO in mice with established infections. de Souza Sales (Clin Exp Immunol. 2011 August; 165(2):251-63) corroborated the role of indoleamine 2,3-dioxygenase in lepromatous leprosy immunosuppression. Boasso et al (Blood, 2007 Apr. 15; 109(8):3351-9) found that HIV inhibits CD4+ T-cell proliferation by inducing indoleamine 2,3-dioxygenase in plasmacytoid dendritic cells and that in vitro inhibition of IDO results in increased CD4(+) T-cell proliferative response in PBMCs from HIV-infected patients Inhibitor drugs of the IDO/GCN2 pathway could be used to enhance host immunity to chronic and persistent infections.
  • LITERATURE
    • 1. Aaltoma, S. H., P. K. Lipponen, and V. M. Kosma. 2001. Inducible nitric oxide synthase (iNOS) expression and its prognostic value in prostate cancer. Anticancer Res. 21:3101-3106.
    • 2. Brandacher, G.; Perathoner, A.; Ladurner, R.; Schneeberger, S.; Obrist, P.; Winkler, C.; Werner, E. R.; Werner-Felmayer, G.; Weiss, H. G.; Gobel, G.; Margreiter, R.; Konigsrainer, A.; Fuchs, D.; Amberger, A. Prognostic value of indoleamine 2,3-dioxygenase expression in colorectal cancer: effect on tumorinfiltrating T cells. Clin. Cancer Res. 2006, 12, 1144-1151.
    • 3. Bronte V, Zanovello P. (2005). Regulation of immune responses by L-arginine metabolism. Nat Rev Immunol 5: 641-654.
    • 4. Bronte, V., P. Serafini, C. De Santo, I. Marigo, V. Tosello, A. Mazzoni, D. M. Segal, C. Staib, M. Lowel, G. Sutter, et al. 2003a. IL-4-induced arginase 1 suppresses alloreactive T cells in tumor-bearing mice. J. Immunol. 170:270-278.
    • 5. Bronte, V., P. Serafini, A. Mazzoni, D. M. Segal, and P. Zanovello. 2003b. L-arginine metabolism in myeloid cells controls T-lymphocyte functions. Trends Immunol. 24:302-306
    • 6. Carmela De Santo, Paolo Serafini, Ilaria Marigo, Luigi Dolcetti, Manlio Bolla, § Piero Del Soldato, Cecilia Melani, Cristiana Guiducci, Mario P. Colombo, Manuela lezzi, Piero Musiani, Paola Zanovello, and Vincenzo Bronte. Nitroaspirin corrects immune dysfunction in tumor-bearing hosts and promotes tumor eradication by cancer vaccination. Proc Natl Acad Sci USA. 2005 Mar. 15; 102(11): 4185-4190
    • 7. Cederbaum, S. D., H. Yu, W. W. Grody, R. M. Kern, P. Yoo, and R. K. Iyer. 2004. Arginases I and II: do their functions overlap? Mol. Genet. Metab. 81:S38-44.
    • 8. T. O'Connor, K. R. Sadleir, E. Maus, R. A. Velliquette, J. Zhao, S. L.
  • Cole, W. A. Eimer, B. Hitt, L. A. Bembinster, S. Lammich, S. F. Lichtenthaler, S. S. Hebert, S. B. De, C. Haass, D. A. Bennett, R. Vassar, Phosphorylation of the translation initiation factor eIF2alpha increases BACE1 levels and promotes amyloidogenesis. Neuron, 60 (2008), pp. 988-1009
    • 9. Dey, M., Cao, C., Sicheri, F. and T. E. Dever. Conserved Intermolecular Salt Bridge Required for Activation of Protein Kinases PKR, GCN2, and PERK. JBC 282(9): 6653, 2007.
    • 10. Dunn, G. P.; Old, L. J.; Schreiber, R. D. The immunobiology of cancer immunosurveillance and immunoediting. Immunity 2004, 21, 137-148.
    • 11. Fallarino, F. U. Grohmann, S. You, B. C. et al. The combined effects of tryptophan starvation and tryptophan catabolites down-regulate T cell receptor zeta-chain and induce a regulatory phenotype in naïve T cells. J. Immunol. 176:6752, 2006.
    • 12. Friberg M, Jennings R, Alsarraj M, Dessureault S, Cantor A, Extermann M et al. (2002). Indoleamine 2,3-dioxygenase contributes to tumor cell evasion of T cell-mediated rejection. Int. J Cancer 101: 151-155
    • 13. Harding H P, Novoa I, Zhang Y, Zeng H, Wek R, Schapira M, Ron D. Regulated translation initiation controls stress-induced gene expression in mammalian cells. Mol Cell. 2000 November; 6(5):1099-108.
    • 14. Hou D Y, Muller A J, Sharma M D, DuHadaway J, Banerjee T, Johnson M et al. (2007). Inhibition of indoleamine 2,3-dioxygenase in dendritic cells by stereoisomers of 1-methyl-tryptophan correlates with antitumor responses. Cancer Res 67: 792-801.
    • 15. Keskinege, A., S. Elgun, and E. Yilmaz. 2001. Possible implications of arginase and diamine oxidase in prostatic carcinoma. Cancer Detect. Prev. 25:76-79.
    • 16. Mellor A L, Munn D H. (2004). IDO expression by dendritic cells: tolerance and tryptophan catabolism. Nat Rev Immunol 4: 762-774.
    • 17. Mitsuda T, Hayakawa Y, Itoh M, Ohta K, Nakagawa T. ATF4 regulates gamma-secretase activity during amino acid imbalance, Biochem Biophys Res Commun. 2007 Jan. 19; 352(3):722-7.
    • 18. Moser, M. Dendritic cells in immunity and tolerance-do they display opposite functions? Immunity 2003, 19, 5-8.
    • 19. Muller, A. J. and P. A. Scherle. Targeting the mechanisms of tumoral immune tolerance with small-molecule inhibitors. Nat. Rev. Cancer. 6:613, 2006.
    • 20. Muller A J, Prendergast G C. (2007). Indoleamine 2,3-dioxygenase in immune suppression and cancer. Curr Cancer Drug Targets 7: 31-40.
    • 21. Muller A J, DuHadaway J B, Sutanto-Ward E, Donover P S, Prendergast G C. (2005a). Inhibition of indoleamine 2,3-dioxygenase, an immunomodulatory target of the tumor suppressor gene Bin1, potentiates cancer chemotherapy. Nature Med 11: 312-319.
    • 22. Muller A J, Malachowski W P, Prendergast G C. (2005b). Indoleamine 2,3-dioxygenase in cancer: targeting pathological immune tolerance with small-molecule inhibitors. Expert Opin Ther Targets 9: 831-849.
    • 23. Munn, D. H., M. D. Sharma, B. Baban, H. P. Harding, Y. Zhang, D. Ron, A. L. Mellor. GCN2 kinase in T cells mediates proliferative arrest and anergy induction in response to indoleamine 2,3-dioxygenase. Immunity. 22:633, 2005
    • 24. Ohta K, Mizuno A, Ueda M, Li S, Suzuki Y, Hida Y, Hayakawa-Yano Y, Itoh M, Ohta E, Kobori M, Nakagawa T. Autophagy impairment stimulates PS1 expression and gamma-secretase activity. Autophagy. 2010; 6(3):345-52
    • 25. Okamoto, A.; Nikaido, T.; Ochiai, K.; Takakura, S.; Saito, M.; Aoki, Y.; Ishii, N.; Yanaihara, N.; Yamada, K.; Takikawa, O.; Kawaguchi, R.; Isonishi, S.; Tanaka, T.; Urashima, M. Indoleamine 2,3-dioxygenase serves as a marker of poor prognosis in gene expression profiles of serous ovarian cancer cells. Clin. Cancer Res. 2005, 11, 6030-6039.
    • 26. Oyadomari S, Mori M. Roles of CHOP/GADD153 in endoplasmic reticulum stress. Cell Death Differ. 2004 April; 11(4):381-9.
    • 27. G C Prendergast, Immune escape as a fundamental trait of cancer: focus on IDO. Oncogene (2008) 27, 3889-3900
    • 28. Popovic P J, Zeh III H J, Ochoa J B. (2007). Arginine and immunity. J Nutr 137: 1681S-1686 S.
    • 29. Rodriguez, P. C., D. G. Quiceno, J. Zabaleta, B. Ortiz, A. H. Zea, M. B. Piazuelo, A. Delgado, P. Correa, J. Brayer, E. M. Sotomayor, S. Antonia, J. B. Ochoa, and A. C. Ochoa. Arginase I Production in the Tumor Microenvironment by Mature Myeloid Cells Inhibits T-Cell Receptor Expression and Antigen-Specific T-Cell Responses. Canc. Res. 64:5839, 2004
    • 30. Rodriguez, P. C., D. G. Quiceno, and A. C. Ochoa. L-arginine availability regulates T-lymphocyte cell-cycle progresión. Blood. 109:1568, 2007.
    • 31. Shankaran, V.; Ikeda, H.; Bruce, A. T.; White, J. M.; Swanson, P. E.; Old, L. J.; Schreiber, R. D. IFNgamma and lymphocytes prevent primary tumour development and shape tumour immunogenicity. Nature 2001, 410, 1107-1111.
    • 32. Sharma, M. D., B. Baban, P. Chandler, D-Y. Hou, N. Singh, H. Yagita, M. Azuma, B. R. Blazar, A. L. Mellor, and D. H. Munn. Plasmacytoid dendritic cells from mouse tumor-draining lymph nodes directly activate mature Tregs via indoleamine 2,3-dioxygenase. J. Clin. Invest. 117:2570, 2007.
    • 33. Uyttenhove C, Pilotte L, Theate I, Stroobant V, Colau D, Parmentier N et al. (2003). Evidence for a tumoral immune resistance mechanism based on tryptophan degradation by indoleamine 2,3-dioxygenase. Nat Med 9: 1269-1274
    • 34. Wang, J., M. Torbenson, Q. Wang, J. Y. Ro, and M. Becich. 2003.
  • Expression of inducible nitric oxide synthase in paired neoplastic and non-neoplastic primary prostate cell cultures and prostatectomy specimen. Urol. Oncol. 21:117-122.
    • 35. Wek R C, Jiang H Y, Anthony T G. Coping with stress: eIF2 kinases and translational control. Biochem Soc Trans. 2006 February; 34 (Pt 1):7-11.
    • 36. Ye J, Kumanova M, Hart L S, Sloane K, Zhang H, De Panis D N, Bobrovnikova-Marjon E, Diehl J A, Ron D, Koumenis C. The GCN2-ATF4 pathway is critical for tumour cell survival and proliferation in response to nutrient deprivation. EMBO J. 2010 Jun. 16; 29(12):2082-96.
  • In particular, the present invention relates to compounds and to the use of compounds in which the inhibition, regulation and/or modulation of signal transduction by GCN2 plays a role.
  • The synthesis of small compounds which specifically inhibit, regulate and/or modulate signal transduction by immune-modulatory or stress response kinases in particular GCN2, is therefore desirable and an aim of the present invention.
  • Moreover, aim of this invention is the synthesis of new compounds for the prevention and treatment of neoplastic malignancies including, but without being limited to, solid tumor cancers, cancers of the lymphatic or blood system, of neurodegenerative diseases and chronic infections.
  • It has been found that the compounds according to the invention and salts thereof have very valuable pharmacological properties while being well tolerated.
  • The compounds of the formula I can furthermore be used for the isolation and investigation of the activity or expression of GCN2. In addition, they are particularly suitable for use in diagnostic methods for diseases in connection with unregulated or disturbed GCN2 activity.
  • Compounds of formula I can also inhibit tyrosine kinases FMS (CSF1R), FLT3 or FLT4 or combinations of these kinases, preferentially in addition to inhibitory activity towards GCN2.
  • Fms-like tyrosine kinase 3 (FLT3), which is also known as FLK-2 (fetal liver kinase 2) and STK-I (stem cell kinase 1), plays an important role in the proliferation and differentiation of hematopoietic stem cells. FLT3 receptor kinase is expressed at very high levels on the cells of more than 80% of myelogenous patients and of a fraction of acute lymphoblastic leukemia cells. Furthermore, the enzyme can also be found on cells from patients with chronic myelogenous leukemia in lymphoid blast crisis. It has been reported that FLT3 kinase is mutated in 30% of acute myeloid leukemia (AML) and in a subset of acute lymphoblastic leukemia (ALL) as well (Gilliland et al, Blood 100, 1532-1542 (2002); Stirewalt et al., Nat. Rev. Cancer, 3, 650-665 (2003). Activating mutations in FLT3 mutations have been associated with a poor prognosis (Malempati et al., Blood, 104, 11 (2004). FLT3 inhibitors are being developed and some have shown promising clinical effects against AML (Levis et al Int. J. Hematol, 52, 100-107 (2005).
  • It has been reported that some of small-molecule FLT3 inhibitors are effective in inducing apoptosis in cell lines with FLT3-activating mutations and prolonging survival of mice that express mutant FLT3 in their bone marrow cells (Levis et al, Blood, 99, 3885-3891 (2002); Kelly et al, Cancer Cell, 1, 421-432 (2002); Weisberg et al, Cancer Cell, 1, 433-443 (2002); Yee et al, Blood, 100, 2941-2949 (2002).
  • US patent application 20090054358 describes Flt3 inhibitors for immune suppression and in particular for the treatment of immune related disorders like organ rejection, bone marrow transplant rejection, non-myeloablative bone marrow transplant rejection, ankylosing spondylitis, arthritis, aplastic anemia, Behcet's disease, type 1 diabetes mellitus, graft-versus-host disease, Graves' disease, autoimmune hemolytic anemia, Wegener's granulomatosis, hyper IgE syndrome, idiopathic thrombocytopenia purpura, rheumatoid arthritis, Crohn's disease, multiple sclerosis, Myasthenia gravis, psoriasis, and lupus, among other autoimmune diseases. Flt3 Inhibitors might also be used to treat neurological disorder as neurodegenerative disease, for example a disease caused by axonal degeneration. Neurodegenerative diseases include, for example, multiple sclerosis; demyelinating core disorders, such as multiple sclerosis, acute transverse myelitis without being limited thereto.
  • Scott et al (Bioorg. Med Chem Let. (2008) 18 (17) p4794) describe CSF-1R inhibitors for the treatment of cancer. CSF-1R is a member of the class III receptor tyrosine kinases. Colony stimulatory factor 1 (CSF-1), also known as macrophage/monocyte colony stimulatory factor (M-CSF), binds to CSF-1R, resulting in dimerization, autophosphorylation, and activation of signal transduction. 1 CSF-1/CSF-1R signaling is essential for normal monocyte development. In cancer, pro-tumorigenic macrophages have been identified and linked to poor prognosis in breast, ovarian, and prostate cancers. Elevated levels of CSF-1 and CSF-1R have been reported in several tumor types, including breast, ovarian, and endometrial cancers, and have also been linked to invasion and metastasis. Inhibition of CSF-1R activity could therefore have multiple effects on the tumor through reduction in the levels of tumor-associated macrophages (TAMs) and have direct effects on the tumor itself (C. E. Lewis, J. W. Pollard, Cancer Res., 66 (2006), p. 605; I. Bingle, N. et al., J. Pathol., 196 (2002), p. 254; B.M. Kacinski, Ann. Med., 27 (1995), p. 79; E. Garwood et al. J Clin Oncol 26: 2008).
  • Su J L et al. (Cancer Cell. 2006 March; 9(3):209-23) report that the VEGF-C/Flt-4 axis promotes invasion and metastasis of cancer cells. Flt-4, a VEGF receptor, is activated by its specific ligand, VEGF-C. The resultant signaling pathway promotes angiogenesis and/or lymphangiogenesis. VEGF-C/Flt-4 axis enhances cancer cell mobility and invasiveness and contributes to the promotion of cancer cell metastasis. Examination of tumor tissues from various types of cancers revealed high levels of Flt-4 and VEGF-C expression that correlated closely with clinical metastasis and patient survival. Inhibition of Flt-4 kinase could reduce the invasive capacity in different types of cancer
  • Combining the inhibitory specificity towards GCN2 with that towards FMS (CSF1R), FLT3 or FLT4 or combinations of these kinases can be of particular advantages for the treatment of neoplastic malignancies at different disease stages. It could combine the effects of stimulating the immune response towards cancer/tumor cells, to reduce the levels of tumor-associated macrophages as well as the invasive capacity of cancers for metastasis formation. In a further aspect the combination of inhibitory activities on GCN2 particularly with inhibition of FLT3 could be advantageous for the treatment of neurodegenerative disorders as it could synergize suppressive effects on inflammatory processes with the modulation of protein deposits generation in the brain. In another aspect the combination of inhibitory activities on GCN2 particularly with inhibition of FLT3 could provide advantages for modulating the immune response to treat immune related disorders and inflammatory or auto-immune diseases.
  • In a further embodiment the present invention specifically relates to compounds of the formula I which inhibit, regulate and/or modulate signal transduction by GCN2, FMS (CSF1R), FLT3 or FLT4 or combinations of these kinases, to compositions which comprise these compounds, and to processes for the use thereof for the treatment of diseases and complaints that are induced or modulated by GCN2, FMS (CSF1R), FLT3 or FLT4 or combinations of these kinases.
  • Further aim of this invention is the synthesis of new compounds for the prevention and treatment of neoplastic malignancies including, but without being limited to, solid tumor cancers, cancers of the lymphatic or blood system, of neurodegenerative diseases, immune related disorders like arthritis, psoriasis, lupus, multiple sclerosis or other autoimmune diseases as well as chronic infections.
  • The compounds of the formula I can furthermore be used for the isolation and investigation of the activity or expression of Syk, GCN2, FMS (CSF1R), FLT3 or FLT4. In addition, they are particularly suitable for use in diagnostic methods for diseases in connection with unregulated or disturbed Syk, GCN2, FMS (CSF1R), FLT3 or FLT4 activity. The host or patient can belong to any mammalian species, for example a primate species, particularly humans; rodents, including mice, rats and hamsters; rabbits; horses, cows, dogs, cats, etc. Animal models are of interest for experimental investigations, providing a model for treatment of human disease.
  • The susceptibility of a particular cell to treatment with the compounds according to the invention can be determined by in vitro tests. Typically, a culture of the cell is combined with a compound according to the invention at various concentrations for a period of time which is sufficient to allow active agents such as anti IgM to induce a cellular response such as expression of a surface marker, usually between about one hour and one week. In vitro testing can be carried out using cultivated cells from blood or from a biopsy sample. The amount of surface marker expressed are assessed by flow cytometry using specific antibodies recognising the marker.
  • The dose varies depending on the specific compound used, the specific disease, the patient status, etc. A therapeutic dose is typically sufficient considerably to reduce the undesired cell population in the target tissue while the viability of the patient is maintained. The treatment is generally continued until a considerable reduction has occurred, for example an at least about 50% reduction in the cell burden, and may be continued until essentially no more undesired cells are detected in the body.
  • For identification of a signal transduction pathway and for detection of interactions between various signal transduction pathways, various scientists have developed suitable models or model systems, for example cell culture models (for example Khwaja et al., EMBO, 1997, 16, 2783-93) and models of transgenic animals (for example White et al., Oncogene, 2001, 20, 7064-7072). For the determination of certain stages in the signal transduction cascade, interacting compounds can be utilised in order to modulate the signal (for example Stephens et al., Biochemical J., 2000, 351, 95-105). The compounds according to the invention can also be used as reagents for testing kinase-dependent signal transduction pathways in animals and/or cell culture models or in the clinical diseases mentioned in this application.
  • Measurement of the kinase activity is a technique which is well known to the person skilled in the art. Generic test systems for the determination of the kinase activity using substrates, for example histone (for example Alessi et al., FEBS Lett. 1996, 399, 3, pages 333-338) or the basic myelin protein, are described in the literature (for example Campos-Gonzalez, R. and Glenney, Jr., J. R. 1992, J. Biol. Chem. 267, page 14535).
  • For the identification of kinase inhibitors, various assay systems are available. In scintillation proximity assay (Sorg et al., J. of. Biomolecular Screening, 2002, 7, 11-19) and flashplate assay, the radioactive phosphorylation of a protein or peptide as substrate with γATP is measured. In the presence of an inhibitory compound, a decreased radioactive signal, or none at all, is detectable. Furthermore, homogeneous time-resolved fluorescence resonance energy transfer (HTR-FRET) and fluorescence polarisation (FP) technologies are suitable as assay methods (Sills et al., J. of Biomolecular Screening, 2002, 191-214).
  • Other non-radioactive ELISA assay methods use specific phospho-antibodies (phospho-ABs). The phospho-AB binds only the phosphorylated substrate. This binding can be detected by chemiluminescence using a second peroxidase-conjugated anti-sheep antibody (Ross et al., 2002, Biochem. J.).
  • Moreover, the present invention relates to compounds and to the use of compounds in which the inhibition, regulation and/or modulation of signal transduction by Syk plays a role.
  • One of the key events in the signaling pathway following the activation of mast cells is activation of the tyrosine kinase Syk. Mast cells play a critical role in asthma and allergic disorders by releasing pro-inflammatory mediators and cytokines. Antigen-mediated aggregation of FcεRJ, the high-affinity receptor for IgE, results in activation of mast cells. This triggers a series of signaling events resulting in the release of mediators, including histamine, proteases, leukotrienes and cytokines. These mediators cause increased vascular permeability, mucus production, bronchoconstriction, tissue degradation and inflammation, thus playing key roles in the etiology and symptoms of asthma and allergic disorders. Syk kinase acts as a central initiator of all subsequent signaling leading to mediator release. The critical role of Syk kinase in the signaling path was demonstrated by the complete inhibition of mediator release by a protein containing the SH2 domains of Syk kinase that functioned as an inhibitor of Syk kinase (J. A. Taylor et al, Molec. and Cell Biol, 15: 4149-4157 (1995)).
  • Syk (Spleen-Tyrosine-Kinase) is a 72 kDa non-receptor tyrosine kinase belonging to the subfamily of intracellular tyrosine kinases that comprises ZAP70, Pyk2, Abl, Tie2, KDR and HER, among others. Syk is a major regulator of FcR (FcγRI, II, III, FcεRI, FcαR) and BCR signaling and is expressed throughout hematopoietic lineage, as well as in fibroblasts, osteoclasts, hepatocytes, epithelial and neuronal cells. In addition to the C terminal kinase domain, SYK exhibits two SH2 domains and over 10 autophosphorylation sites′.
  • By means of both its SH2 domains SYK is specifically recruited to phosphorylated ITAMs (Immunoreceptor Tyrosine-based Activation Motifs present in immunoreceptors such as FcγRI, IIA, IIIA, FcαR, FcεRI and BCR, expressed by monocytes, macrophages, mast cells, neutrophils and B cells) and specifically mediates immunoreceptor signaling triggered by activation of those receptors in mast cells, B cells, macrophages, monocytes, neutrophils, eosinophils, NK cells, DC cells platelets and osteoclasts1,2.
  • Upon BCR cross linking, tyrosine residues at the ITAM motifs of the cytosolic tail of the Igα/Igβ are phosphorylated by the Src-family kinase Lyn, generating docking sites for SYK that is thus recruited to the BCR immunocomplex. SYK is then phosphorylated and activated by the Src-family kinase Lyn. Upon activation, SYK will phosphorylate the adaptor protein BLNK allowing its interaction with both BTK and PLCγ2 via their respective SH2 domains. SYK phosphorylated—and thus activated—BTK will in turn phosphorylate and activate PLCγ2 leading to IP3 formation, Ca2+ mobilization, PKC and MAPK activation and consequent NFAT, AP-1 and NFκB transcription factor activation, resulting in activation and surface marker expression, cytokine release, survival and proliferation of B cells3. In mast cells, allergen activated FcεRI is phosphorylated by LYN and FYN and recruits SYK which is in turn phosphorylated by LYN and further autophosphorylated, becoming fully activated. Activated SYK phosphorylates the two adaptor molecules NTAL and LAT creating more docking sites for SH2 containing proteins such as PLCγ1, vav, and the p85 regulatory subunit of PI3K, resulting in mast cell degranulation and cytokine production4. Syk's critical role in signal transduction of mast cells is confirmed by reproducible observation that the 10-15% of basophils (circulating mast cells) from human donors that cannot degranulate have reduced amounts of Syk protein5,6. In addition, SYK is required for the bone resorption activity of osteoclasts. Upon stimulation of osteoclasts by αvβ3 integrin, SYK becomes phosphorylated, most likely by c-Src, in a DAP-12 FcγRII dependent mechanism, leading to SPL-76 and Vav3 phosphorylation and subsequent cytoskeletal reorganisation. SYK deficient osteoclasts are inactive and show defective cytoskeletal reorganisation. In correlation with this, SYK deficient embryos show defective skeletal mass7,8.
  • BCR-mediated activation of B-cells in the lymph nodes, as well as FcR-mediated activation of dendritic cells, monocytes, macrophages, neutrophils and mast cells in the joints, are essential components of the cellular pathophysiological mechanisms taking place during rheumaoid arthritis (RA). Moreover, activation of osteoclasts leads to the bone and cartilage destruction which are hallmarks of this pathology9. SYK signaling should therefore play a pivotal role during the development of arthritis, both at the periphery and on the site of inflammation10. Indeed, an orally available Syk inhibitor R406—developed by Rigel—induced a significant improvement of clinical scores and significantly reduced serum cytokine concentrations, as well as bone erosion, in a murine model of RA11,12. Moreover, this inhibitor has shown efficacy (ACR scores improvement) and good tolerability in RA Phase II studies in humans13,14,15.
  • In SLE B cells contribute essentially towards pathogenesis via production of autoanibodies resulting in immune complex formation, stimulation of Fc receptors and finally in an excessive and chronic activation of inflammation. In a murine model of SLE treatment with a Syk inhibitor resulted in a reduction of numbers of class-switched germinal center, marginal zone, newly formed and follicular B cells and therefore in disease mitigating effects18.
  • Although TCR signals are transmitted by the intracellular tyrosine kinase ZAP-70 in thymocytes and naïve T cells, several studies indicate that differentiated effector T cells, such as those involved in the pathophysiology of Multiple sclerosis (MS) or systemic lupus erythematosus (SLE), show a down regulation of the TCRzeta chain and a concomitant upregulation of the TCR/CD3 chain and its interaction with FcRγ. Those studies show that the TCR/CD3/FcRgamma complex in effector cells recruits and activates Syk, instead of ZAP-70, tyrosine kinase. This physiologic switch in TCR signaling occurs exclusively in effector, and not naive or memory T cells16,17,18. Not surprisingly then, SYK inhibitors have been shown to delay disease progression and to improve survival in murine models of SLE17,18,19,20,21.
  • SYK inhibitors may also find a use in asthma, allergy, multiple sclerosis and other diseases such as thrombocytopenia purpura and T or B cell lymphomas1,10,14,22-35. Treatment of prediseased NZB/W mice with a Syk inhibitor prevented the development of renal disease demonstrated by reduced glomerular sclerosis, tubular damage, proteinuria and BUN levels18.
  • REFERENCES
    • 1. Turner, M., Schweighoffer, E., Colucci, F., Di Santo, J. P. & Tybulewicz, V. L. Tyrosine kinase SYK: essential functions for immunoreceptor signalling. Immunol Today 21, 148-154 (2000).
    • 2. Ghosh, D. & Tsokos, G. C. Spleen tyrosine kinase: an Src family of non-receptor kinase has multiple functions and represents a valuable therapeutic target in the treatment of autoimmune and inflammatory diseases. Autoimmunity 43, 48-55.
    • 3. Lindvall, J. M., et al. Bruton's tyrosine kinase: cell biology, sequence conservation, mutation spectrum, siRNA modifications, and expression profiling. Immunol Rev 203, 200-215 (2005).
    • 4. Gilfillan, A. M. & Tkaczyk, C. Integrated signalling pathways for mast-cell activation. Nat Rev Immunol 6, 218-230 (2006).
    • 5. Gomez, G., Schwartz, L. & Kepley, C. Syk deficiency in human nonreleaser lung mast cells. Clin Immunol 125, 112-115 (2007).
    • 6. Kepley, C. L., Youssef, L., Andrews, R. P., Wilson, B. S. & Oliver, J. M. Syk deficiency in nonreleaser basophils. J Allergy Clin Immunol 104, 279-284 (1999).
    • 7. Zou, W., et al. Syk, c-Src, the alphavbeta3 integrin, and ITAM immunoreceptors, in concert, regulate osteoclastic bone resorption. J Cell Biol 176, 877-888 (2007).
    • 8. Reeve, J. L., et al. SLP-76 couples Syk to the osteoclast cytoskeleton. J Immunol 183, 1804-1812 (2009).
    • 9. Klareskog, L., Catrina, A. I. & Paget, S. Rheumatoid arthritis. Lancet 373, 659-672 (2009).
    • 10. Wong, B. R., Grossbard, E. B., Payan, D. G. & Masuda, E. S. Targeting Syk as a treatment for allergic and autoimmune disorders. Expert Opin Investig Drugs 13, 743-762 (2004).
    • 11. Braselmann, S., et al. R406, an orally available spleen tyrosine kinase inhibitor blocks fc receptor signaling and reduces immune complex-mediated inflammation. J Pharmacol Exp Ther 319, 998-1008 (2006).
    • 12. Pine, P. R., et al. Inflammation and bone erosion are suppressed in models of rheumatoid arthritis following treatment with a novel Syk inhibitor. Clin Immunol 124, 244-257 (2007).
    • 13. Tomillero, A. & Moral, M. A. Gateways to clinical trials. Methods Find Exp Clin PharmacoI31, 47-57 (2009).
    • 14. Bajpai, M. Fostamatinib, a Syk inhibitor prodrug for the treatment of inflammatory diseases. IDrugs 12, 174-185 (2009).
    • 15. Weinblatt, M. E., et al. Treatment of rheumatoid arthritis with a Syk kinase inhibitor: a twelve-week, randomized, placebo-controlled trial. Arthritis Rheum 58, 3309-3318 (2008).
    • 16. Krishnan, S., Warke, V. G., Nambiar, M. P., Tsokos, G. C. & Farber, D. L. The FcR gamma subunit and Syk kinase replace the CD3 zeta-chain and ZAP-70 kinase in the TCR signaling complex of human effector CD4 T cells. J Immunol 170, 4189-4195 (2003).
    • 17. Krishnan, S., et al. Differential expression and molecular associations of Syk in systemic lupus erythematosus T cells. J Immunol 181, 8145-8152 (2008).
    • 18. Bahjat, F. R., et al. An orally bioavailable spleen tyrosine kinase inhibitor delays disease progression and prolongs survival in murine lupus. Arthritis Rheum 58, 1433-1444 (2008).
    • 19. Smith, J., et al. A Spleen Tyrosine Kinase Inhibitor Reduces the Severity of Established Glomerulonephritis. J Am Soc Nephrol (2009).
    • 20. Enyedy, E. J., et al. Fc epsilon receptor type I gamma chain replaces the deficient T cell receptor zeta chain in T cells of patients with systemic lupus erythematosus. Arthritis Rheum 44, 1114-1121 (2001).
    • 21. Perl, A. Systems biology of lupus: mapping the impact of genomic and environmental factors on gene expression signatures, cellular signaling, metabolic pathways, hormonal and cytokine imbalance, and selecting targets for treatment. Autoimmunity 43, 32-47.
    • 22. Smith, J., et al. A spleen tyrosine kinase inhibitor reduces the severity of established glomerulonephritis. J Am Soc Nephrol 21, 231-236.
    • 23. Sanderson, M. P., Gelling, S. J., Rippmann, J. F. & Schnapp, A. Comparison of the anti-allergic activity of Syk inhibitors with optimized Syk siRNAs in FcepsilonRI-activated RBL-2H3 basophilic cells. Cell Immunol 262, 28-34.
    • 24. Podolanczuk, A., Lazarus, A. H., Crow, A. R., Grossbard, E. & Bussel, J. B. Of mice and men: an open-label pilot study for treatment of immune thrombocytopenic purpura by an inhibitor of Syk. Blood 113, 3154-3160 (2009).
    • 25. Bajpai, M., Chopra, P., Dastidar, S. G. & Ray, A. Spleen tyrosine kinase: a novel target for therapeutic intervention of rheumatoid arthritis. Expert Opin Investig Drugs 17, 641-659 (2008).
    • 26. Friedberg, J. W., et al. Inhibition of Syk with fostamatinib disodium has significant clinical activity in non-Hodgkin lymphoma and chronic lymphocytic leukemia. Blood 115, 2578-2585.
    • 27. Gao, C., et al. Eptifibatide-induced thrombocytopenia and thrombosis in humans require FcgammaRIIa and the integrin beta3 cytoplasmic domain. J Clin Invest 119, 504-511 (2009).
    • 28. Marjon, K. D., Marnell, L. L., Mold, C. & Du Clos, T. W. Macrophages activated by C-reactive protein through Fc gamma RI transfer suppression of immune thrombocytopenia. J Immunol 182, 1397-1403 (2009).
    • 29. Chen, L., et al. SYK-dependent tonic B-cell receptor signaling is a rational treatment target in diffuse large B-cell lymphoma. Blood 111, 2230-2237 (2008).
    • 30. Ponzoni, M., et al. Syk expression patterns differ among B-cell lymphomas. Leuk Res (2010).
    • 31. Pechloff, K., et al. The fusion kinase ITK-SYK mimics a T cell receptor signal and drives oncogenesis in conditional mouse models of peripheral T cell lymphoma. J Exp Med 207, 1031-1044 (2009).
    • 32. Uckun, F. M., Ek, R. O., Jan, S. T., Chen, C. L. & Qazi, S. Targeting SYK kinase-dependent anti-apoptotic resistance pathway in B-lineage acute lymphoblastic leukaemia (ALL) cells with a potent SYK inhibitory pentapeptide mimic. Br J Haematol 149, 508-517 (2010).
    • 33. Wilcox, R. A., et al. Inhibition of Syk protein tyrosine kinase induces apoptosis and blocks proliferation in T-cell non-Hodgkin's lymphoma cell lines. Leukemia 24, 229-232 (2009).
    • 34. Feldman, A. L., et al. Overexpression of Syk tyrosine kinase in peripheral T-cell lymphomas. Leukemia 22, 1139-1143 (2008).
    • 35. Wang, L., et al. Alternative splicing disrupts a nuclear localization signal in spleen tyrosine kinase that is required for invasion suppression in breast cancer. Cancer Res 63, 4724-4730 (2003).
  • In addition to mast cells, Syk is expressed in other hematopoietic cells including B cells, where it is thought to play an essential role in transducing signals required for the transition of immature B cells into mature recirculating B cells (M. Turner et al, Immunology Today, 21: 148 (2000)). B cells are reported to play an important role in some inflammatory conditions such as lupus (0. T. Chan et al., Immunological Rev, 169: 107-121 (1999)) and rheumatoid arthritis (A. Cause et al, Biodrugs, 15(2): 73-79 (2001)).
  • Syk was also reported to be an element of the signaling cascade in beta-amyloid and prion fibrils leading to production of neurotoxic products (C. K. Combs et al., J. Neuroscl, 19: 928-939 (1999)). Furthermore, an inhibitor of Syk blocked the production of these neurotoxic products. Thus furopyridine derivatives would potentially be useful in the treatment of Alzheimer's disease and related neuroinflammatory diseases. Another report (Y. Kuno et al., Blood, 97, 1050-1055 (2001)) demonstrates that Syk plays an important role in malignant progression. A TEL-Syk fusion protein was found to transform hematopoietic cells suggesting a role in the pathogenesis of hematopoietic malignancies. Therefore compounds presently claimed may be useful in the treatment of certain types of cancers.
  • PRIOR ART
  • Triazolopyrimidine derivatives are described as GSK3 inhibitors for the treatment of diseases like Alzheimer or diabtes in WO 2005/012307 A1 and in WO 2006/075023 A2.
  • SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • The invention relates to compounds of the formula I
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00002
    • in which
    • R1 denotes Ar, COHet or Het,
    • R2 denotes H, Ar1, NHHet or Het,
    • R3 denotes H or A′,
    • R4 denotes H, A, Ar1, Het, Hal, NHAr1 or CN,
    • Ar denotes phenyl or naphthyl which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, A, Cyc, [C(R3)2]pOA, [C(R3)2]pOH, CN, NHCOHet1, NHCOA, NHCO[C(R3)2]pCyc, CONH[C(R3)2]pCyc, [C(R3)2]pN(R3)2, [C(R3)2]pHet1, NR3SO2A, SO2N(R3)2, S(O)nA, COHet1, O[C(R3)2]mN(R3)2 and/or O[C(R3)2]pHet1,
    • Ar1 denotes phenyl which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, A, phenyl, CONH2, [C(R3)2]pOR3, [C(R3)2]pN(R3)2, [C(R3)2]pCN, [C(R3)2]pHet1 and/or O[C(R3)2]pHet1,
    • Het denotes furyl, thienyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, thiazolyl, triazolyl, tetrazolyl, pyridyl, pyrimidyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazinyl, indolyl, isoindolyl, benzimidazolyl, indazolyl, quinolyl, 1,3-benzodioxolyl, benzothiophenyl, benzofuranyl, imidazopyridyl, dihydroindolyl, 2,3-dihydro-benzo[1,4]dioxinyl or furo[3,2-b]pyridyl which is unsubstituted or mono-, di- or trisubstituted by Hal, A, [C(R3)2]pOR3, [C(R3)2]p—N(R3)2, [C(R3)2]pHet1, NO2, CN, [C(R6)2]pCOOR3, CON(R3)2, NR3COA, NR3SO2A, SO2N(R3)2, S(O)nA, COHet1, O[C(R3)2]mN(R3)2, O[C(R3)2]pHet1 and/or ═O,
    • Het1 denotes dihydropyrrolyl, pyrrolidinyl, azetidinyl, oxetanyl, tetrahydroimidazolyl, dihydropyrazolyl, tetrahydropyrazolyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, dihydropyridyl, tetrahydropyridyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, hexahydropyridazinyl, hexahydropyrimidinyl, [1,3]dioxolanyl, tetrahydropyranyl, pyridyl or piperazinyl, which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, CN, OH, OA, COOA, CONH2, S(O)nA, S(O)nAr, COA, A and/or ═O,
    • A denotes unbranched or branched alkyl with 1-10 C-atoms, wherein one or two non-adjacent CH- and/or CH2-groups may be replaced by N-, O- and/or S-atoms and wherein 1-7H-atoms may be replaced by F or Cl,
  • Cyc denotes cyclic alkyl with 3-7 C-atoms, which is unsubstituted or monosubstituted by [C(R3)2]pOH or CN,
    • A′ denotes unbranched or branched alkyl with 1, 2, 3 or 4 C-atoms,
    • Hal denotes F, Cl, Br or I,
    • n denotes 0, 1 or 2,
    • m denotes 1, 2 or 3,
    • p denotes 0, 1, 2, 3 or 4,
    • and pharmaceutically usable derivatives, solvates, salts, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios.
  • The invention also relates to the optically active forms (stereoisomers), the enantiomers, the racemates, the diastereomers and the hydrates and solvates of these compounds.
  • The invention also relates to the solvates of the salts of the compounds of formula I, e.g. the mono- or dihydrate of the hydrochloride.
  • Moreover, the invention relates to pharmaceutically acceptable derivatives of compounds of formula I.
  • The term solvates of the compounds is taken to mean adductions of inert solvent molecules onto the compounds which form owing to their mutual attractive force. Solvates are, for example, mono- or dihydrates or alcoholates.
  • The term pharmaceutically acceptable derivatives is taken to mean, for example, the salts of the compounds according to the invention and also so-called prodrug compounds.
  • As used herein and unless otherwise indicated, the term “prodrug” means a derivative of a compound of formula I that can hydrolyze, oxidize, or otherwise react under biological conditions (in vitro or in vivo) to provide an active compound, particularly a compound of formula I. Examples of prodrugs include, but are not limited to, derivatives and metabolites of a compound of formula I that include biohydrolyzable moieties such as biohydrolyzable amides, biohydrolyzable esters, biohydrolyzable carbamates, biohydrolyzable carbonates, biohydrolyzable ureides, and biohydrolyzable phosphate analogues. In certain embodiments, prodrugs of compounds with carboxyl functional groups are the lower alkyl esters of the carboxylic acid. The carboxylate esters are conveniently formed by esterifying any of the carboxylic acid moieties present on the molecule. Prodrugs can typically be prepared using well-known methods, such as those described by Burger's Medicinal Chemistry and Drug Discovery 6th ed. (Donald J. Abraham ed., 2001, Wiley) and Design and Application of Prodrugs (H. Bundgaard ed., 1985, Harwood Academic Publishers Gmfh).
  • The expression “effective amount” denotes the amount of a medicament or of a pharmaceutical active ingredient which causes in a tissue, system, animal or human a biological or medical response which is sought or desired, for example, by a researcher or physician.
  • In addition, the expression “therapeutically effective amount” denotes an amount which, compared with a corresponding subject who has not received this amount, has the following consequence:
  • improved treatment, healing, prevention or elimination of a disease, syndrome, condition, complaint, disorder or side-effects or also the reduction in the advance of a disease, complaint or disorder.
  • The expression “therapeutically effective amount” also encompasses the amounts which are effective for increasing normal physiological function.
  • The invention also relates to the use of mixtures of the compounds of the formula I, for example mixtures of two diastereomers, for example in the ratio 1:1, 1:2, 1:3, 1:4, 1:5, 1:10, 1:100 or 1:1000.
  • These are particularly preferably mixtures of stereoisomeric compounds.
  • “Tautomers” refers to isomeric forms of a compound that are in equilibrium with each other. The concentrations of the isomeric forms will depend on the environment the compound is found in and may be different depending upon, for example, whether the compound is a solid or is in an organic or aqueous solution.
  • The invention relates to the compounds of the formula I and salts thereof and to a process for the preparation of compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically usable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, characterised in that a compound of the formula II
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00003
      • in which R2 and R4 have the meanings indicated in claim 1, is reacted with a compound of the formula III

  • R1-L  III
      • in which R1 has the meaning indicated in claim 1 and
      • L denotes Cl or Br,
  • and/or
  • a base or acid of the formula I is converted into one of its salts.
  • Above and below, the radicals R1, R2 and R4 have the meanings indicated for the formula I, unless expressly stated otherwise.
  • A denotes alkyl, this is unbranched (linear) or branched, and has 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 or 10 C atoms. A preferably denotes methyl, furthermore ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, isobutyl, sec-butyl or tert-butyl, furthermore also pentyl, 1-, 2- or 3-methylbutyl, 1,1-, 1,2- or 2,2-dimethylpropyl, 1-ethylpropyl, hexyl, 1-, 2-, 3- or 4-methylpentyl, 1,1-, 1,2-, 1,3-, 2,2-, 2,3- or 3,3-dimethylbutyl, 1- or 2-ethylbutyl, 1-ethyl-1-methylpropyl, 1-ethyl-2-methylpropyl, 1,1,2- or 1,2,2-trimethylpropyl, furthermore preferably, for example, trifluoromethyl.
  • A very particularly preferably denotes alkyl having 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6 C atoms, preferably methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, isobutyl, sec-butyl, tert-butyl, pentyl, hexyl, trifluoromethyl, pentafluoroethyl or 1,1,1-trifluoroethyl.
  • Moreover, A denotes e.g. CH2OCH3, CH2CH2OH, OCH2CH2NH2, CH2NHCH2 or NHCH2CH3
  • Cyc preferably denotes cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl or cycloheptyl.
  • A′ preferably denotes methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl or butyl.
  • R2 preferably denotes furyl, thienyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, thiazolyl, triazolyl or tetrazolyl which is unsubstituted or monosubstituted by A, [C(R3)2]pCyc, [C(R3)2]pAr, [C(R3)2]pHet1, CN or [C(R3)2]pCOOR3.
  • R3 preferably denotes H or alkyl having 1, 2, 3 or 4 C atoms, particularly preferably H or methyl.
  • Ar denotes, for example, o-, m- or p-tolyl, o-, m- or p-ethylphenyl, o-, m- or p-propylphenyl, o-, m- or p-isopropylphenyl, o-, m- or p-tert-butylphenyl, o-, m- or p-hydroxyphenyl, o-, m- or p-nitrophenyl, o-, m- or p-aminophenyl, o-, m- or p-(N-methylamino)phenyl, o-, m- or p-(N-methylaminocarbonyl)phenyl, o-, m- or p-methoxyphenyl, o-, m- or p-ethoxyphenyl, o-, m- or p-ethoxycarbonylphenyl, o-, m- or p-(N,N-dimethylamino)phenyl, o-, m- or p-(N,N-dimethylaminocarbonyl)phenyl, o-, m- or p-(N-ethylamino)-phenyl, o-, m- or p-(N,N-diethylamino)phenyl, o-, m- or p-fluorophenyl, o-, m- or p-bromophenyl, o-, m- or p-chlorophenyl, o-, m- or p-(methylsulfonamido)phenyl, o-, m- or p-(methylsulfonyl)phenyl, o-, m- or p-cyanophenyl, o-, m- or p-carboxyphenyl, o-, m- or p-methoxycarbonylphenyl, o-, m- or p-formylphenyl, o-, m- or p-acetylphenyl, o-, m- or p-aminosulfonylphenyl, o-, m- or p-[2-(morpholin-4-yl)ethoxy]phenyl, o-, m- or p-[3-(N,N-diethylamino)propoxy]phenyl, furthermore preferably 2,3-, 2,4-, 2,5-, 2,6-, 3,4- or 3,5-difluorophenyl, 2,3-, 2,4-, 2,5-, 2,6-, 3,4- or 3,5-dichlorophenyl, 2,3-, 2,4-, 2,5-, 2,6-, 3,4- or 3,5-dibromophenyl, 2,4- or 2,5-dinitrophenyl, 2,5- or 3,4-dimethoxyphenyl, 3-nitro-4-chlorophenyl, 3-amino-4-chloro-, 2-amino-3-chloro-, 2-amino-4-chloro-, 2-amino-5-chloro- or 2-amino-6-chlorophenyl, 2-nitro-4-N,N-dimethylamino- or 3-nitro-4-N,N-dimethylaminophenyl, 2,3-diaminophenyl, 2,3,4-, 2,3,5-, 2,3,6-, 2,4,6- or 3,4,5-trichlorophenyl, 2,4,6-trimethoxyphenyl, 2-hydroxy-3,5-dichlorophenyl, p-iodophenyl, 3,6-dichloro-4-aminophenyl, 4-fluoro-3-chlorophenyl, 2-fluoro-4-bromophenyl, 2,5-difluoro-4-bromophenyl, 3-bromo-6-methoxyphenyl, 3-chloro-6-methoxyphenyl, 3-chloro-4-acetamidophenyl, 3-fluoro-4-methoxyphenyl, 3-amino-6-methylphenyl, 3-chloro-4-acetamidophenyl or 2,5-dimethyl-4-chlorophenyl.
  • Ar furthermore preferably denotes phenyl which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, A, Cyc, [C(R3)2]pOA, [C(R3)2]pOH, CN, NHCOHet1, NHCOA, NHCO[C(R3)2]pCyc, CONH[C(R3)2]pCyc, [C(R3)2]pHet1, SO2N(R3)2, NR3SO2A, O[C(R3)2]pHet1, COHet1, and/or S(O)nA.
  • Ar1 preferably denotes phenyl which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, A, phenyl, CONH2, [C(R3)2]pCN, [C(R3)2]pOR3 and/or [C(R3)2]pHet1.
  • Het preferably denotes furyl, thienyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, thiazolyl, triazolyl, tetrazolyl, pyridyl, pyrimidyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazinyl, indolyl, isoindolyl, benzimidazolyl, indazolyl, quinolyl, 1,3-benzodioxolyl, benzothiophenyl, benzofuranyl, imidazopyridyl, dihydroindolyl, 2,3-dihydro-benzo[1,4]dioxinyl or furo[3,2-b]pyridyl which is unsubstituted or mono-, di- or trisubstituted by A, [C(R3)2]pN(R3)2 and/or ═O.
  • Het particularly preferably denotes pyrazolyl, pyridyl, benzimidazolyl, indazolyl, quinolyl or dihydroindolyl which is unsubstituted or mono-, di- or trisubstituted by A, [C(R3)2]pHet1, [C(R3)2]pN(R3)2 and/or ═O.
  • Het1 preferably denotes dihydropyrrolyl, pyrrolidinyl, azetidinyl, oxetanyl, tetrahydroimidazolyl, dihydropyrazolyl, tetrahydropyrazolyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, dihydropyridyl, tetrahydropyridyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, hexahydropyridazinyl, hexahydropyrimidinyl, [1,3]dioxolanyl, tetrahydropyranyl, pyridyl or piperazinyl, which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by A.
  • Het1 particularly preferably denotes morpholinyl or piperazinyl, which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by A.
  • Hal preferably denotes F, Cl or Br, but also I, particularly preferably F or Cl.
  • Throughout the invention, all radicals which occur more than once may be identical or different, i.e. are independent of one another.
  • The compounds of the formula I may have one or more chiral centres and can therefore occur in various stereoisomeric forms. The formula I encompasses all these forms.
  • Accordingly, the invention relates, in particular, to the compounds of the formula I in which at least one of the said radicals has one of the preferred meanings indicated above. Some preferred groups of compounds may be expressed by the following sub-formulae Ia to Ie, which conform to the formula I and in which the radicals not designated in greater detail have the meaning indicated for the formula I, but in which
    • in Ia Ar denotes phenyl which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, A, Cyc, [C(R3)2]pOA, [C(R3)2]pOH, CN, NHCOHet1, NHCOA, NHCO[C(R3)2]pCyc, CONH[C(R3)2]pCyc, [C(R3)2]pHet1, SO2N(R3)2, NR3SO2A, O[C(R3)2]pHet1, COHet1, and/or S(O)nA;
    • in Ib Ar1 denotes phenyl which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, A, phenyl, CONH2, [C(R3)2]pCN, [C(R3)2]pOR3 and/or [C(R3)2]pHet1;
    • in Ic Het denotes furyl, thienyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, thiazolyl, triazolyl, tetrazolyl, pyridyl, pyrimidyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazinyl, indolyl, isoindolyl, benzimidazolyl, indazolyl, quinolyl, 1,3-benzodioxolyl, benzothiophenyl, benzofuranyl, imidazopyridyl, dihydroindolyl, 2,3-dihydro-unsubstituted or mono-, di- or trisubstituted by A, [C(R3)2]pHet1, [C(R3)2]pN(R3)2 and/or ═O;
    • in Id Het1 denotes dihydropyrrolyl, pyrrolidinyl, azetidinyl, oxetanyl, tetrahydroimidazolyl, dihydropyrazolyl, tetrahydropyrazolyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, dihydropyridyl, tetrahydropyridyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, hexahydropyridazinyl, hexahydropyrimidinyl, [1,3]dioxolanyl, tetrahydropyranyl, pyridyl or piperazinyl, which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by A;
    • in Ie R1 denotes Ar, COHet or Het,
      • R2 denotes H, Ar1, NHHet or Het,
      • R3 denotes H or A′,
      • R4 denotes H, A, Ar1, Het, Hal, NHAr1 or CN,
  • Ar denotes phenyl which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, A, Cyc, [C(R3)2]pOA, [C(R3)2]pOH, CN, NHCOHet1, NHCOA, NHCO[C(R3)2]pCyc, CONH[C(R3)2]pCyc, [C(R3)2]pHet1, SO2N(R3)2, NR3SO2A, O[C(R3)2]pHet1, COHet1, and/or S(O)nA,
    • Ar1 denotes phenyl which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, A, phenyl, CONH2, [C(R3)2]pCN, [C(R3)2]pOR3 and/or [C(R3)2]pHet1,
    • Het denotes furyl, thienyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, thiazolyl, triazolyl, tetrazolyl, pyridyl, pyrimidyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazinyl, indolyl, isoindolyl, benzimidazolyl, indazolyl, quinolyl, 1,3-benzodioxolyl, benzothiophenyl, benzofuranyl, imidazopyridyl, dihydroindolyl, 2,3-dihydro-benzo[1,4]dioxinyl or furo[3,2-b]pyridyl which is unsubstituted or mono-, di- or trisubstituted by A, [C(R3)2]pHet1, [C(R3)2]pN(R3)2 and/or ═O,
    • Het1 denotes dihydropyrrolyl, pyrrolidinyl, azetidinyl, oxetanyl, tetrahydroimidazolyl, dihydropyrazolyl, tetrahydropyrazolyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, dihydropyridyl, tetrahydropyridyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, hexahydropyridazinyl, hexahydropyrimidinyl, [1,3]dioxolanyl, tetrahydropyranyl, pyridyl or piperazinyl, which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by A,
    • A denotes unbranched or branched alkyl with 1-10 C-atoms, and wherein 1-7H-atoms may be replaced by F or Cl,
    • Cyc denotes cyclic alkyl with 3-7 C-atoms, which is unsubstituted or monosubstituted by [C(R3)2]pOH or CN,
    • A′ denotes unbranched or branched alkyl with 1, 2, 3 or 4 C-atoms,
    • Hal denotes F, Cl, Br or I,
    • n denotes 0, 1 or 2,
    • p denotes 0, 1, 2, 3 or 4;
  • and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios.
  • The compounds of the formula I and also the starting materials for their preparation are, in addition, prepared by methods known per se, as described in the literature (for example in the standard works, such as Houben-Weyl, Methoden der organischen Chemie [Methods of Organic Chemistry], Georg-Thieme-Verlag, Stuttgart), to be precise Use can also be made here of variants known per se which are not mentioned here in greater detail.
  • The starting compounds of the formulae II and III are generally known. If they are novel, however, they can be prepared by methods known per se.
  • Compounds of the formula I can preferably be obtained by reacting a compound of the formula II with a compound of the formula III.
  • The reaction is generally carried out under Buchwald-conditions known to the skilled artisan and which are known and suitable for the said reaction. Depending on the conditions used, the reaction time is between a few minutes and 14 days, the reaction temperature is between about 0° and 140°, normally between 20° and 120°, in particular between about 60° and about 110°.
  • Examples of suitable inert solvents are hydrocarbons, such as hexane, petroleum ether, benzene, toluene or xylene; chlorinated hydrocarbons, such as trichloroethylene, 1,2-dichloroethane, carbon tetrachloride, chloroform or dichloromethane; alcohols, such as methanol, ethanol, isopropanol, n-propanol, n-butanol or tert-butanol; ethers, such as diethyl ether, diisopropyl ether, tetrahydrofuran (THF) or dioxane; glycol ethers, such as ethylene glycol monomethyl or monoethyl ether, ethylene glycol dimethyl ether (diglyme); ketones, such as acetone or butanone; amides, such as acetamide, dimethylacetamide or dimethylformamide (DMF); nitriles, such as acetonitrile; sulfoxides, such as dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO); carbon disulfide; carboxylic acids, such as formic acid or acetic acid; nitro compounds, such as nitromethane or nitrobenzene; esters, such as ethyl acetate, or mixtures of the said solvents.
  • Particular preference is given to aprotic solvents, particularly preferably to THF.
  • Free amino groups can furthermore be acylated in a conventional manner using an acid chloride or anhydride or alkylated using an unsubstituted or substituted alkyl halide, advantageously in an inert solvent, such as dichloromethane or THF, and/or in the presence of a base, such as triethylamine or pyridine, at temperatures between −60 and +30°.
  • Pharmaceutical Salts and Other Forms
  • The said compounds according to the invention can be used in their final non-salt form. On the other hand, the present invention also encompasses the use of these compounds in the form of their pharmaceutically acceptable salts, which can be derived from various organic and inorganic acids and bases by procedures known in the art. Pharmaceutically acceptable salt forms of the compounds of the formula I are for the most part prepared by conventional methods. If the compound of the formula I contains a carboxyl group, one of its suitable salts can be formed by reacting the compound with a suitable base to give the corresponding base-addition salt. Such bases are, for example, alkali metal hydroxides, including potassium hydroxide, sodium hydroxide and lithium hydroxide; alkaline earth metal hydroxides, such as barium hydroxide and calcium hydroxide; alkali metal alkoxides, for example potassium ethoxide and sodium propoxide; and various organic bases, such as piperidine, diethanolamine and N-methylglutamine. The aluminium salts of the compounds of the formula I are likewise included. In the case of certain compounds of the formula I, acid-addition salts can be formed by treating these compounds with pharmaceutically acceptable organic and inorganic acids, for example hydrogen halides, such as hydrogen chloride, hydrogen bromide or hydrogen iodide, other mineral acids and corresponding salts thereof, such as sulfate, nitrate or phosphate and the like, and alkyl- and monoarylsulfonates, such as ethanesulfonate, toluenesulfonate and benzenesulfonate, and other organic acids and corresponding salts thereof, such as acetate, trifluoroacetate, tartrate, maleate, succinate, citrate, benzoate, salicylate, ascorbate and the like. Accordingly, pharmaceutically acceptable acid-addition salts of the compounds of the formula I include the following: acetate, adipate, alginate, arginate, aspartate, benzoate, benzenesulfonate (besylate), bisulfate, bisulfite, bromide, butyrate, camphorate, camphorsulfonate, caprylate, chloride, chlorobenzoate, citrate, cyclopentanepropionate, digluconate, dihydrogenphosphate, dinitrobenzoate, dodecylsulfate, ethanesulfonate, fumarate, galacterate (from mucic acid), galacturonate, glucoheptanoate, gluconate, glutamate, glycerophosphate, hemisuccinate, hemisulfate, heptanoate, hexanoate, hippurate, hydrochloride, hydrobromide, hydroiodide, 2-hydroxyethanesulfonate, iodide, isethionate, isobutyrate, lactate, lactobionate, malate, maleate, malonate, mandelate, metaphosphate, methanesulfonate, methylbenzoate, monohydrogenphosphate, 2-naphthalenesulfonate, nicotinate, nitrate, oxalate, oleate, palmoate, pectinate, persulfate, phenylacetate, 3-phenylpropionate, phosphate, phosphonate, phthalate, but this does not represent a restriction.
  • Furthermore, the base salts of the compounds according to the invention include aluminium, ammonium, calcium, copper, iron(III), iron(II), lithium, magnesium, manganese(III), manganese(II), potassium, sodium and zinc salts, but this is not intended to represent a restriction. Of the above-mentioned salts, preference is given to ammonium; the alkali metal salts sodium and potassium, and the alkaline earth metal salts calcium and magnesium. Salts of the compounds of the formula I which are derived from pharmaceutically acceptable organic non-toxic bases include salts of primary, secondary and tertiary amines, substituted amines, also including naturally occurring substituted amines, cyclic amines, and basic ion exchanger resins, for example arginine, betaine, caffeine, chloroprocaine, choline, N,N′-dibenzylethylenediamine(benzathine), dicyclohexylamine, diethanolamine, diethylamine, 2-diethylaminoethanol, 2-dimethylaminoethanol, ethanolamine, ethylenediamine, N-ethylmorpholine, N-ethylpiperidine, glucamine, glucosamine, histidine, hydrabamine, isopropylamine, lidocaine, lysine, meglumine, N-methyl-D-glucamine, morpholine, piperazine, piperidine, polyamine resins, procaine, purines, theobromine, triethanolamine, triethylamine, trimethylamine, tripropylamine and tris(hydroxymethyl)methylamine(tromethamine), but this is not intended to represent a restriction.
  • Compounds of the present invention which contain basic nitrogen-containing groups can be quaternised using agents such as (C1-C4)alkyl halides, for example methyl, ethyl, isopropyl and tert-butyl chloride, bromide and iodide; di(C1-C4)alkyl sulfates, for example dimethyl, diethyl and diamyl sulfate; (C10-C18)alkyl halides, for example decyl, dodecyl, lauryl, myristyl and stearyl chloride, bromide and iodide; and aryl(C1-C4)alkyl halides, for example benzyl chloride and phenethyl bromide. Both water- and oil-soluble compounds according to the invention can be prepared using such salts.
  • The above-mentioned pharmaceutical salts which are preferred include acetate, trifluoroacetate, besylate, citrate, fumarate, gluconate, hemisuccinate, hippurate, hydrochloride, hydrobromide, isethionate, mandelate, meglumine, nitrate, oleate, phosphonate, pivalate, sodium phosphate, stearate, sulfate, sulfosalicylate, tartrate, thiomalate, tosylate and tromethamine, but this is not intended to represent a restriction.
  • Particular preference is given to hydrochloride, dihydrochloride, hydrobromide, maleate, mesylate, phosphate, sulfate and succinate.
  • The acid-addition salts of basic compounds of the formula I are prepared by bringing the free base form into contact with a sufficient amount of the desired acid, causing the formation of the salt in a conventional manner.
  • The free base can be regenerated by bringing the salt form into contact with a base and isolating the free base in a conventional manner. The free base forms differ in a certain respect from the corresponding salt forms thereof with respect to certain physical properties, such as solubility in polar solvents; for the purposes of the invention, however, the salts otherwise correspond to the respective free base forms thereof.
  • As mentioned, the pharmaceutically acceptable base-addition salts of the compounds of the formula I are formed with metals or amines, such as alkali metals and alkaline earth metals or organic amines. Preferred metals are sodium, potassium, magnesium and calcium. Preferred organic amines are N,N′-dibenzylethylenediamine, chloroprocaine, choline, diethanolamine, ethylenediamine, N-methyl-D-glucamine and procaine.
  • The base-addition salts of acidic compounds according to the invention are prepared by bringing the free acid form into contact with a sufficient amount of the desired base, causing the formation of the salt in a conventional manner. The free acid can be regenerated by bringing the salt form into contact with an acid and isolating the free acid in a conventional manner. The free acid forms differ in a certain respect from the corresponding salt forms thereof with respect to certain physical properties, such as solubility in polar solvents; for the purposes of the invention, however, the salts otherwise correspond to the respective free acid forms thereof.
  • If a compound according to the invention contains more than one group which is capable of forming pharmaceutically acceptable salts of this type, the invention also encompasses multiple salts. Typical multiple salt forms include, for example, bitartrate, diacetate, difumarate, dimeglumine, diphosphate, disodium and trihydrochloride, but this is not intended to represent a restriction.
  • With regard to that stated above, it can be seen that the expression “pharmaceutically acceptable salt” in the present connection is taken to mean an active ingredient which comprises a compound of the formula I in the form of one of its salts, in particular if this salt form imparts improved pharmacokinetic properties on the active ingredient compared with the free form of the active ingredient or any other salt form of the active ingredient used earlier. The pharmaceutically acceptable salt form of the active ingredient can also provide this active ingredient for the first time with a desired pharmacokinetic property which it did not have earlier and can even have a positive influence on the pharmacodynamics of this active ingredient with respect to its therapeutic efficacy in the body.
  • Isotopes
  • There is furthermore intended that a compound of the formula I includes isotope-labelled forms thereof. An isotope-labelled form of a compound of the formula I is identical to this compound apart from the fact that one or more atoms of the compound have been replaced by an atom or atoms having an atomic mass or mass number which differs from the atomic mass or mass number of the atom which usually occurs naturally. Examples of isotopes which are readily commercially available and which can be incorporated into a compound of the formula I by well-known methods include isotopes of hydrogen, carbon, nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorus, fluorine and chlorine, for example 2H, 3H, 13C, 14C, 15N, 18O, 17O, 31P, 32P, 35S, 18F and 36Cl, respectively. A compound of the formula I, a prodrug, thereof or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt of either which contains one or more of the above-mentioned isotopes and/or other isotopes of other atoms is intended to be part of the present invention. An isotope-labelled compound of the formula I can be used in a number of beneficial ways. For example, an isotope-labelled compound of the formula I into which, for example, a radioisotope, such as 3H or 14C, has been incorporated is suitable for medicament and/or substrate tissue distribution assays. These radioisotopes, i.e. tritium (3H) and carbon-14 (14C), are particularly preferred owing to simple preparation and excellent detectability. Incorporation of heavier isotopes, for example deuterium (2H), into a compound of the formula I has therapeutic advantages owing to the higher metabolic stability of this isotope-labelled compound. Higher metabolic stability translates directly into an increased in vivo half-life or lower dosages, which under most circumstances would represent a preferred embodiment of the present invention. An isotope-labelled compound of the formula I can usually be prepared by carrying out the procedures disclosed in the synthesis schemes and the related description, in the example part and in the preparation part in the present text, replacing a non-isotope-labelled reactant by a readily available isotope-labelled reactant.
  • Deuterium (2H) can also be incorporated into a compound of the formula I for the purpose in order to manipulate the oxidative metabolism of the compound by way of the primary kinetic isotope effect. The primary kinetic isotope effect is a change of the rate for a chemical reaction that results from exchange of isotopic nuclei, which in turn is caused by the change in ground state energies necessary for covalent bond formation after this isotopic exchange. Exchange of a heavier isotope usually results in a lowering of the ground state energy for a chemical bond and thus cause a reduction in the rate in rate-limiting bond breakage. If the bond breakage occurs in or in the vicinity of a saddle-point region along the coordinate of a multi-product reaction, the product distribution ratios can be altered substantially. For explanation: if deuterium is bonded to a carbon atom at a non-exchangeable position, rate differences of kM/kD=2-7 are typical. If this rate difference is successfully applied to a compound of the formula I that is susceptible to oxidation, the profile of this compound in vivo can be drastically modified and result in improved pharmacokinetic properties.
  • When discovering and developing therapeutic agents, the person skilled in the art attempts to optimise pharmacokinetic parameters while retaining desirable in vitro properties. It is reasonable to assume that many compounds with poor pharmacokinetic profiles are susceptible to oxidative metabolism. In vitro liver microsomal assays currently available provide valuable information on the course of oxidative metabolism of this type, which in turn permits the rational design of deuterated compounds of the formula I with improved stability through resistance to such oxidative metabolism. Significant improvements in the pharmacokinetic profiles of compounds of the formula I are thereby obtained, and can be expressed quantitatively in terms of increases in the in vivo half-life (t/2), concentration at maximum therapeutic effect (Cmax), area under the dose response curve (AUC), and F; and in terms of reduced clearance, dose and materials costs.
  • The following is intended to illustrate the above: a compound of the formula I which has multiple potential sites of attack for oxidative metabolism, for example benzylic hydrogen atoms and hydrogen atoms bonded to a nitrogen atom, is prepared as a series of analogues in which various combinations of hydrogen atoms are replaced by deuterium atoms, so that some, most or all of these hydrogen atoms have been replaced by deuterium atoms. Half-life determinations enable favourable and accurate determination of the extent of the extent to which the improvement in resistance to oxidative metabolism has improved. In this way, it is deter-mined that the half-life of the parent compound can be extended by up to 100% as the result of deuterium-hydrogen exchange of this type.
  • Deuterium-hydrogen exchange in a compound of the formula I can also be used to achieve a favourable modification of the metabolite spectrum of the starting compound in order to diminish or eliminate undesired toxic metabolites. For example, if a toxic metabolite arises through oxidative carbon-hydrogen (C—H) bond cleavage, it can reasonably be assumed that the deuterated analogue will greatly diminish or eliminate production of the unwanted metabolite, even if the particular oxidation is not a rate-determining step. Further information on the state of the art with respect to deuterium-hydrogen exchange may be found, for example in Hanzlik et al., J. Org. Chem. 55, 3992-3997, 1990, Reider et al., J. Org. Chem. 52, 3326-3334, 1987, Foster, Adv. Drug Res. 14, 1-40, 1985, Gillette et al, Biochemistry 33(10) 2927-2937, 1994, and Jarman et al. Carcinogenesis 16(4), 683-688, 1993.
  • The invention furthermore relates to medicaments comprising at least one compound of the formula I and/or pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, and optionally excipients and/or adjuvants.
  • Pharmaceutical formulations can be administered in the form of dosage units which comprise a predetermined amount of active ingredient per dosage unit. Such a unit can comprise, for example, 0.5 mg to 1 g, preferably 1 mg to 700 mg, particularly preferably 5 mg to 100 mg, of a compound according to the invention, depending on the condition treated, the method of administration and the age, weight and condition of the patient, or pharmaceutical formulations can be administered in the form of dosage units which comprise a predetermined amount of active ingredient per dosage unit. Preferred dosage unit formulations are those which comprise a daily dose or part-dose, as indicated above, or a corresponding fraction thereof of an active ingredient. Furthermore, pharmaceutical formulations of this type can be prepared using a process which is generally known in the pharmaceutical art.
  • Pharmaceutical formulations can be adapted for administration via any desired suitable method, for example by oral (including buccal or sublingual), rectal, nasal, topical (including buccal, sublingual or transdermal), vaginal or parenteral (including subcutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous or intradermal) methods. Such formulations can be prepared using all processes known in the pharmaceutical art by, for example, combining the active ingredient with the excipient(s) or adjuvant(s).
  • Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for oral administration can be administered as separate units, such as, for example, capsules or tablets; powders or granules; solutions or suspensions in aqueous or non-aqueous liquids; edible foams or foam foods; or oil-in-water liquid emulsions or water-in-oil liquid emulsions.
  • Thus, for example, in the case of oral administration in the form of a tablet or capsule, the active-ingredient component can be combined with an oral, non-toxic and pharmaceutically acceptable inert excipient, such as, for example, ethanol, glycerol, water and the like. Powders are prepared by comminuting the compound to a suitable fine size and mixing it with a pharmaceutical excipient comminuted in a similar manner, such as, for example, an edible carbohydrate, such as, for example, starch or mannitol. A flavour, preservative, dispersant and dye may likewise be present.
  • Capsules are produced by preparing a powder mixture as described above and filling shaped gelatine shells therewith. Glidants and lubricants, such as, for example, highly disperse silicic acid, talc, magnesium stearate, calcium stearate or polyethylene glycol in solid form, can be added to the powder mixture before the filling operation. A disintegrant or solubiliser, such as, for example, agar-agar, calcium carbonate or sodium carbonate, may likewise be added in order to improve the availability of the medicament after the capsule has been taken.
  • In addition, if desired or necessary, suitable binders, lubricants and disintegrants as well as dyes can likewise be incorporated into the mixture. Suitable binders include starch, gelatine, natural sugars, such as, for example, glucose or beta-lactose, sweeteners made from maize, natural and synthetic rubber, such as, for example, acacia, tragacanth or sodium alginate, carboxymethylcellulose, polyethylene glycol, waxes, and the like. The lubricants used in these dosage forms include sodium oleate, sodium stearate, magnesium stearate, sodium benzoate, sodium acetate, sodium chloride and the like. The disintegrants include, without being restricted thereto, starch, methylcellulose, agar, bentonite, xanthan gum and the like. The tablets are formulated by, for example, preparing a powder mixture, granulating or dry-pressing the mixture, adding a lubricant and a disintegrant and pressing the entire mixture to give tablets. A powder mixture is prepared by mixing the compound comminuted in a suitable manner with a diluent or a base, as described above, and optionally with a binder, such as, for example, carboxymethylcellulose, an alginate, gelatine or polyvinylpyrrolidone, a dissolution retardant, such as, for example, paraffin, an absorption accelerator, such as, for example, a quaternary salt, and/or an absorbant, such as, for example, bentonite, kaolin or dicalcium phosphate. The powder mixture can be granulated by wetting it with a binder, such as, for example, syrup, starch paste, acadia mucilage or solutions of cellulose or polymer materials and pressing it through a sieve. As an alternative to granulation, the powder mixture can be run through a tabletting machine, giving lumps of non-uniform shape, which are broken up to form granules. The granules can be lubricated by addition of stearic acid, a stearate salt, talc or mineral oil in order to prevent sticking to the tablet casting moulds. The lubricated mixture is then pressed to give tablets. The compounds according to the invention can also be combined with a free-flowing inert excipient and then pressed directly to give tablets without carrying out the granulation or dry-pressing steps. A transparent or opaque protective layer consisting of a shellac sealing layer, a layer of sugar or polymer material and a gloss layer of wax may be present. Dyes can be added to these coatings in order to be able to differentiate between different dosage units.
  • Oral liquids, such as, for example, solution, syrups and elixirs, can be prepared in the form of dosage units so that a given quantity comprises a pre-specified amount of the compound. Syrups can be prepared by dissolving the compound in an aqueous solution with a suitable flavour, while elixirs are prepared using a non-toxic alcoholic vehicle. Suspensions can be formulated by dispersion of the compound in a non-toxic vehicle. Solubilisers and emulsifiers, such as, for example, ethoxylated isostearyl alcohols and polyoxyethylene sorbitol ethers, preservatives, flavour additives, such as, for example, peppermint oil or natural sweeteners or saccharin, or other artificial sweeteners and the like, can likewise be added.
  • The dosage unit formulations for oral administration can, if desired, be encapsulated in microcapsules. The formulation can also be prepared in such a way that the release is extended or retarded, such as, for example, by coating or embedding of particulate material in polymers, wax and the like.
  • The compounds of the formula I and salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof can also be administered in the form of liposome delivery systems, such as, for example, small unilamellar vesicles, large unilamellar vesicles and multilamellar vesicles. Liposomes can be formed from various phospholipids, such as, for example, cholesterol, stearylamine or phosphatidylcholines.
  • The compounds of the formula I and the salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof can also be delivered using monoclonal antibodies as individual carriers to which the compound molecules are coupled. The compounds can also be coupled to soluble polymers as targeted medicament carriers. Such polymers may encompass polyvinylpyrrolidone, pyran copolymer, polyhydroxypropylmethacrylamidophenol, polyhydroxyethylaspartamidophenol or polyethylene oxide polylysine, substituted by palmitoyl radicals. The compounds may furthermore be coupled to a class of biodegradable polymers which are suitable for achieving controlled release of a medicament, for example polylactic acid, poly-epsilon-caprolactone, polyhydroxybutyric acid, polyorthoesters, polyacetals, polydihydroxypyrans, polycyanoacrylates and crosslinked or amphipathic block copolymers of hydrogels.
  • Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for transdermal administration can be administered as independent plasters for extended, close contact with the epidermis of the recipient. Thus, for example, the active ingredient can be delivered from the plaster by iontophoresis, as described in general terms in Pharmaceutical Research, 3(6), 318 (1986).
  • Pharmaceutical compounds adapted for topical administration can be formutated as ointments, creams, suspensions, lotions, powders, solutions, pastes, gels, sprays, aerosols or oils.
  • For the treatment of the eye or other external tissue, for example mouth and skin, the formulations are preferably applied as topical ointment or cream. In the case of formulation to give an ointment, the active ingredient can be employed either with a paraffinic or a water-miscible cream base. Alternatively, the active ingredient can be formulated to give a cream with an oil-in-water cream base or a water-in-oil base.
  • Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for topical application to the eye include eye drops, in which the active ingredient is dissolved or suspended in a suitable carrier, in particular an aqueous solvent.
  • Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for topical application in the mouth encompass lozenges, pastilles and mouthwashes.
  • Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for rectal administration can be administered in the form of suppositories or enemas.
  • Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for nasal administration in which the carrier substance is a solid comprise a coarse powder having a particle size, for example, in the range 20-500 microns, which is administered in the manner in which snuff is taken, i.e. by rapid inhalation via the nasal passages from a container containing the powder held close to the nose. Suitable formulations for administration as nasal spray or nose drops with a liquid as carrier substance encompass active-ingredient solutions in water or oil.
  • Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for administration by inhalation encompass finely particulate dusts or mists, which can be generated by various types of pressurised dispensers with aerosols, nebulisers or insufflators.
  • Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for vaginal administration can be administered as pessaries, tampons, creams, gels, pastes, foams or spray formulations.
  • Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for parenteral administration include aqueous and non-aqueous sterile injection solutions comprising antioxidants, buffers, bacteriostatics and solutes, by means of which the formulation is rendered isotonic with the blood of the recipient to be treated; and aqueous and non-aqueous sterile suspensions, which may comprise suspension media and thickeners. The formulations can be administered in single-dose or multidose containers, for example sealed ampoules and vials, and stored in freeze-dried (lyophilised) state, so that only the addition of the sterile carrier liquid, for example water for injection purposes, immediately before use is necessary. Injection solutions and suspensions prepared in accordance with the recipe can be prepared from sterile powders, granules and tablets.
  • It goes without saying that, in addition to the above particularly mentioned constituents, the formulations may also comprise other agents usual in the art with respect to the particular type of formulation; thus, for example, formulations which are suitable for oral administration may comprise flavours.
  • A therapeutically effective amount of a compound of the formula I depends on a number of factors, including, for example, the age and weight of the animal, the precise condition that requires treatment, and its severity, the nature of the formulation and the method of administration, and is ultimately determined by the treating doctor or vet. However, an effective amount of a compound according to the invention is generally in the range from 0.1 to 100 mg/kg of body weight of the recipient (mammal) per day and particularly typically in the range from 1 to 10 mg/kg of body weight per day. Thus, the actual amount per day for an adult mammal weighing 70 kg is usually between 70 and 700 mg, where this amount can be administered as a single dose per day or usually in a series of partdoses (such as, for example, two, three, four, five or six) per day, so that the total daily dose is the same. An effective amount of a salt, solvate, tautomer and stereoisomer thereof can be determined as the fraction of the effective amount of the compound according to the invention per se. It can be assumed that similar doses are suitable for the treatment of other conditions mentioned above.
  • The disclosed compounds of the formula I can be administered in combination with other known therapeutic agents including agents for the treatment of RA (rheumatoid arthritis). As used here, the term “agents for the treatment of RA” relates to any agent which is administered to a patient with RA for the purposes of treating the RA. The medicaments below are preferably, but not exclusively, combined with the compounds of the formula I:
  • 1. NSAIDs (non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs) and analgesics
  • 2. Glucocorticoids (low oral doses)
  • 3. Conventional disease-modifying antirheumatic drugs (DMARDs)
      • Methotrexate
      • Leflunomide
      • Sulfasalazine
      • Hydroxycloroquine
      • Azathioprine
      • Ciclosporin
      • Minocycline
      • Gold
  • 4. Biologic response modifiers (BRMs)-->target molecules/immune cells involved in the inflammatory process, and include the following agents:
      • TNF inhibitors
        • etanercept (Enbrel)
        • infliximab (Remicade)
        • adalimumab (Humira)
      • B-cell-directed therapy
        • rituximab (Rituxan)
      • T-cell/B-cell coactivation signal inhibitor
        • abatacept (Orencia)
      • IL-1 receptor antagonist
        • anakinra (Kineret)
  • MECHANISM OF ACTION
    Golimumab Fully humanized monoclonal
    antibody to TNF
    Certolizumab pegol Anti-TNF agent with just the
    Fab portion attached to the
    polyethylene glycol
    Tocilizumab Humanized monoclonal anti-IL-
    6 antibody that binds to the
    soluble and membrane-
    expresses IL-6 receptor
    Ocrelizumab Humanized-second generation
    anti-CD20 antibody that depletes
    B cells
    Ofatumumab Human monoclonal anti-CD20
    IgG1 antibody
    Denosumab Fully humanized monoclonal
    antibody that binds to and
    inhibits the receptor activator for
    nuclear factor-kB ligand
    TRU-015 New class of CD20-directed
    protein therapeutics
    Oral small molecules Cytoplasmic targets
    (JAK, Syk, MAP kinase
    inhibitors)
    Tolerogens (dnaJP1) Immunotherapy based on T-cell
    tolerization
  • A combined treatment of this type can be achieved with the aid of simultaneous, consecutive or separate dispensing of the individual components of the treatment. Combination products of this type employ the compounds according to the invention.
  • The invention furthermore relates to medicaments comprising at least one compound of the formula I and/or pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, and at least one further medicament active ingredient.
  • The invention also relates to a set (kit) consisting of separate packs of
    • (a) an effective amount of a compound of the formula I and/or pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, and
    • (b) an effective amount of a further medicament active ingredient.
  • The set comprises suitable containers, such as boxes, individual bottles, bags or ampoules. The set may, for example, comprise separate ampoules, each containing an effective amount of a compound of the formula I and/or pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, and an effective amount of a further medicament active ingredient in dissolved or lyophilised form.
  • “Treating” as used herein, means an alleviation, in whole or in part, of symptoms associated with a disorder or disease, or slowing, or halting of further progression or worsening of those symptoms, or prevention or prophylaxis of the disease or disorder in a subject at risk for developing the disease or disorder.
  • The term “effective amount” in connection with a compound of formula (I) can mean an amount capable of alleviating, in whole or in part, symptoms associated with a disorder or disease, or slowing or halting further progression or worsening of those symptoms, or preventing or providing prophylaxis for the disease or disorder in a subject having or at risk for developing a disease disclosed herein, such as inflammatory conditions, immunological conditions, cancer, metabolic conditions, neurodegenerative conditions, chronic infections or conditions treatable or preventable by inhibition of a kinase or a kinase pathway, in one embodiment, the GCN2 pathway. In another embodiment this relates to conditions treatable or preventable by inhibition of a kinase or a kinase pathway, from the group of GCN2, FMS (CSF1R), FLT3 or FLT4 or combinations thereof. In one embodiment an effective amount of a compound of formula (I) is an amount that inhibits a kinase in a cell, such as, for example, in vitro or in vivo. In some embodiments, the effective amount of the compound of formula (I) inhibits the kinase in a cell by 10%, 20%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 90% or 99%, compared to the activity of the kinase in an untreated cell. The effective amount of the compound of formula (I), for example in a pharmaceutical composition, may be at a level that will exercise the desired effect; for example, about 0.005 mg/kg of a subject's body weight to about 10 mg/kg of a subject's body weight in unit dosage for both oral and parenteral administration.
  • Use
  • The present compounds are suitable as pharmaceutical active ingredients for mammals, especially for humans, in the treatment of immune modulatory and stress response kinase-induced diseases. These diseases include neoplastic malignancies including, but without being limited to, solid tumor cancers, cancers of the lymphatic or blood system, the proliferation of tumour cells, pathological neovascularisation (or angiogenesis) which promotes the growth of solid tumours, neurodegenerative diseases (Alzheimer, demyelinating core disorders multiple sclerosis and the like), immune related disorders like arthritis, psoriasis, lupus, or other autoimmune diseases as well as chronic infections.
  • The present invention encompasses the use of the compounds of the formula I and/or physiologically acceptable salts and solvates thereof for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prevention of cancer. Preferred carcinomas for the treatment originate from the group cerebral carcinoma, urogenital tract carcinoma, carcinoma of the lymphatic system, stomach carcinoma, laryngeal carcinoma and lung carcinoma. A further group of preferred forms of cancer are monocytic leukaemia, lung adenocarcinoma, small-cell lung carcinomas, pancreatic cancer, glioblastomas, melanomas and breast carcinoma. A further group of preferred forms of cancer include, but is not limited to, cervical cancer, neuroblastoma, testicular cancer, macroglobulinemia and sarcomas.
  • Also encompassed is the use of the compounds according to Claim 1 according to the invention and/or physiologically acceptable salts and solvates thereof for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prevention of a neurological disorder, particularly a neurodegenerative disease, for example a disease caused by axonal degeneration or by protein plaque deposition. Neurodegenerative diseases include, for example, demyelinating core disorders, such as multiple sclerosis, acute transverse myelitis, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis, Creutzfeldt-Jakob disease or Alzheimer disease.
  • Further encompassed is the use of the compounds according to claim 1 according to the invention and/or physiologically acceptable salts and solvates thereof for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of chronic infections. Such a chronic infection could relate to parasites like leishmania to leprosy or to viral infection by HIV and the like.
  • Further encompassed is the use of the compounds according to claim 1 according to the invention and/or physiologically acceptable salts and solvates thereof for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prevention of a disease in which angiogenesis is implicated.
  • Such a disease in which angiogenesis is implicated is an ocular disease, such as retinal vascularisation, diabetic retinopathy, age-induced macular degeneration and the like.
  • The present invention encompasses the use of the compounds of the formula I and/or physiologically acceptable salts and solvates thereof for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prevention of immune related disorder like ankylosing spondylitis, arthritis, aplastic anemia, Behcet's disease, type 1 diabetes mellitus, graft-versus-host disease, Graves' disease, autoimmune hemolytic anemia, Wegener's granulomatosis, hyper IgE syndrome, idiopathic thrombocytopenia purpura, rheumatoid arthritis, Crohn's disease, multiple sclerosis, Myasthenia gravis, psoriasis, and lupus, among other autoimmune diseases. It might also be used treat organ rejection, bone marrow transplant rejection, non-myeloablative bone marrow transplant rejection, enhance bone marrow engraftment after non-myeloablative conditioning regimens, and combinations thereof
  • Also encompassed is the use of the compounds of the formula I and/or physiologically acceptable salts and solvates thereof for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prevention of a immune-modulatory or stress response kinase-induced disease or a immune-modulatory or stress response kinase-induced condition in a mammal, in which to this method a therapeutically effective amount of a compound according to the invention is administered to a sick mammal in need of such treatment. The therapeutic amount varies according to the specific disease and can be determined by the person skilled in the art without undue effort.
  • The present invention also encompasses the use compounds of the formula I and/or physiologically acceptable salts and solvates thereof for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment or prevention of retinal vascularisation.
  • The expression “immune-modulatory or stress response kinase-induced diseases or conditions” refers to pathological conditions that depend on the activity of one or more immune-modulatory or stress response kinases. immune-modulatory or stress response kinases either directly or indirectly participate in the signal transduction pathways of a variety of cellular activities, including proliferation, adhesion and migration and differentiation. Diseases associated with immune-modulatory or stress response kinase activity include neoplastic malignancies (solid tumor cancers, cancers of the lymphatic or blood system and the like), of neurodegenerative diseases, immune related disorders like arthritis, psoriasis, lupus, multiple sclerosis or other autoimmune diseases as well as chronic infections.
  • The present invention specifically relates to compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, for the use for the treatment of diseases in which the inhibition, regulation and/or modulation inhibition of GCN2 plays a role.
  • The present invention specifically relates to compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, for the use for the inhibition of GCN2.
  • The present invention specifically relates to compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, for the use for the treatment of neoplastic malignancies (solid tumor cancers, cancers of the lymphatic or blood system and the like), of neurodegenerative diseases, immune related disorders like arthritis, psoriasis, lupus, multiple sclerosis or other autoimmune diseases as well as chronic infections.
  • Especial preference is given to the use for the treatment of a disease where the disease is a neoplastic malignancies.
  • The neoplastic malignancies is preferably selected from the group of tumours of the lung, squamous epithelium, the bladder, the stomach, the kidneys, of head and neck, the oesophagus, the cervix, the thyroid, the intestine, the liver, the brain, the prostate, the urogenital tract, the lymphatic system, the stomach and/or the larynx.
  • The neoplastic malignancies is furthermore preferably selected from the group lung adenocarcinoma, small-cell lung carcinomas, pancreatic cancer, glioblastomas, colon carcinoma and breast carcinoma.
  • Preference is furthermore given to the use for the treatment of a neoplastic malignancies of the blood and immune system, preferably for the treatment of a tumour selected from the group of acute myeloid leukaemia, chronic myeloid leukaemia, acute lymphatic leukaemia and/or chronic lymphatic leukaemia.
  • The present invention specifically relates to methods for treating or preventing an inflammatory condition, immunological condition, autoimmune condition, allergic condition, rheumatic condition, thrombotic condition, cancer, infection, neurodegenerative disease, neuroinflammatory disease, cardiovascular disease or metabolic condition, comprising administering to a subject in need thereof an effective amount of a compound of formula I or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, tautomer, stereoisomer or solvate thereof.
  • In another aspect provided herein are methods of inhibiting a kinase in a cell expressing said kinase, comprising contacting said cell with an effective amount of a compound of formula I or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, tautomer, stereoisomer or solvate thereof. In one embodiment the kinase is GCN2 or mutants or isoforms thereof, or combinations of two or more thereof.
  • Representative immunological conditions that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, Behcet's syndrome, non-allergy mast cell diseases (e.g., mastocytosis and treatment of anaphylaxis), ankylosing spondylitis, osteoarthritis, rheumatoid arthritis (RA), multiple sclerosis, lupus, inflammatory bowel disease, ulcerative colitis, Crohn's disease, myasthenia gravis, Grave's disease, transplant rejection, humoral transplant rejection, non-humoral transplant rejection, cellular transplant rejection, immune thrombocytopenic purpura (ITP), idiopathic thrombocytopenic purpura, diabetes, immunological response to bacterial, parasitic, helminth infestation or viral infection, eczema, dermatitis, graft versus host disease, Goodpasture's disease, hemolytic disease of the newborn, autoimmune hemolytic anemia, anti-phospholipid syndrome, ANCA-associated vasculitis, ChurgStrauss syndrome, Wegeners granulomatosus, pemphigus vulgaris, serum sickness, mixed cryoglobulinemia, peripheral neuropathy associated with IgM antibody, microscopic polyangiitis, Hashimoto's thyroiditis, Sjogrens syndrome, fibrosing conditions (such as those dependent on the innate or adaptive immune systems or local mesenchyma cells) or primary biliary cirrhosis.
  • Representative autoimmune conditions that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, autoimmune hemolytic anemia (A1HA), Behcet's syndrome, Crohn's disease, type I diabetes, Goodpasture's disease, Grave's disease, Hashimoto's thyroiditis, idiopathic thrombocytopenic purpura, lupus, multiple sclerosis, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis, myasthenia gravis, pemphigus vulgaris, primary biliary cirrhosis, rheumatoid arthritis, scleroderma, Sjogren's syndrome, ulcerative colitis, or Wegeners granulomatosus.
  • Representative allergic conditions that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, anaphylaxis, hay fever, allergic conjunctivitis, allergic rhinitis, allergic asthma, atopic dermatitis, eczema, urticaria, mucosal disorders, tissue disorders and certain gastrointestinal disorders.
  • Representative rheumatic conditions that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, rheumatoid arthritis, gout, ankylosing spondylitis, or osteoarthritis.
  • Representative inflammatory conditions that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, non-ANCA (anti-neutrophil cytoplasmic autoantibody) vasculitis (e.g., wherein GCN2 function is associated with neutrophil adhesion, diapedesis and/or activation), psoriasis, asthma, allergic rhinitis, allergic conjunctivitis, chronic urticaria, hives, anaphylaxis, bronchitis, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease, cystic fibrosis, inflammatory bowel disease, irritable bowel syndrome, gout, Crohn's disease, mucous colitis, ulcerative colitis, allergy to intestinal antigens (such as gluten enteropathy), diabetes (e.g., Type I diabetes and Type II diabetes) and obesity. In some embodiments, the inflammatory condition is a dermatologic condition, such as, for example, psoriasis, urticaria, hives, eczema, scleroderma, or dermatitis. In other embodiments, the inflammatory condition is an inflammatory pulmonary condition, such as, for example, asthma, bronchitis, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease (COPD), or adult/acute respiratory distress syndrome (ARDS). In other embodiments, the inflammatory condition is a gastrointestinal condition, such as, for example, inflammatory bowel disease, ulcerative colitis, Crohn's disease, idiopathic inflammatory bowel disease, irritable bowel syndrome, or spastic colon.
  • Representative infections that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, bacterial, parasitic, prion, viral infections or helminth infestation.
  • Representative cancers that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, cancer of the head, neck, eye, mouth, throat, esophagus, bronchus, larynx, pharynx, chest, bone, lung, colon, rectum, stomach, prostate, urinary bladder, uterine, cervix, breast, ovaries, testicles or other reproductive organs, skin, thyroid, blood, lymph nodes, kidney, liver, pancreas, brain, central nervous system, solid tumors and blood-borne tumors.
  • Representative cardiovascular diseases that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, restenosis, atherosclerosis and its consequences such as stroke, myocardial infarction, ischemic damage to the heart, lung, gut, kidney, liver, pancreas, spleen or brain.
  • Representative metabolic conditions that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, obesity and diabetes (e.g., Type I and II diabetes). In a particular embodiment, provided herein are methods for the treatment or prevention of insulin resistance. In certain embodiments, provided herein are methods for the treatment or prevention of insulin resistance that leads to diabetes (e.g., Type II diabetes). In another embodiment, provided herein are methods for the treatment or prevention of syndrome X or metabolic syndrome. In another embodiment, provided herein are methods for the treatment or prevention of Type II diabetes, Type I diabetes, slow-onset Type I diabetes, diabetes insipidus (e.g., neurogenic diabetes insipidus, nephrogenic diabetes insipidus, dipsogenic diabetes insipidus, or gestagenic diabetes insipidus), diabetes mellitus, gestational diabetes mellitus, polycystic ovarian syndrome, maturity-onset diabetes, juvenile diabetes, insulin-dependant diabetes, non-insulin dependant diabetes, malnutrition-related diabetes, ketosis-prone diabetes, pre-diabetes (e.g., impaired glucose metabolism), cystic fibrosis related diabetes, hemochromatosis and ketosis-resistant diabetes.
  • Representative neurodegenerative and neuroinflammatory diseases that compounds of formula I are useful for treating or preventing include, but are not limited to, Huntington's disease, Alzheimer's disease, viral (e.g., HIV) or bacterial-associated encephalitis and damage.
  • In another embodiment, provided herein are methods for the treatment or prevention of fibrotic diseases and disorders. In a particular embodiment, provided herein are methods for the treatment or prevention of idiopathic pulmonary fibrosis, myelofibrosis, hepatic fibrosis, steatofibrosis and steatohepatitis.
  • In another embodiment, provided herein are methods for the treatment or prevention of diseases associated with thrombotic events such as but not limited to atherosclerosis, myocardial infarction and ischemic stroke.
  • The present invention specifically relates to compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, for the use for the treatment and/or prevention of inflammatory conditions, immunological conditions, autoimmune conditions, allergic conditions, rheumatic conditions, thrombotic conditions, cancer, infections, neurodegenerative diseases, neuroinflammatory diseases, cardiovascular diseases, and metabolic conditions, the methods comprising administering to a subject in need thereof an effective amount of a compound of claim 1.
  • Moreover, the present invention specifically relates to compounds for the use for the treatment and/or prevention of cancer, where the cancer to be treated is a solid tumour or a tumour of the blood and immune system.
  • Moreover, the present invention specifically relates to compounds, for the use for the treatment and/or prevention of cancer, where the where the tumour originates from the group of acute myeloid leukaemia, chronic myeloid leukaemia, acute lymphatic leukaemia and/or chronic lymphatic leukaemia.
  • Moreover, the present invention specifically relates to compounds, for the use for the treatment and/or prevention of cancer, where the solid tumour originates from the group of tumours of the epithelium, the bladder, the stomach, the kidneys, of head and neck, the esophagus, the cervix, the thyroid, the intestine, the liver, the brain, the prostate, the uro-genital tract, the lymphatic system, the stomach, the larynx, the bones, including chondosarcoma and Ewing sarcoma, germ cells, including embryonal tissue tumours, and/or the lung, from the group of monocytic leukaemia, lung adenocarcinoma, small-cell lung carcinomas, pancreatic cancer, glioblastomas, neurofibroma, angiosarcoma, breast carcinoma and/or maligna melanoma.
  • Moreover, the present invention specifically relates to for the use for the treatment and/or prevention of diseases selected from the group rheumatoid arthritis, systemic lupus, asthma, multiple sclerosis, osteoarthritis, ischemic injury, giant cell arteritis, inflammatory bowel disease, diabetes, cystic fibrosis, psoriasis, Sjögrens syndrom and transplant organ rejection.
  • Moreover, the present invention specifically relates to compounds for the use for the treatment and/or prevention of diseases selected from the group
  • Alzheimer's disease, Down's syndrome, hereditary cerebral hemorrhage with amyloidosis-Dutch Type, cerebral amyloid angiopathy, Creutzfeldt-Jakob disease, frontotemporal dementias, Huntington's disease, Parkinson's disease.
  • Moreover, the present invention specifically relates to compounds for the use for the treatment and/or prevention of diseases selected from the group
  • leishmania, mycobacteria, including M. leprae, M. tuberculosis and/or M. avium, leishmania, plasmodium, human immunodeficiency virus, Epstein Barr virus, Herpes simplex virus, hepatitis C virus.
  • The disclosed compounds of the formula I can be administered in combination with other known therapeutic agents, including anticancer agents. As used here, the term “anticancer agent” relates to any agent which is administered to a patient with cancer for the purposes of treating the cancer.
  • The anti-cancer treatment defined herein may be applied as a sole therapy or may involve, in addition to the compound of the invention, conventional surgery or radiotherapy or chemotherapy. Such chemotherapy may include one or more of the following categories of anti-tumour agents:
  • (i) antiproliferative/antineoplastic/DNA-damaging agents and combinations thereof, as used in medical oncology, such as alkylating agents (for example cis-platin, carboplatin, cyclophosphamide, nitrogen mustard, melphalan, chloroambucil, busulphan and nitrosoureas); antimetabolites (for example antifolates such as fluoropyrimidines like 5-fluorouracil and tegafur, raltitrexed, methotrexate, cytosine arabinoside, hydroxyurea and gemcitabine); antitumour antibiotics (for example anthracyclines, like adriamycin, bleomycin, doxorubicin, daunomycin, epirubicin, idarubicin, mitomycin-C, dactinomycin and mithramycin); antimitotic agents (for example vinca alkaloids, like vincristine, vinblastine, vindesine and vinorelbine, and taxoids, like taxol and taxotere); topoisomerase inhibitors (for example epipodophyllotoxins, like etoposide and teniposide, amsacrine, topotecan, irinotecan and camptothecin) and cell-differentiating agents (for example all-trans-retinoic acid, 13-cis-retinoic acid and fenretinide);
  • (ii) cytostatic agents, such as antioestrogens (for example tamoxifen, toremifene, raloxifene, droloxifene and iodoxyfene), oestrogen receptor downregulators (for example fulvestrant), antiandrogens (for example bicalutamide, flutamide, nilutamide and cyproterone acetate), LHRH antagonists or LHRH agonists (for example goserelin, leuprorelin and buserelin), progesterones (for example megestrol acetate), aromatase inhibitors (for example as anastrozole, letrozole, vorazole and exemestane) and inhibitors of 5α-reductase, such as finasteride;
  • (iii) agents which inhibit cancer cell invasion (for example metalloproteinase inhibitors, like marimastat, and inhibitors of urokinase plasminogen activator receptor function);
  • (iv) inhibitors of growth factor function, for example such inhibitors include growth factor antibodies, growth factor receptor antibodies (for example the anti-erbb2 antibody trastuzumab [Herceptin™] and the anti-erbbI antibody cetuximab [C225]), farnesyl transferase inhibitors, tyrosine kinase inhibitors and serine/threonine kinase inhibitors, for example inhibitors of the epidermal growth factor family (for example EGFR family tyrosine kinase inhibitors, such as N-(3-chloro-4-fluorophenyl)-7-methoxy-6-(3-morpholinopropoxy) quinazolin-4-amine (gefitinib, AZD1839), N-(3-ethynylphenyl)-6,7-bis(2-methoxyethoxy)quinazolin-4-amine (erlotinib, OSI-774) and 6-acrylamido-N-(3-chloro-4-fluorophenyl)-7-(3-morpholinopropoxy)quinazolin-4-amine (Cl 1033)), for example inhibitors of the platelet-derived growth factor family and for example inhibitors of the hepatocyte growth factor family;
  • (v) antiangiogenic agents, such as those which inhibit the effects of vascular endothelial growth factor, (for example the anti-vascular endothelial cell growth factor antibody bevacizumab [Avastin™], compounds such as those disclosed in published international patent applications WO 97/22596, WO 97/30035, WO 97/32856 and WO 98/13354) and compounds that work by other mechanisms (for example linomide, inhibitors of integrin αvβ3 function and angiostatin);
  • (vi) vessel-damaging agents, such as combretastatin A4 and compounds disclosed in international patent applications WO 99/02166, WO 00/40529, WO 00/41669, WO 01/92224, WO 02/04434 and WO 02/08213;
  • (vii) antisense therapies, for example those which are directed to the targets listed above, such as ISIS 2503, an anti-Ras antisense;
  • (viii) gene therapy approaches, including, for example, approaches for replacement of aberrant genes, such as aberrant p53 or aberrant BRCA1 or BRCA2, GDEPT (gene-directed enzyme pro-drug therapy) approaches, such as those using cytosine deaminase, thymidine kinase or a bacterial nitroreductase enzyme, and approaches for increasing patient tolerance to chemotherapy or radiotherapy, such as multi-drug resistance gene therapy; and
  • (ix) immunotherapy approaches, including, for example, ex-vivo and in-vivo approaches for increasing the immunogenicity of patient tumour cells, such as transfection with cytokines, such as interleukin 2, interleukin 4 or granulocyte-macrophage colony stimulating factor, approaches for decreasing T-cell anergy, approaches using transfected immune cells, such as cytokine-transfected dendritic cells, approaches using cytokine-transfected tumour cell lines, and approaches using anti-idiotypic antibodies.
  • The medicaments from Table 1 below are preferably, but not exclusively, combined with the compounds of the formula I.
  • TABLE 1
    Alkylating agents Cyclophosphamide Lomustine
    Busulfan Procarbazine
    Ifosfamide Altretamine
    Melphalan Estramustine phosphate
    Hexamethylmelamine Mechloroethamine
    Thiotepa Streptozocin
    chloroambucil Temozolomide
    Dacarbazine Semustine
    Carmustine
    Platinum agents Cisplatin Carboplatin
    Oxaliplatin ZD-0473 (AnorMED)
    Spiroplatin Lobaplatin (Aetema)
    Carboxyphthalatoplatinum Satraplatin (Johnson
    Tetraplatin Matthey)
    Ormiplatin BBR-3464
    Iproplatin (Hoffrnann-La Roche)
    SM-11355 (Sumitomo)
    AP-5280 (Access)
    Antimetabolites Azacytidine Tomudex
    Gemcitabine Trimetrexate
    Capecitabine Deoxycoformycin
    5-fluorouracil Fludarabine
    Floxuridine Pentostatin
    2-chlorodesoxyadenosine Raltitrexed
    6-Mercaptopurine Hydroxyurea
    6-Thioguanine Decitabine (SuperGen)
    Cytarabine Clofarabine (Bioenvision)
    2-fluorodesoxycytidine Irofulven (MGI Pharrna)
    Methotrexate DMDC (Hoffmann-La
    Idatrexate Roche)
    Ethynylcytidine (Taiho)
    Topoisomerase Amsacrine Rubitecan (SuperGen)
    inhibitors Epirubicin Exatecan mesylate
    Etoposide (Daiichi)
    Teniposide or Quinamed (ChemGenex)
    mitoxantrone Gimatecan (Sigma- Tau)
    Irinotecan (CPT-11) Diflomotecan (Beaufour-
    7-ethyl-10- Ipsen)
    hydroxycamptothecin TAS-103 (Taiho)
    Topotecan Elsamitrucin (Spectrum)
    Dexrazoxanet J-107088 (Merck & Co)
    (TopoTarget) BNP-1350 (BioNumerik)
    Pixantrone (Novuspharrna) CKD-602 (Chong Kun
    Rebeccamycin analogue Dang)
    (Exelixis) KW-2170 (Kyowa Hakko)
    BBR-3576 (Novuspharrna)
    Antitumour Dactinomycin (Actinomycin Amonafide
    antibiotics D) Azonafide
    Doxorubicin (Adriamycin) Anthrapyrazole
    Deoxyrubicin Oxantrazole
    Valrubicin Losoxantrone
    Daunorubicin Bleomycin sulfate
    (Daunomycin) (Blenoxan)
    Epirubicin Bleomycinic acid
    Therarubicin Bleomycin A
    Idarubicin Bleomycin B
    Rubidazon Mitomycin C
    Plicamycinp MEN-10755 (Menarini)
    Porfiromycin GPX-100 (Gem
    Cyanomorpholinodoxo- Pharmaceuticals)
    rubicin
    Mitoxantron (Novantron)
    Antimitotic agents Paclitaxel SB 408075
    Docetaxel (GlaxoSmithKline)
    Colchicine E7010 (Abbott)
    Vinblastine PG-TXL (Cell
    Vincristine Therapeutics)
    Vinorelbine IDN 5109 (Bayer)
    Vindesine A 105972 (Abbott)
    Dolastatin 10 (NCI) A 204197 (Abbott)
    Rhizoxin (Fujisawa) LU 223651 (BASF)
    Mivobulin (Warner- D 24851 (ASTA Medica)
    Lambert) ER-86526 (Eisai)
    Cemadotin (BASF) Combretastatin A4 (BMS)
    RPR 109881A (Aventis) Isohomohalichondrin-B
    TXD 258 (Aventis) (PharmaMar)
    Epothilone B (Novartis) ZD 6126 (AstraZeneca)
    T 900607 (Tularik) PEG-Paclitaxel (Enzon)
    T 138067 (Tularik) AZ10992 (Asahi)
    Cryptophycin 52 (Eli Lilly) !DN-5109 (Indena)
    Vinflunine (Fabre) AVLB (Prescient
    Auristatin PE (Teikoku NeuroPharma)
    Hormone) Azaepothilon B (BMS)
    BMS 247550 (BMS) BNP- 7787 (BioNumerik)
    BMS 184476 (BMS) CA-4-prodrug (OXiGENE)
    BMS 188797 (BMS) Dolastatin-10 (NrH)
    Taxoprexin (Protarga) CA-4 (OXiGENE)
    Aromatase Aminoglutethimide Exemestan
    inhibitors Letrozole Atamestan (BioMedicines)
    Anastrazole YM-511 (Yamanouchi)
    Formestan
    Thymidylate Pemetrexed (Eli Lilly) Nolatrexed (Eximias)
    synthase ZD-9331 (BTG) CoFactor ™ (BioKeys)
    inhibitors
    DNA antagonists Trabectedin (PharmaMar) Mafosfamide (Baxter
    Glufosfamide (Baxter International)
    International) Apaziquone (Spectrum
    Albumin + 32P (Isotope Pharmaceuticals)
    Solutions) O6-benzylguanine
    Thymectacin (NewBiotics) (Paligent)
    Edotreotid (Novartis)
    Farnesyl Arglabin (NuOncology Tipifarnib (Johnson &
    transferase Labs) Johnson)
    inhibitors Ionafarnib (Schering- Perillyl alcohol (DOR
    Plough) BioPharma)
    BAY-43-9006 (Bayer)
    Pump inhibitors CBT-1 (CBA Pharma) Zosuquidar
    Tariquidar (Xenova) trihydrochloride (Eli Lilly)
    MS-209 (Schering AG) Biricodar dicitrate (Vertex)
    Histone acetyl Tacedinaline (Pfizer) Pivaloyloxymethyl butyrate
    transferase SAHA (Aton Pharma) (Titan)
    inhibitors MS-275 (Schering AG) Depsipeptide (Fujisawa)
    Metalloproteinase Neovastat (Aeterna Labo- CMT -3 (CollaGenex)
    inhibitors ratories) BMS-275291 (Celltech)
    Ribonucleoside Marimastat (British Bio- Tezacitabine (Aventis)
    reductase tech) Didox (Molecules for
    inhibitors Gallium maltolate (Titan) Health)
    Triapin (Vion)
    TNF-alpha Virulizin (Lorus Therapeu- Revimid (Celgene)
    agonists/ tics)
    antagonists CDC-394 (Celgene)
    Endothelin-A re- Atrasentan (Abbot) YM-598 (Yamanouchi)
    ceptor antagonists ZD-4054 (AstraZeneca)
    Retinoic acid re- Fenretinide (Johnson & Alitretinoin (Ligand)
    ceptor agonists Johnson)
    LGD-1550 (Ligand)
    Immunomodulators Interferon Dexosome therapy
    Oncophage (Antigenics) (Anosys)
    GMK (Progenics) Pentrix (Australian Cancer
    Adenocarcinoma vaccine Technology)
    (Biomira) JSF-154 (Tragen)
    CTP-37 (AVI BioPharma) Cancer vaccine (Intercell)
    JRX-2 (Immuno-Rx) Norelin (Biostar)
    PEP-005 (Peplin Biotech) BLP-25 (Biomira)
    Synchrovax vaccines (CTL MGV (Progenics)
    Immuno) !3-Alethin (Dovetail)
    Melanoma vaccine (CTL CLL-Thera (Vasogen)
    Immuno)
    p21-RAS vaccine
    (GemVax)
    Hormonal and Oestrogens Prednisone
    antihormonal Conjugated oestrogens Methylprednisolone
    agents Ethynyloestradiol Prednisolone
    chlorotrianisene Aminoglutethimide
    Idenestrol Leuprolide
    Hydroxyprogesterone Goserelin
    caproate Leuporelin
    Medroxyprogesterone Bicalutamide
    Testosterone Flutamide
    Testosterone propionate Octreotide
    Fluoxymesterone Nilutamide
    Methyltestosterone Mitotan
    Diethylstilbestrol P-04 (Novogen)
    Megestrol 2-Methoxyoestradiol
    Tamoxifen (EntreMed)
    Toremofin Arzoxifen (Eli Lilly)
    Dexamethasone
    Photodynamic Talaporfin (Light Sciences) Pd-Bacteriopheophorbid
    agents Theralux (Theratechnolo- (Yeda)
    gies) Lutetium-Texaphyrin
    Motexafin-Gadolinium (Pharmacyclics)
    (Pharmacyclics) Hypericin
    Tyrosine kinase Imatinib (Novartis) Kahalide F (PharmaMar)
    inhibitors Leflunomide(Sugen/ CEP- 701 (Cephalon)
    Pharmacia) CEP-751 (Cephalon)
    ZDI839 (AstraZeneca) MLN518 (Millenium)
    Erlotinib (Oncogene PKC412 (Novartis)
    Science) Phenoxodiol O
    Canertjnib (Pfizer) Trastuzumab (Genentech)
    Squalamine (Genaera) C225 (ImClone)
    SU5416 (Pharmacia) rhu-Mab (Genentech)
    SU6668 (Pharmacia) MDX-H210 (Medarex)
    ZD4190 (AstraZeneca) 2C4 (Genentech)
    ZD6474 (AstraZeneca) MDX-447 (Medarex)
    Vatalanib (Novartis) ABX-EGF (Abgenix)
    PKI166 (Novartis) IMC-1C11 (ImClone)
    GW2016 (GlaxoSmith-
    Kline)
    EKB-509 (Wyeth)
    EKB-569 (Wyeth)
    Various agents SR-27897 (CCK-A inhibi- BCX-1777 (PNP inhibitor,
    tor, Sanofi-Synthelabo) BioCryst)
    Tocladesine (cyclic AMP Ranpirnase (ribonuclease
    agonist, Ribapharm) stimulant, Alfacell)
    Alvocidib (CDK inhibitor, Galarubicin (RNA synthe-
    Aventis) sis inhibitor, Dong-A)
    CV-247 (COX-2 inhibitor, Tirapazamine (reducing
    Ivy Medical) agent, SRI International)
    P54 (COX-2 inhibitor, N-Acetylcysteine (reducing
    Phytopharm) agent, Zambon)
    CapCell ™ (CYP450 R-Flurbiprofen (NF-kappaB
    stimulant, Bavarian Nordic) inhibitor, Encore)
    GCS-IOO (gal3 antagonist, 3CPA (NF-kappaB
    GlycoGenesys) inhibitor, Active Biotech)
    G17DT immunogen (gas- Seocalcitol (vitamin D
    trin inhibitor, Aphton) receptor agonist, Leo)
    Efaproxiral (oxygenator, 131-I-TM-601 (DNA
    Allos Therapeutics) antagonist,
    PI-88 (heparanase inhibi- TransMolecular)
    tor, Progen) Eflornithin (ODC inhibitor,
    Tesmilifen (histamine an- ILEX Oncology)
    tagonist, YM BioSciences) Minodronic acid
    Histamine (histamine H2 (osteoclast inhibitor,
    receptor agonist, Maxim) Yamanouchi)
    Tiazofurin (IMPDH inhibi- Indisulam (p53 stimulant,
    tor, Ribapharm) Eisai)
    Cilengitide (integrin an- Aplidin (PPT inhibitor,
    tagonist, Merck KGaA) PharmaMar)
    SR-31747 (IL-1 antagonist, Rituximab (CD20 antibody,
    Sanofi-Synthelabo) Genentech)
    CCI-779 (mTOR kinase Gemtuzumab (CD33
    inhibitor, Wyeth) antibody, Wyeth Ayerst)
    Exisulind (PDE-V inhibitor, PG2 (haematopoiesis
    Cell Pathways) promoter, Pharmagenesis)
    CP-461 (PDE-V inhibitor, Immunol ™ (triclosan
    Cell Pathways) mouthwash, Endo)
    AG-2037 (GART inhibitor, Triacetyluridine (uridine
    Pfizer) prodrug, Wellstat)
    WX-UK1 (plasminogen SN-4071 (sarcoma agent,
    activator inhibitor, Wilex) Signature BioScience)
    PBI-1402 (PMN stimulant, TransMID-107 ™
    ProMetic LifeSciences) (immunotoxin, KS
    Bortezomib (proteasome Biomedix)
    inhibitor, Millennium) PCK-3145 (apoptosis
    SRL-172 (T-cell stimulant, promoter, Procyon)
    SR Pharma) Doranidazole (apoptosis
    TLK-286 (glutathione-S promoter, Pola)
    transferase inhibitor, Telik) CHS-828 (cytotoxic agent,
    PT-100 (growth factor Leo)
    agonist, Point Therapeu- Trans-retinic acid
    tics) (differentiator, NIH)
    Midostaurin (PKC inhibitor, MX6 (apoptosis promoter,
    Novartis) MAXIA)
    Bryostatin-1 (PKC stimu- Apomine (apoptosis
    lant, GPC Biotech) promoter, ILEX Oncology)
    CDA-II (apoptosis pro- Urocidin (apoptosis
    moter, Everlife) promoter, Bioniche)
    SDX-101 (apoptosis pro- Ro-31-7453 (apoptosis
    moter, Salmedix) promoter, La Roche)
    Ceflatonin (apoptosis pro- Brostallicin (apoptosis
    moter, ChemGenex) promoter, Pharmacia)
  • The disclosed compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically acceptable solvates, salts, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, preferably can be administered in combination with immunmodulators, preferably with anti-PDL-1- or IL-12.
  • Moreover, the present invention relates to compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, for the use for the inhibition of Syk.
  • The present invention specifically relates to compounds of the formula I and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, for the use for the treatment of rheumatoid arthritis, systemic lupus, asthma, allergic rhinitis, ITP, multiple sclerosis, leukemia, breast cancer, maligna melanoma.
  • The present invention specifically relates to methods for treating or preventing an inflammatory condition, immunological condition, autoimmune condition, allergic condition, rheumatic condition, thrombotic condition, cancer, infection, neurodegenerative disease, neuroinflammatory disease, cardiovascular disease or metabolic condition, comprising administering to a subject in need thereof an effective amount of a compound of formula I or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, tautomer, stereoisomer or solvate thereof.
  • The following abbreviations refer respectively to the definitions below: aq (aqueous), h (hour), g (gram), L (liter), mg (milligram), MHz (Megahertz), min. (minute), mm (millimeter), mmol (millimole), mM (millimolar), m.p. (melting point), eq (equivalent), mL (milliliter), L (microliter), ACN (acetonitrile), AcOH (acetic acid), CDCl3 (deuterated chloroform), CD3OD (deuterated methanol), CH3CN (acetonitrile), c-hex (cyclohexane), DCC (dicyclohexyl carbodiimide), DCM (dichloromethane), DIC (diisopropyl carbodiimide), DIEA (diisopropylethyl-amine), DMF (dimethylformamide), DMSO (dimethylsulfoxide), DMSO-d6 (deuterated dimethylsulfoxide), EDC (1-(3-dimethyl-amino-propyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide), ESI (Electro-spray ionization), EtOAc (ethyl acetate), Et2O (diethyl ether), EtOH (ethanol), HATU (dimethylamino-([1,2,3]triazolo[4,5-b]pyridin-3-yloxy)-methylene]-dimethyl-ammonium hexafluorophosphate), HPLC (High Performance Liquid Chromatography), i-PrOH (2-propanol), K2CO3 (potassium carbonate), LC (Liquid Chromatography), MeOH (methanol), MgSO4 (magnesium sulfate), MS (mass spectrometry), MTBE (Methyl tert-butyl ether), NaHCO3 (sodium bicarbonate), NaBH4 (sodium borohydride), NMM (N-methyl morpholine), NMR (Nuclear Magnetic Resonance), PyBOP (benzotriazole-1-yl-oxy-tris-pyrrolidino-phosphonium hexafluorophosphate), RT (room temperature), Rt (retention time), SPE (solid phase extraction), TBTU (2-(1-H-benzotriazole-1-yl)-1,1,3,3-tetramethyluromium tetrafluoro borate), TEA (triethylamine), TFA (trifluoroacetic acid), THF (tetrahydrofuran), TLC (Thin Layer Chromatography), UV (Ultraviolet).
  • Description of the In Vitro Assays
  • GCN2: Assay Principle & Conditions
  • This assay can quantificate the activity of the serin kinase GCN2 (general control non-derepressible-2).
  • This kinase is involved in the stress metabolism of cells. It is activated upon starvation (amino acid depletion). Its natural substrate is eIF2a (eukaryotic initiation factor 2 alpha subunit), a translation factor, which gets activated (phosphorylated) by GCN2 in case of an amino acid bottleneck in the cells. This in turn leads to a halt of the protein synthesis. Inhibition of GCN2 results in stopping this mechanism: The cell can not stop protein production upon “starvation” stress.
  • The assay is run in two steps: the enzymatic reaction and the detection step. In the first step GCN2 is incubated with 10 μM ATP and 80 nM of the GFP-labelled substrate eIF2alpha at room temperature.
  • The enzymatic reaction is stopped by addition of EDTA. The amount of phosphorylated eIF2alpha is determined by TR-FRET (Lanthascreen): A complex is formed consisting of antibody and GFP labelled phospho-eIF2a, which allows a FRET upon exitation at 340 nm.
  • The GCN2-activity is directly proportional to the ratio of fluorescence units at the emission wavelenghth 520 nm (phosphopeptide-sensitive wavelength=emission of GFP) to the units at 495 nm (reference wavelength=emission of Terbium-chelate).
  • Final Concentrations in the Enzymatic Reaction
      • Hepes, pH 7.0 50 mM
      • MgCl2 10 mM
      • MnCl2 5 mM
      • BSA 0.1%
      • DMSO 1%
      • ATP 10 uM
      • DTT 2 mM
      • GFP-eIF2a 80 nM (substrate)
      • GCN2 30 nM (enzyme)
  • Assay Procedure
      • 4 uL enzyme solution (in assay buffer)
      • 1.5 uL compound (in cmpd dilution buffer/6.3% DMSO)
      • Incubation 20 min at RT
      • 4 uL substrate/ATP mix (in assay buffer)
      • Incubation 90 min at RT
      • 10 uL stop/detection mix (in antibody dilution buffer)
      • Incubation 60 min at RT
      • Readout Lanthascreen 340/495/520
  • Cellular Assay for the Determination of Compound Activities
  • Human U2OS cells (2000 cells/well) are seeded into 384-well plates and incubated for 20 hours.
  • The next day, the cells are treated with the test compounds and incubated for 2 hours. Then, tryptophanol, at a final concentration of 600 μM, is added to the cells and those are incubated for 30 minutes.
  • The analysis of cellular GCN2 activities is done by immunocytochemistry. Briefly, cells are fixated on the well surfaces by formaldehyde and permeabilised with Triton X-100. The primary antibody (anti-phospho-eIF2alpha (Ser51, Cell Signalling Technology, #3398) is incubated on the treated cells for 20 hours, followed by a 60 minutes incubation of the secondary antibody (anti-rabbit-IgG-Alexa 488; Molecular Probes #11008).
  • The analysis and quantification of phosphorylated GCN2 is done by scanning the plates in the Acumen Explorer system (TTPLabtech). The obtained data are normalised against the untreated control wells (DMSO only) and expressed as % effect values. The determination of IC50 values is done by using the Graph Pad Prism software.
  • SYK Flash Plate Assay
  • The kinase assay is performed either as 384-well Flashplate assay (for e.g. Topcount measurement) or as 384-well Image-Flashplate assay (for LEADseeker measurement).
  • 2.5 nM SYK, 400 nM Biotin-Aha-Aha-KEDPDYEWPSAKK
  • and 10 μM ATP (spiked with 0.3 μCi 33P-ATP/well) are incubated in a total volume of 50 μl (60 mM Hepes, 10 mM MgCl2, 1.2 mM Dithiothreitol, 0.02% Brij35, 0.1% BSA, pH 7.5) with or without test compound for 1 hours at 30° C. The reaction is stopped with 25 μl 200 mM EDTA. After 30 Min at 30° C. the liquid is removed and each well washed thrice with 100 μl 0.9% sodium chloride solution. Non-specific reaction is determined in presence of 0.1 μM Staurosporine. Radioactivity is measured with Topcount (when using Flashplates) or with LEADseeker (when using Image-Flashplates) respectively. Results (e.g. IC50-values) are calculated with program tools provided by the IT-department (e.g. Symyx Assay Explorer, Genedata Screener).
  • Enzymatic Assays Using the Caliper LifeSciences Technology
  • The assays described here are performed on the Caliper Life Sciences LC3000 system This technology provides data on enzyme activity via measurement of the relative amounts of phosphorylated or unphosphorylated fluorescently labelled substrate peptide at the end of an enzymatic reaction.
  • These different states of peptide are resolved by applying a potential difference across the sample. The presence of the charged phosphate group on the product (as opposed to the substrate) causes a different peptide mobility between the two peptides. This is visualized by excitation of the fluorescent label on the substrate and product peptides and represented as peaks within the analysis software.
  • In order to measure inhibitor activity of kinase inhibitors on this technology, a TTP Mosquito liquid handling instrument is used to place 0.25 ul of the appropriate concentration of inhibitor in 100% DMSO (for a dose response curve calculation) into each well of a 384-well plate. To this reaction components are added to a final volume of 25 ul. The table below indicates the sequences and concentrations for the assays described in this report. Standard components are 1 mM DTT (Sigma, D0632), 1 mM MgCl2 (Sigma, M1028), 100 mM HEPES pH 7.5 (Calbiochem, 391338), 0.015% Brij-35 (Sigma, B4184).
  • Enzyme ATP
    Concen- Concen- Peptide
    tration tration Sequence
    Enzyme (ng/ul) (uM) (@ 1 uM)
    Syk 0.06 5 FITC-AHA-KED
    (BPS Bioscience, PDYEWP
    CA, USA) SAKKK-NH2
  • The reaction is incubated for 90 min at 25 C, and then stopped by the addition of 70 ul of Stop buffer (100 mM HEPES pH 7.5, 0.015% Brij-35, 10 mM EDTA (Sigma, E7889)).
  • The plate is read on a Caliper LC 3000 in an Off-Chip mobility shift assay format, on a 12-sipper chip. Unphosphorylated substrate and phosphorylated product peptide resolve as separate peaks allowing direct measurement of percentage of conversion of substrate to product. The percent conversion can be plotted against concentration of inhibitor to produce a sigmoidal dose response curve, from which an IC50 can be calculated using GeneData Condoseo or a similar product.
  • Cellular Activity Assays
  • 1. BCR Crosslinking-Induced BLNK Phosphorylation
  • Ramos cells incubated overnight in IMDM medium containing 5% FCS were resuspended in IMDM medium without serum (3.3×106 cells/nil). 90 μl of cell suspension (300,000 cells) were incubated with 10 μl of SYK inhibitors (in 3% DMSO) for 20 minutes at 37° C., in 96 well plates. After preincubation with inhibitors, cells were activated with 10 μg/ml of goat antihuman anti-IgM for 10 minutes at 37° C. After stimulation, cells were fixed by addition of 80 μl of 4% paraformaldehyde followed by a 10 minutes incubation at RT and fixed in 0.1% Triton X-100 in PBS. BLNK phosphorylation was detected by flow cytometry after staining of the cells with anti-BLNK-pY84-PE antibodies from BD pharmingen, for 45 minutes at RT.
  • BLNK phosphorylation in CD19+ peripheral blood mononuclear cells (PBMC) isolated from buffy coats of healthy volunteers was performed using the same protocol and staining the cells with a mixture of anti-BLNK-pY84-PE, anti CD-19 PerCp and Anti-IgM APC antibodies from BD Pharmingen.
  • 2. BCR Crosslinking-Induced CD69 Up-Regulation
  • To quantify anti-IgM-induced CD69 up-regulation in peripheral blood mononuclear cells, 90 μl of PBMC cell suspension (containing 1×106 cells) were preincubated with 10 μl of SYK inhibitors (in 3% DMSO) for 1 h at 37° C./5% CO2. After preincubation with inhibitors cells were stimulated with 10 μg/ml of goat antihuman anti-IgM during 18 hours at 37° C./5% CO2. After stimulation cells were stained with a cocktail containing goat IgG (1:200 dilution), CD19-PerCpCy5.5 (5 μl) and CD69-APC (3 μl) antibodies in PBS containing 4% FCS. CD69 expression in CD19+ cells was quantified by flow cytometry.
  • In Vivo Assays
  • CIA
  • For induction of collagen-induced arthritis (CIA) male DBA/1 mice are injected with 500 μl pristane i.p. on day—21. On day 0 mice are immunized with 100 μg chicken collagen type II (CII) in Complete Freund's Adjuvant (CFA) intradermally, distributed over pinnae and one site on the back on day 0. On day 21, mice will receive an i.p. booster immunization (100 μg) with soluble CII in PBS. Dosing of Syk inhibitor will be prophylactic: starting day 0 and continued until day 10 and before boost starting on day 20 and continued until day 30. Compounds will be administered orally twice a day at doses of 3, 10 and 30 mg/kg.
  • Body weight and clinical score will be recorded on a daily basis. Arthritis severity is graded using a clinical scoring system based on the assessment of inflammation in individual paws. The scale for this clinical score ranges from 0-4 for each individual paw.
  • GIA
  • For induction of Glucose-6-phosphate isomerase-induced arthritis (GIA) female DBA/1 mice are immunized with 100 μg G6PI in Complete Freund's Adjuvant (CFA) intradermally, distributed over pinnae and one site on the back on day 0. Dosing of Syk inhibitor will be prophylactic starting day 0 and continued until day 14. Compounds will be administered orally twice a day at doses of 3, 10 and 30 mg/kg.
  • Body weight and clinical score will be recorded on a daily basis. Arthritis severity is graded using a clinical scoring system based on the assessment of inflammation in individual paws. The scale for this clinical score ranges from 0-4 for each individual paw.
  • LCMS:
  • Method A
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 mL/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Method B
  • Method: A—0.1% NH4HCO3 in H2O, B—ACN: Flow—1.0 mL/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), −ve mode
  • 1HNMR:
  • Bruker 400 MHz
  • HPLC:
  • Method A
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 mL/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm).
  • Method B
  • Method: A—0.1% NH4HCO3 in H2O, B—ACN: Flow—1.0 mL/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm).
  • Above and below, all temperatures are indicated in ° C. In the following examples, “conventional work-up” means: water is added if necessary, the pH is adjusted, if necessary, to values between 2 and 10, depending on the constitution of the end product, the mixture is extracted with ethyl acetate or dichloromethane, the phases are separated, the organic phase is dried over sodium sulfate and evaporated, and the residue is purified by chromatography on silica gel and/or by crystallisation. Rf values on silica gel; eluent: ethyl acetate/methanol 9:1.
  • EXAMPLE 1 Synthesis of (4-methanesulfonyl-phenyl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine (“A1”) 1.1 5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00004
  • To a solution of 5-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine (2.0 g, 11.8 mmol) in 1,4-dioxane/water (9:1, 50 mL), 1-methyl-1H-indazole-5yl-boronic acid (3.1 g, 17.7 mmol), 2-dicyclohexylphosphino-2′,4′,6′-triisopropylbiphenyl (0.4 g, 0.7 mmol)), palladium acetate (0.08 g, 0.35 mmol) and potassium carbonate (4.9 g, 35.4 mmol) are added and heated in a pressure tube at 110° C. for 10 h. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 75 mL), the filtrate is concentrated to get the crude product. The crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, MEOH/DCM gradient elution); yield: 42% (1.3 g, yellow solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 266.2 (M+H), RT. 2.2 min, 80.3% (Max), 92.7% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 8.80 (s, 1H), 8.54 (s, 1H), 8.24-8.21 (m, 2H), 8.03-8.01 (m, 1H), 7.82 (d, J=8.84 Hz, 1H), 6.53 (br s, 2H), 4.11 (s, 3H).
  • 1.2 (4-methanesulfonyl-phenyl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine (“A1”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00005
  • To a solution of 5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine (0.1 g, 0.37 mmol) in dry tert-butanol (5 mL), 4-bromophenyl-methylsulfone (0.13 g, 0.56 mmol), 2-dicyclohexylphosphino-2′-(N,N-dimethylamino)biphenyl (0.015 g, 0.04 mmol), tris(dibenzelideneacetone)dipalladium(0) (0.015 g, 0.02 mmol) and lithiumhexamethyldisilylamide (1M/THF) (1.1 mL) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave 150° C. for 90 minutes. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is filtered through celite washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 50 mL), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by flash column chromatography (silica gel, MEOH/DCM gradient elution); yield: 5% (7.7 mg, light brown solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 420.0 (M+H), RT. 3.3 min, 91.6% (Max), 90.7% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm]10.65 (s, 1H), 9.14 (s, 1H), 8.60-8.59 (m, 1H), 8.46 (s, 1H), 8.27-8.26 (m, 1H), 8.13 (dd, J=8.8, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 7.94-7.89 (m, 3H), 7.85-7.83 (m, 2H), 4.14 (s, 3H), 3.14 (s, 3H); HPLC: (Method A) RT 3.3 min, 92.5% (Max), 91.0% (254 nm).
  • The following compounds are synthesized analogously to “A1”:
  • 3-methoxy-phenyl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine (“A2”
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00006
  • Yield: 18% (26 mg, light brown solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 372.2 (M+H), RT. 3.9 min, 98.4% (Max), 99.2% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 10.00 (s, 1H), 9.04 (s, 1H), 8.63 (t, J=0.6 Hz, 1H), 8.39 (s, 1H), 8.23 (d, J=0.8 Hz, 1H), 8.11 (dd, J=8.8, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 7.86 (d, J=8.8 Hz, 1H), 7.51 (t, J=1.8 Hz, 1H), 7.20-7.15 (m, 2H), 6.50-6.47 (m, 1H), 4.13 (s, 3H), 3.70 (s, 3H);
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 3.8 min, 98.5% (Max), 98.4% (254 nm).
  • [5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-pyridin-3-yl-amine (“A3”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00007
  • Yield: 36% (46 mg, light brown solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 343.2 (M+H), RT. 2.3 min, 96.4% (Max), 94.6% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 10.24 (s, 1H), 9.09 (s, 1H), 8.87 (d, J=2.4 Hz, 1H), 8.59 (d, J=0.7 Hz, 1H), 8.42 (s, 1H), 8.25 (d, J=0.7 Hz, 1H), 8.18-8.10 (m, 3H), 7.88 (d, J=8.8 Hz, 1H), 7.35-7.32 (m, 1H), 4.14 (s, 3H);
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 2.3 min, 95.8% (Max), 94.3% (254 nm).
  • [5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-[3-methyl-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-amine (“A4”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00008
  • Yield: 65% (65 mg, pale yellow solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 454.2 (M+H), RT. 3.0 min, 94.5% (Max), 96.2% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3): δ [ppm] 8.95 (s, 1H), 8.55 (s, 1H), 8.26 (s, 1H), 8.15 (s, 1H), 8.06 (dd, J=1.5, 8.8 Hz, 1H), 7.61 (d, J=8.8 Hz, 1H), 7.45 (d, J=2.5 Hz, 1H), 7.39 (dd, J=8.5, 2.6 Hz, 1H), 7.06 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 1H), 6.87 (s, 1H), 4.19 (s, 3H), 2.99-2.93 (m, 4H), 2.57-2.71 (m, 4H), 2.40 (s, 3H), 2.34 (s, 3H);
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 2.9 min, 94.4% (Max), 95.7% (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 2 Synthesis of 3,3-dimethyl-6-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one (“A5”) 2.1 2-(4-bromo-2-nitro-phenyl)-malonic acid dimethyl ester
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00009
  • To a suspension of sodium hydride (60%) (2.13 g, 53.3 mmol) in dry N,N-dimethylformamide (50 mL) at 0° C., a solution of dimethylmalonate (12 mL, 104.2 mmol) in dry N,N-dimethylformamide (20 mL) is added. The reaction mixture is heated to 100° C. for 20 min. 2,5-Dibromonitrobenzene (5 g, 17.8 mmol) in dry N,N-dimethylformamide (20 mL) is added dropwise at RT and is heated to 100° C. for 3 h. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is cooled to 0° C. and quenched with cold water. The reaction mixture is concentrated at high vacuum, the residue is taken in ethylacetate (75 mL), washed with water (2×75 mL), brine, dried over MgSO4 and concentrated to get the crude product. The crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, EA/PE gradient elution); yield: 80% (4.7 g, light orange solid);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 8.30 (d, J=2.16 Hz, 1H), 8.01 (dd, J=8.3, 2.1 Hz, 1H), 7.50 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 1H), 5.49 (s, 1H), 3.69 (s, 6H);
  • LCMS: (Method B) 330.0 (M−H), RT. 5.8 min, 91.1% (Max), 90.8% (254 nm).
  • 2.2 4-bromo-2-nitro-benzoic acid methyl ester
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00010
  • To a solution of 2-(4-bromo-2-nitro-phenyl)-malonic acid dimethyl ester (4.7 g, 14.2 mmol) in DMSO (10 mL), lithium chloride (1.2 g, 28.4 mmol) and water (0.3 mL) are added and heated to 100° C. for 24 h. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is concentrated under high vacuum. The residue is diluted with dichloromethane (50 mL), washed with water, brine, dried over MgSO4 and concentrated to get the crude product. The crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, EA/PE gradient elution); yield: 20% (0.8 mg, light brown solid);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 8.28 (d, J=2.1 Hz, 1H), 7.96 (dd, J=8.2, 2.0 Hz, 1H), 7.54 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H), 4.06 (s, 2H), 3.61 (s, 3H);
  • LCMS: (Method B) 274.0 (M−H), RT. 5.8 min, 94.0% (Max).
  • 2.3 2-(4-bromo-2-nitro-phenyl)-2-methyl-propionic acid methyl ester
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00011
  • To a suspension of sodium hydride (60%) (0.28 g, 7.22 mmol) in dry N,N-dimethylformamide (15 mL) at 0° C., 4-bromo-2-nitro-benzoic acid methyl ester (0.8 g, 2.9 mmol), iodomethane (0.72 mL, 11.5 mmol) and 18-crown-6 (0.8 g, 0.3 mmol) are added and stirred at RT for 2 h. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is cooled to 0° C. and quenched with cold water. The reaction mixture is concentrated at high vacuum, the residue is taken in ethylacetate (30 mL), washed with water (2×30 mL), brine, dried over MgSO4 and concentrated to get the crude product. The crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, EA/PE gradient elution); yield: 91% (0.8 g, brown oil);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 8.14 (d, J=2.2 Hz, 1H), 7.94 (dd, J=8.6, 2.2 Hz, 1H), 7.71 (d, J=8.6 Hz, 1H), 3.53 (s, 3H), 1.56 (s, 6H);
  • LCMS: (Method B) 301.0 (M−H), RT. 6.2 min, 96.3% (Max), 93.5% (254 nm);
  • 2.4 6-bromo-3,3-dimethyl-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00012
  • To a solution of 2-(4-bromo-2-nitro-phenyl)-2-methyl-propionic acid methyl ester (0.6 g, 1.96 mmol) in glacial acetic acid (10 mL), iron powder (0.55 g, 9.8 mmol) is added and heated to 100° C. for 2 h. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is concentrated at high vacuum, diluted with dichloromethane and passed through celite. The filtrate is concentrated to get the crude product. The crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, EA/PE gradient elution); yield: 35% (210 mg, white solid);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 10.45 (s, 1H), 7.24 (d, J=7.9 Hz, 1H), 7.13 (dd, J=7.8, 1.7 Hz, 1H), 6.97 (d, J=1.8 Hz, 1H), 1.22 (s, 6H); LCMS: (Method B) 240.0 (M−H), RT. 5.1 min, 99.5% (Max), 99.0% (254 nm);
  • 2.5 3,3-dimethyl-6-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one (“A5”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00013
  • The compound is obtained analogously to “A1”;
  • yield: 58% (59 mg, yellow solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 425.2 (M+H), RT. 3.6 min, 97.5% (Max), 81.0, 96.6% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 10.31 (s, 1H), 9.98 (s, 1H), 9.03 (s, 1H), 8.59-8.58 (m, 1H), 8.39 (s, 1H), 8.26 (d, J=0.8 Hz, 1H), 8.12 (dd, J=8.8, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 7.88 (d, J=8.8 Hz, 1H), 7.35 (d, J=1.9 Hz, 1H), 7.28 (dd, J=8.1, 2.0 Hz, 1H), 7.16 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 4.14 (s, 3H), 1.21 (s, 6H).
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 3.7 min, 96.8% (Max), 95.3% (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 3 Synthesis of (2-dimethylaminomethyl-1H-benzoimidazol-5-yl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine (“A6”) 3.1 6-bromo-2-chloromethyl-1H-benzoimidazole
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00014
  • To a solution of 4-bromobenzene-1,2-diamine (3 g, 16 mmol) in absolute alcohol (50 mL), ethyl-2-chloroacetimidate hydrochloride (5 g, 32 mmol) is added and stirred at RT for 12 h. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is concentrated under vacuo. The residue is taken in dichloromethane (60 mL), washed with water, brine, dried over MgSO4 and concentrated to get the crude product. The crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, EA/PE gradient elution);
  • yield: 30% (1.2 g, pale brown solid);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 7.76 (s, 1H), 7.52 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 1H), 7.34 (dd, J=8.5, 1.8 Hz, 1H), 4.91 (s, 2H);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 246.0 (M+H), RT. 2.3 min, 97.4% (Max), 97.5% (254 nm).
  • 3.2 (6-bromo-1H-benzoimidazol-2-ylmethyl)-dimethyl-amine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00015
  • To a solution of 6-bromo-2-chloromethyl-1H-benzoimidazole (1.2 g, 4.8 mmol) in dry tetrahydrofuran (20 mL), diethylamine (40%, 5 mL) is added and stirred at RT for 2 h in a sealed tube. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is concentrated under vacuo. The residue is taken in dichloromethane (30 mL), washed with water, brine, dried over MgSO4 and concentrated to get the product;
  • yield: 69% (0.85 g, brown solid);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 13.41 (br s, 1H), 7.95 (s, 1H), 7.68 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 1H), 7.44 (dd, J=8.6, 1.5 Hz, 1H), 5.00 (s, 2H), 3.26 (s, 6H).
  • 3.3 [6-bromo-1-(2-trimethylsilanyl-ethoxymethyl)-1H-benzoimidazol-2-ylmethyl]-dimethyl-amine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00016
  • To a suspension of sodium hydride (60%) (150 mg, 3.8 mmol) in dry N,N-dimethylformamide (15 mL) at 0° C., a solution of (6-bromo-1H-benzoimidazol-2-ylmethyl)-dimethyl-amine (800 mg, 3.17 mmol) in dry N,N-dimethylformamide (10 mL) is added and stirred for 1 h. (2-(Chloromethoxy)ethyl)trimethylsilane (5.4 mL, 30.6 mmol) is added and stirred at RT for 30 min. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is quenched with cold water and concentrated at high vacuum, the residue is taken in ethylacetate, washed with water (2×25 mL), brine (1×25 mL), dried over MgSO4 and concentrated to get the crude product. The crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, MeOH/DCM gradient elution) to get the mixture of regioisomers;
  • yield: 49% (0.6 g, brown gummy solid);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 7.86-7.80 (m, 1H), 7.60-7.55 (m, 1H), 7.35-7.32 (m, 1H), 5.69 (s, 2H), 3.69-3.68 (m, 2H), 3.53-3.48 (m, 2H), 2.20 (s, 6H), 0.84-0.80 (m, 2H), −0.102 (s, 9H);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 384.0 (M+H), RT. 4.5 min, 85.3% (Max), 88.7% (254 nm).
  • 3.4 [2-dimethylaminomethyl-1-(3-trimethylsilanyl-propoxymethyl)-1H-benzoimidazol-5-yl]-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00017
  • The compound is prepared analogously to “A1”;
  • yield: 17% (60 mg, brown liquid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 569.3 (M+H), RT. 3.8, 4.1 min, 34.3, 30.5% (Max).
  • 3.5 (2-dimethylaminomethyl-1H-benzoimidazol-5-yl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine (“A6”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00018
  • To a solution of [2-dimethylaminomethyl-1-(3-trimethylsilanyl-propoxymethyl)-1H-benzoimidazol-5-yl]-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine (60 mg, 0.1 mmol) in dry methanol (3 mL), HCl in methanol (3 mL) is added and stirred at RT for 1 h. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is concentrated and the residue is taken in dichloromethane (15 mL), washed with aqueous NaHCO3 (20%, 15 mL), water (1×15 mL), brine (1×15 mL), dried over MgSO4 and concentrated to get the crude product. The crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, MeOH/DCM gradient elution);
  • yield: 5% (5 mg, yellow solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 439.2 (M+H), RT. 2.5 min, 97.7% (Max), 95.8% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6 δ [ppm] 12.15 (d, J=7.2 Hz, 1H), 9.91-9.80 (m, 1H), 9.02 (s, 1H), 8.65-8.62 (m, 1H), 8.38-8.36 (m, 1H), 8.15-8.12 (m, 1H), 8.04 (s, 1H), 7.97 (d, J=1.6 Hz, 1H), 7.88 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 1H), 7.44-7.41 (m, 1H), 7.36-7.29 (m, 1H), 4.14 (s, 3H), 3.61-3.59 (m, 2H), 2.21 (s, 6H)
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 2.4 min, 93.6% (Max), 92.8% (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 4 Synthesis of 3-(5-quinolin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino)-benzenesulfonamide (“A7”) 4.1 5-quinolin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00019
  • To a solution of 5-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine (1.0 g, 5.9 mmol) in 1,2-dimethoxyethane/water (9:1, 20 mL), 3-quinoline-boronic acid pinacol ester (2.24 g, 8.8 mmol), dikis(triphenylphosphino)palladium(II)chloride (0.2 g, 0.3 mmol) and an aqueous solution of sodium carbonate (2M, 5 mL) are added and irradiated in a microwave at 130° C. for 90 minutes. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 75 mL), the filtrate is concentrated to get the crude product. The crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, MEOH/DCM gradient elution);
  • yield: 55% (0.85 g, light brown solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 263.0 (M+H), RT. 1.7 min, 96.2% (Max), 95.7% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 9.48 (d, J=2.2 Hz, 1H), 9.09 (d, J=2.0 Hz, 1H), 8.91 (s, 1H), 8.42 (s, 1H), 8.13-8.09 (m, 2H), 7.91-7.86 (m, 1H), 7.74-7.70 (m, 1H), 6.61 (br s, 2H).
  • 4.2 3-(5-quinolin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino)-benzenesulfonamide (“A7”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00020
  • The compound is prepared analogously to “A1”;
  • yield: 36% (36 mg, off white solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 418.0 (M+H), RT. 2.7 min, 97.8% (Max), 97.5% (254 nm); 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 10.42 (s, 1H), 9.56 (d, J=2.1 Hz, 1H), 9.21 (d, J=1.9 Hz, 1H), 9.19 (s, 1H), 8.64 (s, 1H), 8.24 (s, 1H), 8.19-8.14 (m, 2H), 7.94-7.90 (m, 2H), 7.75 (t, J=7.3 Hz, 1H), 7.50 (t, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.39 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.34 (s, 2H);
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 2.6 min, 96.9% (Max), 97.1% (254 nm).
  • The following compounds are prepared analogously:
  • [3-methyl-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-(5-quinolin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-amine (“A8”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00021
  • yield: 28% (28 mg, yellow solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 451.2 (M+H), RT. 2.7 min, 97.3% (Max), 96.5% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3): δ [ppm] 9.51 (d, J=2.2 Hz, 1H), 9.08 (d, J=2.1 Hz, 1H), 9.02 (s, 1H), 8.39 (s, 1H), 8.24 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 8.01 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H), 7.90-7.86 (m, 1H), 7.72-7.68 (m, 1H), 7.45-7.42 (m, 2H), 7.07 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 1H), 6.90 (s, 1H), 2.98-2.92 (m, 4H), 2.69-2.61 (m, 4H), 2.41 (s, 3H), 2.33 (s, 3H);
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 2.6 min, 96.7% (Max), 96.2% (254 nm).
  • 3,3-dimethyl-6-(5-quinolin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino)-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one (“A9”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00022
  • yield: 32% (32 mg, pale yellow solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 422.2 (M+H), RT. 3.3 min, 96.5% (Max), 97.3% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 10.30 (s, 1H), 10.02 (s, 1H), 9.55 (d, J=2.20 Hz, 1H), 9.16 (d, J=2.12 Hz, 1H), 9.13 (s, 1H), 8.58 (s, 1H), 8.15 (d, J=8.52 Hz, 2H), 7.92 (dt, J=1.40, 10.77 Hz, 1H), 7.75 (t, J=8.00 Hz, 1H), 7.31-7.29 (m, 2H), 7.16 (d, J=8.64 Hz, 1H), 1.21 (s, 6H);
  • HPLC: (Method B) RT 5.0 min, 94.1% (Max), 92.4% (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 5 Synthesis of (2-dimethylaminomethyl-1H-benzoimidazol-5-yl)-(5-quinolin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-amine (“A10”) 5.1 [2-dimethylaminomethyl-1-(3-trimethylsilanyl-propoxymethyl)-1H-benzoimidazol-5-yl]-(5-quinolin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-amine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00023
  • The compound is prepared analogously to “A1”;
  • yield: 20% (70 mg, brown liquid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 566.2 (M+H), RT. 3.7, 3.9 min, 43.5, 37.3% (Max).
  • 5.2 (2-dimethylaminomethyl-1H-benzoimidazol-5-yl)-(5-quinolin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-amine (“A10”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00024
  • The compound is prepared analogously to “A6”;
  • yield: 10% (9 mg, yellow solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 436.2 (M+H), RT. 2.4 min, 99.2% (Max), 99.5% (254 nm).
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 12.16 (s, 1H), 9.95-9.86 (m, 1H), 9.60-9.57 (m, 1H), 9.25-9.19 (m, 1H), 9.12 (s, 1H), 8.57 (s, 1H), 8.16 (d, J=7.6 Hz, 2H), 7.93-7.90 (m, 2H), 7.75 (t, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.45-7.30 (m, 2H), 3.61-3.59 (m, 2H), 2.22 (s, 6H);
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 2.3 min, 97.1% (Max), 97.0% (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 6 Synthesis of (4-methanesulfonyl-phenyl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine (“A11”) 6.1 5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00025
  • The compound is prepared analogously to “A1”, step 1;
  • yield: 32% (0.8 g, light brown solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 216.2 (M+H), RT. 1.5 min, 99.8% (Max), 99.6% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 8.77 (s, 1H), 8.65 (s, 1H), 8.48 (s, 1H), 8.45 (s, 1H), 6.52 (br s, 2H), 3.96 (s, 3H).
  • 6.2 (4-methanesulfonyl-phenyl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine (“A11”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00026
  • The compound is prepared analogously to “A1”;
  • yield: 29% (50 mg, light brown solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 370.0 (M+H), RT. 2.8 min, 95.8% (Max), 92.6% (220 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm]10.63 (s, 1H), 8.97 (s, 1H), 8.83 (s, 1H), 8.69 (s, 1H), 8.54 (s, 1H), 7.96-7.89 (m, 4H), 4.03 (s, 3H), 3.16 (s, 3H)
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 2.7 min, 94.4% (Max), 90.5% (254 nm).
  • The following compounds are prepared analogously:
  • [5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-pyridin-3-yl-amine (“A12”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00027
  • yield: 24% (33 mg, light brown solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 293.2 (M+H), RT. 1.8 min, 98.8% (Max), 98.3% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 10.22 (s, 1H), 8.92 (s, 1H), 8.89 (d, J=2.6 Hz, 1H), 8.81 (s, 1H), 8.65 (s, 1H), 8.53 (s, 1H), 8.24-8.20 (m, 1H), 8.17 (dd, J=4.6, 1.3 Hz, 1H), 7.42-7.38 (m, 1H), 4.00 (s, 3H);
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 1.8 min, 99.2% (Max), 98.6% (254 nm).
  • 3,3-dimethyl-6-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one (“A13”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00028
  • yield: 66% (70 mg, off white solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 375.2 (M+H), RT. 3.0 min, 97.9% (Max), 96.8% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 10.37 (s, 1H), 9.96 (s, 1H), 8.86 (s, 1H), 8.82 (s, 1H), 8.63 (s, 1H), 8.53 (s, 1H), 7.42 (d, J=1.8 Hz, 1H), 7.27-7.20 (m, 2H), 4.01 (s, 3H), 1.23 (s, 6H);
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 3.3 min, 97.6% (Max), 96.9% (254 nm).
  • 2-dimethylaminomethyl-1H-benzoimidazol-5-yl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine (“A14”
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00029
  • The compound is prepared analogously to “A6”;
  • yield: 11% (11 mg, yellow solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 389.2 (M+H), RT. 2.1 min, 97.5% (Max), 97.3% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3): δ [ppm] 8.84 (s, 1H), 8.65 (s, 1H), 8.41 (s, 1H), 8.30 (s, 1H), 8.11 (d, J=1.8 Hz, 1H), 7.63-7.61 (m, 1H), 7.29 (br s, 1H), 7.12 (s, 1H), 4.11 (s, 3H), 3.97 (s, 2H), 2.51 (s, 6H); HPLC: (Method A) RT 2.2 min, 98.0% (Max), 96.7% (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 7 Synthesis of 5-[5-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one (“A15”) 7.1 5-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00030
  • The compound is prepared analogously to “A1”, step 1;
  • yield: 45% (800 mg, light brown solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 297.2 (M+H), RT. 2.4 min, 89.2% (Max), 93.2% (254 nm);
  • 7.2 5-[5-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one (“A15”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00031
  • The compound is prepared analogously to “A1”;
  • yield: 30% (30 mg, yellow solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 428.2 (M+H), RT. 3.1 min, 97.8% (Max), 96.6% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 10.22 (s, 1H), 9.77 (s, 1H), 8.90 (s, 1H), 8.31 (s, 1H), 8.10 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.66 (s, 1H), 7.48 (dd, J=8.4, 2.2 Hz, 1H), 7.14 (d, J=9.0 Hz, 2H), 6.75 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 3.77 (t, J=5.2 Hz, 4H), 3.49 (s, 2H), 3.29-3.26 (m, 4H);
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 3.3 min, 96.2% (Max), 95.5% (254 nm).
  • The following compounds are prepared analogously:
  • [5-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-pyridin-3-yl-amine (“A16”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00032
  • yield: 20% (26 mg, yellow solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 374.2 (M+H), RT. 2.5 min, 97.1% (Max), 96.8% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm]10.62 (s, 1H), 9.03 (s, 2H), 8.39 (s, 1H), 8.36 (d, J=7.9 Hz, 1H), 8.30 (d, J=4.7 Hz, 1H), 8.09 (d, J=9.0 Hz, 2H), 7.64 (br s, 1H), 7.15 (d, J=9.0 Hz, 2H), 3.78 (t, J=5.0 Hz, 4H), 3.29 (t, J=4.8 Hz, 4H);
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 2.5 min, 98.6% (Max), 98.1% (254 nm).
  • [3-methyl-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-[5-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine (“A17”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00033
  • yield: 37% (37 mg, brown solid);
  • LCMS: (Method A) 485.3 (M+H), RT. 3.1 min, 97.3% (Max), 97.8% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 9.76 (s, 1H), 8.91 (s, 1H), 8.31 (s, 1H), 8.12 (d, J=8.9 Hz, 2H), 7.56 (d, J=2.4 Hz, 1H), 7.50 (dd, J=8.6, 2.5 Hz, 1H), 7.14 (d, J=9.0 Hz, 2H), 7.01 (d, J=8.6 Hz, 1H), 3.78 (t, J=5.0 Hz, 4H), 3.28 (t, J=4.9 Hz, 4H), 3.19-2.69 (m, 8H), 2.53 (s, 3H), 2.25 (s, 3H);
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 3.1 min, 97.2% (Max), 97.8% (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 8 Synthesis of (6-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(4-methoxy-phenyl)-amine (“A18”) 8.1 N-(tert-butoxy carbonyl)-O-(mesitylsulfonyl)-hydroxylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00034
  • To a solution of 2-mesitylene sulphonyl chloride (2.0 g, 0.00914 mol) in dry THF (50 mL) is added N-Boc-hydroxylamine (1.21 g, 0.00914 mol) and cooled to 0° C. under N2 atmosphere. The reaction mixture is stirred for 5 minutes. To this mixture triethylamine (1.1 g, 0.011 mol) is added slowly over 10 minutes. The reaction mixture is stirred for 1 hour 0° C. and then the solvent is removed in vacuo. The residue is dissolved in dichloromethane (50 mL) and washed with water (2×50 mL), 10% aqueous NaHCO3 (50 ml) and dried over MgSO4. It is then concentrated under reduced pressure at room temperature to get the product as an off white solid. (2.1 g, 73%);
  • TLC: Pet ether/Ethyl acetate (8/2) Rf—0.4;
  • 1H NMR (DMSO-d6; 400 MHz): δ [ppm] 11.16 (s, 1H), 7.12 (s, 2H), 2.49 (s, 6H), 2.28 (s, 3H), 1.23 (s, 9H).
  • 8.2 2-[(aminooxy)sulfonyl]-1,3,5-trimethylbenzene
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00035
  • To N-(t-butoxy carbonyl)-O-(mesitylsulfonyl)-hydroxylamine (2.1 g, 0.0066 mol) is added trifluoroacetic acid (20 ml) slowly at 0° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere. The reaction mixture is stirred for 30 minutes and water (60 mL) is added slowly and the reaction mixture is stirred for 15 minutes. The precipitate is filtered and washed several times with water until the pH of the filtrate is neutral. The white solid (1.4 g, 98%) is dried in the Buchner funnel and used immediately for the next reaction.
  • White solid CAUTION: 2-[(amino oxy) sulfonyl]-1,3,5-trimethylbenzene, also known as MSH is highly unstable and reactive compound. It is known to explode when handled in large quantities. This compound should always be prepared in batches and used immediately for next reaction.
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 6.73 (s, 2H), 2.48 (s, 6H), 2.15 (s, 3H).
  • 8.3 1,2-diamino-5-chloro-pyrazinium mesitylenate
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00036
  • To a solution of 5-amino-2-chloro-pyrazine (1.75 g, 13.5 mmol) in dry dichloromethane (75 ml) at 0° C. under N2 atmosphere, 2-[(aminooxy)sulfonyl]-1,3,5-trimethylbenzene (3.36 g, 16.88 mmol) in dry dichloromethane (50 ml) is added dropwise and the reaction mixture is stirred for 3 hours at room temperature. The reaction mixture is concentrated to minimum and diethyl ether (100 ml) is added and stirred for 15 minutes. The precipitate is filtered, washed with diethyl ether to get the product as brown solid (3.2 g, 69.56%);
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 8.99 (br s, 2H), 8.42 (s, 1H), 8.38 (s, 1H), 7.24-7.22 (m, 2H), 6.74 (s, 2H), 2.48 (s, 6H), 2.16 (s, 3H).
  • 8.4 (6-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(4-methoxy-phenyl)-amine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00037
  • To a solution of 3-methoxyphenylisothiocyanate (0.1 g, 5.87 mmol) in dry dichloromethane (25 ml), 1,2-diamino-5-chloro-pyrazinium mesitylenate (2.52 g, 7.34 mmol) and diisopropylethylamine (3.79 g, 29.35 mmol) are added and stirred for an hour. EDCl (2.24 g, 11.74 mmol) is added and stirred for 6 hours. The reaction mixture is taken in water, separated the layer, the organic layer is washed with water, brine, dried over anhydrous MgSO4 and concentrated. The crude product is purified by silica column using (60-120) mesh to get the product as light brown solid (0.55 g, 35.71%);
  • TLC: Chloroform/Methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.3;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 10.01 (s, 1H), 9.31 (d, J=1.16 Hz, 1H), 8.92 (d, J=1.12 Hz, 1H), 7.38 (t, J=2.08 Hz, 1H), 7.25-7.18 (m, 2H), 6.54-6.51 (m, 1H), 3.74 (s, 3H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 276.0);
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.79 area %-96.75 (Max), 97.37 (254 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: X Bridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 3.85 area %-96.68 (Max), 97.02 (254 nm).
  • The following compounds are prepared analogously:
  • 6-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-fluoro-phenyl)-amine (“A19”
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00038
  • yield: 0.5 g, 29.41%; color: light brown solid;
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.3;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 10.31 (s, 1H), 9.35 (d, J=1.24 Hz, 1H), 8.97 (d, J=1.20 Hz, 1H), 7.68 (dt, J=2.32, 7.18 Hz, 1H), 7.42-7.30 (m, 2H), 6.73-6.77 (m, 1H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 264.0)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 4.25 area % 99.07 (Max), 98.26 (254 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: X Bridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 4.11 area % 99.41 (Max), 98.47 (254 nm).
  • 6-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-pyridin-3-yl-amine (“A20”
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00039
  • yield: 0.026 g, 37.08%; color: pale yellow solid;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 10.27 (s, 1H), 9.34 (d, J=1.24 Hz, 1H), 8.97 (d, J=1.20 Hz, 1H), 8.85 (d, J=2.48 Hz, 1H), 8.17-8.13 (m, 2H), 7.37-7.34 (m, 1H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 247.0)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 1.64 area % 97.82 (Max), 96.52 (254 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: X Bridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 1.69 area % 98.07 (Max), 96.67 (254 nm).
  • 6-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(4-fluoro-phenyl)-amine (“A21”
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00040
  • yield: 0.023 g, 49.48%; color: off white solid;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 10.05 (s, 1H), 9.30 (d, J=1.12 Hz, 1H), 8.91 (d, J=1.16 Hz, 1H), 7.71-7.66 (m, 2H), 7.20-7.14 (m, 2H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 264.0);
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.91 area % 99.11 (Max), 98.98 (254 nm).
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: X Bridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 3.99 area % 99.3 (Max), 99.42 (254 nm).
  • 6-bromo-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-methoxy-phenyl)-amine (“A22”
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00041
  • yield: 2.3 g, 60%; color: light brown solid;
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.4;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 10.01 (s, 1H), 9.36 (d, J=1.24 Hz, 1H), 8.91 (d, J=1.20 Hz, 1H), 7.38 (t, J=2.16 Hz, 1H), 7.25-7.18 (m, 2H), 6.54-6.51 (m, 1H), 3.74 (s, 3H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 322.0)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.88 area % 99.12 (Max), 99.46 (254 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: X Bridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 3.93 area % 99.46 (Max), 99.80 (254 nm).
  • 6-cyano-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-methoxy-phenyl)-amine (“A23”
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00042
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 10.22 (s, 1H), 9.83 (d, J=1.16 Hz, 1H), 9.14 (d, J=1.12 Hz, 1H), 7.36 (t, J=1.64 Hz, 1H), 7.25-7.23 (m, 2H), 6.58-6.55 (m, 1H), 3.75 (s, 3H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 267.0)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.67 area % 98.79 (Max), 98.78 (254 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: X Bridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 3.66 area % 99.57 (Max), 96.80 (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 9 Synthesis of (3-methoxy-phenyl)-(6-methyl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-amine (“A24”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00043
  • To a solution of (6-bromo-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-methoxy-phenyl)-amine (0.1 g, 0.31 mmol) in acetonitrile/water (1:1, 8 ml), methyl boronic acid (0.037 g, 0.62 mmol), bis(triphenylphosphino)-dichloropalladium(II) (0.008 g, 0.01 mmol), sodium carbonate (0.09 g, 0.93 mmol) are added and degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave for 30 minutes at 120° C. The reaction mixture is concentrated and diluted with 50% dichloromethane in methanol and passed through celite, the filtrate is concentrated. The crude product is purified by column using silica gel(60-120) mesh to get the product as off white solid(0.052 g, 50.9%);
  • TLC: Pet ether/ethylacetate(7/3) Rf—0.3;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, CDCl3: δ [ppm] 8.93 (d, J=1.32 Hz, 1H), 8.24 (t, J=1.08 Hz, 1H), 7.36-7.34 (m, 2H), 7.29-7.24 (m, 1H), 7.08-7.11 (m, 1H), 6.61-6.58 (m, 1H), 3.86 (s, 3H), 2.60 (d, J=0.60 Hz, 3H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 256.30)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.18 area % 96.51 (Max), 96.80 (254 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: X Bridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 3.19 area % 98.85 (Max), 97.92 (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 10 Synthesis of pyridin-3-yl-(6-pyridin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine (“A25”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00044
  • yield: 0.031 g, 21%; color: light brown solid;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 10.25 (s, 1H), 9.70 (s, 1H), 9.31 (s, 1H), 9.23 (s, 1H), 8.90 (s, 1H), 8.63 (d, J=5.04 Hz, 1H), 8.48 (d, J=6.96 Hz, 1H), 8.18 (t, J=3.80 Hz, 2H), 7.56-7.53 (m, 1H), 7.39-7.36 (m, 1H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 290.0)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.67 area %-95.59 (Max), 95.64 (254 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% NH4HCO3 in H2O, B—ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: X Bridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 3.78 area %-98.22 (Max), 97.67 (254 nm).
  • The following compound is prepared analogously
  • 3-methoxy-phenyl)-(6-o-tolyl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-amine (“A26”
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00045
  • yield: 0.052 g, 50.9%; color: off white solid;
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.4,
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 9.93 (s, 1H), 9.13 (d, J=1.36 Hz, 1H), 9.06 (d, J=1.36 Hz, 1H), 7.49 (d, J=7.24 Hz, 1H), 7.41 (t, J=2.20 Hz, 1H), 7.36-7.27 (m, 4H), 7.21 (t, J=8.12 Hz, 1H), 6.53-6.51 (m, 1H), 3.75 (s, 3H), 2.38 (s, 3H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 332.0)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 4.67 area %-98.38 (Max), 99.78 (254 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: X Bridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 4.78 area %-98.25 (Max), 99.81 (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 10A Synthesis of (3-fluoro-phenyl)-[5-(3-Methoxy-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine 10a.1 6-(3-methoxy-phenyl)-pyrazin-2ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00046
  • To a solution of 2-amino-6-chloropyrazine (0.5 g, 3.85 mmol) in a mixture of toluene/ethanol (4:1, 10 ml), 3-methoxyphenylboronic acid (0.64 g, 4.24 mmol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphino)palladium(0) (0.13 g, 0.11 mmol) and cesium carbonate (2.51 g, 7.71 mmol) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave at 120° C. for 15 minutes. The reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane, the filterate is concentrated and purified by column using silica gel (60-120) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.34 g, 44.15%);
  • TLC: Pet ether/Ethylacetate(7/3) Rf—0.2;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 8.27 (s, 1H), 7.83 (s, 1H), 7.57-7.52 (m, 2H), 7.37 (t, J=7.88 Hz, 1H), 7.00-6.97 (m, 1H), 6.51 (br s, 2H), 3.80 (s, 3H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 202.3)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 2.48 area %-98.79 (Max), 99.35 (254 nm).
  • 10a.2 5-(3-methoxy-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl-amine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00047
  • To a solution of 6-(3-methoxy-phenyl)-pyrazin-2ylamine (0.34 g, 1.68 mmol), in dry dichloromethane (25 ml), ethoxycarbonylisothiocyanate (0.24 g, 1.85 mmol) is added and heated to 50° C. for 16 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated and is taken in a mixture of methanol/ethanol(1:1, 35 ml), hydroxylamine hydrochloride (0.58 g, 8.44 mmol) and diisopropylethylamine (0.65 g, 5.06 mmol) are added and refluxed at 80° C. for 3 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated to minimum and cooled, filtered, washed with water, 20% acetonitrile in diethylether to get the product as yellow solid (0.25 g, 61.42 g).
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 8.82 (s, 1H), 8.21 (s, 1H), 7.59-7.67 (m, 2H), 7.48 (t, J=7.80 Hz, 1H), 7.13 (d, J=7.28 Hz, 1H), 6.53 (br s, 2H), 3.82 (s, 3H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 242.3)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.04 area %-87.06 (Max), 90.54 (254 nm).
  • 10a.3 (3-fluoro-phenyl)-[5-(3-Methoxy-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00048
  • To a solution of 5-(3-methoxy-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl-amine (0.1 g, 0.41 mmol) in dry tert-butanol (5 ml), 3-chloro-1-fluorobenzene (0.0.094 g, 0.82 mmol), tris(dibenzylideneacetone)dipalladium(0) (0.016 g, 0.017 mmol), 2-dicyclohexylphosphino-2′-(N,N-dimethylamino)biphenyl (0.016 g, 0.041 mmol), and sodiumhexamethyldisilylamide (1M/THF) (0.62 ml, 0.62 mmol) are added, degasified briefly and irradiated in microwave at 120° C. for 40 minutes. The reaction mixture is concentrated and directly purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as off white solid (0.05 g, 35.90%);
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.4;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 10.32 (s, 1H), 9.14 (s, 1H), 8.11 (s, 1H), 7.74-7.70 (m, 2H), 7.67-7.65 (m, 1H), 7.53 (t, J=7.88 Hz, 1H), 7.41-7.39 (m, 1H), 7.31 (q, J=8.16 Hz, 1H), 7.19-7.16 (m, 1H), 6.74-6.70 (m, 1H), 3.86 (s, 3H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 336.3)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 4.62 area %-95.42 (Max), 97.75 (254 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: X Bridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 4.61 area %-97.72 (Max), 98.03 (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 11 [5-(4-fluoro-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-pyridin-3-yl-amine (“A27”) is prepared analogously to example 10a 11.1 6-(4-fluoro-phenyl)-pyrazin-2ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00049
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 8.26 (s, 1H), 8.02-8.05 (m, 2H), 7.83 (s, 1H), 7.31-7.27 (m, 2H), 6.52 (br s, 2H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 190.0)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 2.52 area %-96.57 (Max).
  • 11.2 5-(4-fluoro-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00050
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 8.82 (s, 1H), 8.19 (s, 1H), 8.13-8.10 (m, 2H), 7.45-7.40 (m, 2H), 6.55 (br s, 2H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 230.0)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.02 area %-97.52 (Max), 97.50 (220 nm).
  • 11.3 [5-(4-fluoro-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-pyridin-3-yl-amine (“A27”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00051
  • yield: 0.015 g, 11.90%; color: off white solid
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 10.26 (s, 1H), 9.11 (s, 1H), 8.85 (d, J=2.36 Hz, 1H), 8.37 (s, 1H), 8.30-8.13 (m, 4H), 7.49 (t, J=8.84 Hz, 2H), 7.36-7.32 (m, 1H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 307.3)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.67 area %-92.99 (Max), 93.45 (254 nm).
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: X Bridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 2.58 area %-95.92 (Max), 94.84 (254 nm).
  • The following compound is prepared analogously
  • 3-methoxy-phenyl)-(5-phenyl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-amine (“A28”
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00052
  • yield: 0.061 g, 40.99%; color: pale yellow solid;
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.4;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 10.01 (s, 1H), 9.07 (s, 1H), 8.34 (s, 1H), 8.14-8.11 (m, 2H), 7.62-7.59 (m, 3H), 7.51 (t, J=1.20 Hz, 1H), 7.18-7.14 (m, 2H), 6.50-6.48 (m, 1H), 3.72 (s, 3H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 318.3)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 4.46 area % 99.03 (Max), 99.01 (254 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: X Bridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 4.37 area % 96.18 (Max), 97.66 (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 12 N2-(3-fluoro-phenyl)-N6-(3-methoxy-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazine-2,6-diamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00053
  • To a solution of (6-bromo-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-fluoro-phenyl)-amine (0.1 g, 0.31 mmol) in dry 1,4-dioxane (4 ml), m-anisidine (0.034 g, 0.28 mmol), 4,5-bis(diphenylphosphino)-9,9-dimethylxanthene (0.018 g, 0.032 mmol), tris(dibenzylideneacetone)dipalladium(0) (0.14 g, 0.015 mmol), cesium carbonate (0.15 g, 0.46 mmol) were added, briefly degassed, sonicated for 5 minutes and heated in sealed tube at 120° C. for 12 hours. The reaction mixture is passed through celite and washed with 30% methanol in dichloromethane (20 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by column chromatography using silica gel (230-400) mesh to get the product as off white solid (0.144 g, 43.8%);
  • TLC: Pet ether/Ethylacetate (5/5) Rf—0.2.
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 10.05 (s, 1H), 8.89 (s, 1H), 8.86 (d, J=1.36 Hz, 1H), 8.34 (d, J=1.36 Hz, 1H), 7.69 (dt, J=2.32, 7.24 Hz, 1H), 7.40 (dd, J=1.16, 8.26 Hz, 1H), 7.33-7.28 (m, 1H), 7.16 (t, J=8.12 Hz, 1H), 7.01 (t, J=2.24 Hz, 1H), 6.95 (dd, J=1.96, 7.80 Hz, 1H), 6.72-6.68 (m, 1H), 6.47 (dd, J=2.40, 8.12 Hz, 1H), 3.73 (s, 3H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 351.0)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 4.67 area % 99.40 (Max), 98.45 (254 nm).
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: X Bridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 4.67 area % 99.57 (Max), 99.09 (254 nm).
  • The following compound is prepared analogously
  • N6-(4-fluoro-phenyl)-N2-pyridin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazine-2,6-diamine (“A29”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00054
  • yield: 0.014 g, 3.23%; color: pale brown solid;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 10.00 (s, 1H), 8.89 (s, 1H), 8.84 (d, J=2.92 Hz, 2H), 8.28 (d, J=1.24 Hz, 1H), 8.18 (d, J=8.48 Hz, 1H), 8.12 (d, J=4.52 Hz, 1H), 7.42-7.39 (m, 2H), 7.35-7.31 (m, 1H), 7.12 (t, J=6.68 Hz, 2H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 322.0)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 2.81 area % 95.12 (Max), 95.94 (254 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: X Bridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 2.87 area % 96.95 (Max), 95.08 (254 nm).
  • The following compound is prepared analogously to example 10a
  • 3-methoxy-phenyl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine (“A30”
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00055
  • yield: 0.0071 g, 29.72%; color: light brown solid;
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.4;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 9.99 (s, 1H), 8.89 (s, 1H), 8.83 (s, 1H), 8.62 (s, 1H), 8.55 (s, 1H), 7.49-7.48 (m, 1H), 7.25-7.23 (m, 2H), 6.55-6.52 (m, 1H), 3.99 (s, 3H), 3.79 (s, 3H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 323.3)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.33 area %-94.37 (Max), 94.62 (254 nm).
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: X Bridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 3.34 area %-96.30 (Max), 96.75 (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 13 Synthesis of (4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-[5-(1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine (“A31”) 13.1 5-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00056
  • To a solution of 2-amino-6-chloropyrazine (15.0 g, 115.8 mmol) in dry tetrahydrofuran (150 ml), ethoxycarbonylisothiocyante (16.7 g, 127.4 mmol) is added and heated to 50° C. for 12 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated and suspended in ethanol/methanol (1:1, 300 ml), hydroxylamine hydrochloride (40.09 g, 576.9 mmol) and diisopropylethylamine (44.73 g, 346.1 mmol) are added and heated to 80° C. for 3 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated and the crude mass is taken in water and filtered, washed with water, cold acetonitrile, diethylether, to get the product as pale yellow solid (14.0 g, 71.42%);
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.2.
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 8.80 (s, 1H), 8.18 (s, 1H), 6.75 (br s, 2H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 170.0)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—1.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 2.01 area %-99.66 (Max), 99.51 (220 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—1.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 2.02 area %-99.23 (Max), 99.05 (220 nm).
  • 13.2 4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-[1,3,2]dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1-(2-trimethylsilanyl-ethoxymethyl)-1H-pyrazole
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00057
  • To a solution of 1H-pyrazole-4-boronic acid pinacol ester (0.5 g, 2.57 mmol), in tetrahydrofuran/acetonitrile (3:2, 20 ml), 2-(chloromethoxylethyl)trimethylsilane (0.51 g, 3.09 mmol) and cesium carbonate (1.67 g, 5.15 mmol) are added and stirred for 2 hours at room temperature. The reaction mixture is filtered through celite, and concentrated, the crude mass is taken in ethylacetate (30 ml), washed with water, brine solution, dried over anhydrous MgSO4 and concentrated to get the product as brown oil (0.55 g, 65.94%);
  • TLC: Pet ether/ethyl acetate(8/2) Rf—0.5;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 8.08 (s, 1H), 7.64 (s, 1H), 5.40 (s, 2H), 3.48-3.54 (m, 2H), 1.24 (s, 12H), 0.81-0.85 (m, 2H), −0.049 (s, 9H);
  • 13.3 5-[1-(2-trimethylsilanyl-ethoxymethyl)-1H-pyrazol-4-yl]-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00058
  • To a solution of 5-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine (0.3 g, 1.77 mmol) in 1,2-dimethoxyethane/water (9:1, 10 ml), 4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-[1,3,2]dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1-(2-trimethylsilanyl-ethoxymethyl)-1H-pyrazole (0.86 g, 2.66 mmol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine) palladium(0) (0.061 g, 0.05 mmol) and sodium bicarbonate(0.44 g, 5.32 mmol) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave at 120° C. for 45 minutes. The reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as off white solid (0.09 g, 96.77%);
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.2;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 8.97 (s, 1H), 8.69 (s, 1H), 8.56 (s, 1H), 8.55 (s, 1H), 6.55 (br s, 2H), 5.54 (s, 2H), 3.58 (t, J=8.12 Hz, 2H), 0.85 (t, J=8.00 Hz, 2H), −0.051 (s, 9H); LCMS: Mass found (M+, 332.3);
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.92 area %-74.45 (Max).
  • 13.4 (4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-{5-[1-(2-trimethylsilanyl-ethoxymethyl)-1H-pyrazol-4-yl]-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl}-amine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00059
  • To a solution of 5-[1-(2-trimethylsilanyl-ethoxymethyl)-1H-pyrazol-4-yl]-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine(0.09 g, 0.27 mmol) in dry tert-butanol (5 ml), 4-(4-chlorophenyl)-morpholine (0.08 g, 0.40 mmol), 2-dicyclohexylphosphino-2′-(N,N-dimethylamino)biphenyl (0.01 g, 0.03 mmol), tris(dibenzelideneacetone)dipalladium(0) (0.01 g, 0.01 mmol) and sodium hexamethyl disilylamide (1M/THF) (0.4 ml) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave 150° C. for 45 minutes. The reaction mixture is filtered through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 10 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.05 g, 37.59%);
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.3;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 9.73 (s, 1H), 9.02 (s, 1H), 8.86 (s, 1H), 8.65 (s, 1H), 8.62 (s, 1H), 7.62 (d, J=9.04 Hz, 2H), 6.77 (d, J=167.84 Hz, 2H), 5.59-5.58 (m, 2H), 3.74 (t, J=4.92 Hz, 4H), 3.62 (t, J=8.12 Hz, 2H), 3.03 (t, J=4.80 Hz, 4H), 0.86 (t, J=7.84 Hz, 2H), −0.054 (s, 9H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 493.3);
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.98 area %-87.00 (Max), 89.03 (254 nm).
  • 13.5 (4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-[5-(1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine (“A31”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00060
  • To a solution of (4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-{5-[1-(2-trimethylsilanyl-ethoxymethyl)-1H-pyrazol-4-yl]-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl}-amine (0.05 g, 0.1 mmol) in dry methanol (3 ml), HCl in methanol (5 ml) is added and stirred for 12 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated and the crude mass is taken in water (15 ml), neutralized with Na2CO3 and adjusted to pH-8, extracted with dichloromethane, dried over anhydrous MgSO4, concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.004 g, 16.66%);
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 13.54 (s, 1H), 9.69 (s, 1H), 8.89 s, 1H), 8.83 (s, 1H), 8.65 (s, 1H), 8.60 (s, 1H), 7.61 (d, J=9.04 Hz, 2H), 6.96 (d, J=9.08 Hz, 2H), 3.74 (t, J=4.88 Hz, 4H), 3.04 (t, J=4.76 Hz, 4H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 363.3);
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 1.99 Area %-97.48 (Max), 97.97 (254 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 2.04 area %-98.46 (Max), 98.52 (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 14 Synthesis of (4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-(5-quinolin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-amine (“A32”) 14.1 6-quinolin-3-yl-pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00061
  • To a solution of 2-amino-6-chloro-pyrazine (0.3 g, 2.31 mmol) in toluene/ethanol (9:1, 10 ml), quinoline-3-boronic acid pinacol ester (0.65 g, 2.54 mmol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (0.08 g, 0.069 mmol) and cesium carbonate (1.5 g, 4.60 mmol) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave at 130° C. for an hour. The reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.25 g, 49.61%);
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.4;
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 223.0)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 1.67 area %-99.35 (Max).
  • 14.2 5-quinolin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00062
  • To a solution of 6-quinolin-3-yl-pyrazin-2-ylamine (0.25 g, 1.14 mmol) in dry tetrahydrofuran (30 ml), ethoxycarbonylisothiocyante (0.16 g, 1.26 mmol) is added and heated to 50° C. for 12 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated and suspended in ethanol/methanol (1:1, 50 ml), hydroxylamine hydrochloride (0.49 g, 7.08 mmol) and diisopropylethylamine (0.54 g, 4.24 mmol) are added and heated to 80° C. for 6 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated and the crude mass is taken in water and filtered, washed with water, cold acetonitrile and diethylether to get the product as pale yellow solid (0.05 g, 8%);
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.2;
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 263.0)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 1.76 area %-95.72 (Max), 90.35 (254 nm).
  • 14.3 (4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-(5-quinolin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-amine (“A32”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00063
  • To a solution of 5-quinolin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine (0.04 g, 0.15 mmol) in dry tert-butanol (5 ml), 4-(4-chlorophenyl)-morpholine (0.045 g, 0.22 mmol), 2-dicyclohexylphosphino-2′-(N,N-dimethylamino)biphenyl (0.006 g, 0.015 mmol), tris(dibenzelideneacetone)dipalladium(0) (0.006 g, 0.006 mmol) and sodiumhexamethyldisilylamide (1M/THF) (0.23 ml) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave 150° C. for an hour. The reaction mixture is filtered through celite washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 10 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.017 g, 21.6%);
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.3;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 9.77 (s, 1H), 9.57 (d, J=2.24 Hz, 1H), 9.17 (d, J=2.04 Hz, 1H), 9.09 (s, 1H), 8.55 (s, 1H), 8.13-8.16 (m, 2H), 7.91 (dt, J=1.48, 6.94 Hz, 1H), 7.75 (dt, J=1.04, 7.02 Hz, 1H), 7.58 (d, J=9.04 Hz, 2H), 6.91 (d, J=9.08 Hz, 2H), 3.72 (t, J=4.92 Hz, 4H), 3.01 (t, J=4.08 Hz, 4H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 424.3)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 2.49 area %-98.12 (Max), 97.50 (254 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 2.50 area %-97.91 (Max), 97.47 (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 15 Synthesis of (4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-(5-quinolin-6-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-amine (“A33”) 15.1 6-quinolin-6-yl-pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00064
  • To a solution of 2-amino-6-chloro pyrazine (0.25 g, 3.86 mmol) in toluene/ethanol (9:1, 10 ml), 6-quinoline boronic acid pinacol ester (1.08 g, 4.24 mmol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (0.13 g, 0.11 mmol) and cesium carbonate (2.5 g, 7.7 mmol) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave at 130° C. for an hour. The reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.51 g, 59.44%); TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.2;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 8.92 (dd, J=1.68, 4.20 Hz, 1H), 8.62 (d, J=1.88 Hz, 1H), 8.43-8.46 (m, 2H), 8.38 (dd, J=2.00, 8.86 Hz, 1H), 8.09 (d, J=8.84 Hz, 1H), 7.90 (s, 1H), 7.55-7.59 (m, 1H), 6.62 (br s, 2H)
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 223.3)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 1.41 area %-95.35 (Max), 95.76 (254 nm).
  • 15.2 5-quinolin-6-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00065
  • To a solution of 6-quinolin-6-yl-1,2-dihydro-pyrazin-2-ylamine (0.51 g, 2.29 mmol) in dry tetrahydrofuran (20 ml), ethoxycarbonylisothiocyante (0.33 g, 2.52 mmol) is added and heated to 50° C. for 12 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated and suspended in ethanol/methanol (1:1, 50 ml), hydroxylamine hydrochloride (0.79 g, 11.46 mmol) and diisopropylethylamine (0.88 g, 6.87 mmol) are added and heated to 80° C. for 12 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated and the crude mass is taken in water and filtered, washed with water, cold acetonitrile and diethylether to get the product as pale yellow solid (0.45 g, 74.98%);
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.3;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 9.00 (dd, J=1.60, 4.18 Hz, 1H), 8.88 (s, 1H), 8.70 (d, J=1.84 Hz, 1H), 8.49 (d, J=7.68 Hz, 1H), 8.39 (dd, J=2.00, 8.86 Hz, 1H), 8.33 (s, 1H), 8.18 (d, J=8.84 Hz, 1H), 7.62-7.65 (m, 1H), 6.59 (br s, 2H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 263.3)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 1.29 area %-89.08 (Max), 90.99 (254 nm).
  • 15.3 (4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-(5-quinolin-6-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-amine (“A33”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00066
  • To a solution of 5-quinolin-6-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine (0.09 g, 0.34 mmol) in dry tert-butanol (5 ml), 4-(4-chlorophenyl)-morpholine (0.101 g, 0.51 mmol), 2-dicyclohexylphosphino-2′-(N,N-dimethylamino)biphenyl (0.013 g, 0.03 mmol), tris(dibenzelideneacetone)dipalladium(0) (0.013 g, 0.01 mmol) and sodiumhexamethyldisilylamide (1M/THF) (0.51 ml) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave 150° C. for 30 minutes. The reaction mixture is filtered through celite washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 10 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as orange solid (0.024 g, 16.62%);
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.3;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 9.76 (br s, 1H), 9.07 (s, 1H), 9.03 (dd, J=1.76, 4.22 Hz, 1H), 8.78 (d, J=2.00 Hz, 1H), 8.46-8.53 (m, 3H), 8.22-8.24 (m, 1H), 7.65-7.68 (m, 1H), 7.59 (dd, J=2.12, 8.02 Hz, 2H), 6.90-6.92 (m, 2H), 3.72 (t, J=4.92 Hz, 4H), 3.01 (t, J=4.84 Hz, 4H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 424.0)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 2.00 area %-98.18 (Max), 98.12 (254 nm).
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 1.99 area %-99.54 (Max), 99.53 (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 16 Synthesis of 2-methyl-2-{4-[2-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenylamino)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl]-phenyl}-propionitrile (“A34”) 16.1 2-[4-(6-amino-pyrazin-2-yl)-phenyl]-2-methyl-propionitrile
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00067
  • To a solution of 2-amino-6-chloro-pyrazine (0.5 g, 3.86 mmol) in toluene/ethanol (9:1, 10 ml), 4-(1-cyano-1-methylethyl)phenyl boronic acid (0.8 g, 4.24 mmol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (0.13 g, 0.11 mmol) and cesium carbonate (2.5 g, 7.72 mmol) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave at 130° C. for an hour. The reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.63 g, 69.28%); TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.2;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 8.29 (s, 1H), 8.03 (dd, J=1.92, 6.68 Hz, 2H), 7.85 (s, 1H), 7.61 (dd, J=1.88, 6.68 Hz, 2H), 6.54 (br s, 2H), 1.70 (s, 6H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 239.3)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.06 area %-93.86 (Max), 99.39 (254 nm).
  • 16.2 2-[4-(2-amino-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl)-phenyl]-2-methyl-propionitrile
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00068
  • To a solution of 2-[4-(6-amino-pyrazin-2-yl)-phenyl]-2-methyl-propionitrile (0.63 g, 2.67 mmol) in dry tetrahydrofuran (20 ml), ethoxycarbonylisothiocyanate (0.38 g, 2.93 mmol) is added and heated to 50° C. for 12 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated and suspended in ethanol/methanol (1:1, 50 ml), hydroxylamine hydrochloride (1.5 g, 21.68 mmol) and diisopropylethylamine (1.67 g, 12.97 mmol) are added and heated to 80° C. for 3 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated and the crude mass is taken in water and filtered, washed with water, cold acetonitrile and diethylether to get the product as pale yellow solid (0.15 g, 20.21%);
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.3;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 8.83 (s, 1H), 8.20 (s, 1H), 8.08 (dd, J=1.96, 6.62 Hz, 2H), 7.71 (dd, J=1.92, 6.66 Hz, 2H), 6.53 (br s, 2H), 1.75 (s, 6H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 279.3)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.06 area %-96.70 (Max), 95.39 (254 nm).
  • 16.3 2-Methyl-2-{4-[2-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenylamino)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl]-phenyl}-propionitrile (“A34”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00069
  • To a solution of 2-[4-(2-amino-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl)-phenyl]-2-methyl-propionitrile (0.1 g, 0.36 mmol) in dry tert-butanol (5 ml), 4-(4-chlorophenyl)-morpholine (0.106 g, 0.54 mmol), 2-dicyclohexylphosphino-2′-(N,N-dimethylamino)biphenyl (0.014 g, 0.03 mmol), tris(dibenzelidene-acetone)dipalladium(0) (0.014 g, 0.01 mmol) and sodiumhexamethyldisilylamide (1M/THF) (0.54 ml) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave 150° C. for 30 minutes. The reaction mixture is filtered through celite washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 10 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.04 g, 25.39%); TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.3;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 9.73 (s, 1H), 9.02 (s, 1H), 8.33 (s, 1H), 8.17 (dd, J=1.96, 6.70 Hz, 2H), 7.76 (dd, J=1.92, 6.66 Hz, 2H), 7.57 (dd, J=2.08, 7.02 Hz, 2H), 6.92 (d, J=9.12 Hz, 2H), 3.73 (t, J=4.92 Hz, 4H), 3.01 (t, J=4.84 Hz, 4H), 1.77 (s, 6H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 440.3)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.34 area %-98.72 (Max), 99.21 (254 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 3.32 area %-99.05 (Max), 99.61 (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 17 Synthesis of [5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine (“A35”) 17.1 6-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00070
  • To a solution of 2-amino-6-chloro pyrazine (0.5 g, 3.86 mmol) in toluene/ethanol (9:1, 10 ml), 1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-4-boronic acid pinacol ester (0.8 g, 4.24 mmol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (0.13 g, 0.11 mmol) and cesium carbonate (2.5 g, 7.72 mmol) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave at 130° C. for an hour. The reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.51 g, 75.44%);
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.3;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 8.16 (s, 1H), 8.00 (s, 1H), 7.89 (s, 1H), 7.65 (s, 1H), 6.32 (br s, 2H), 3.86 (s, 3H); LCMS: Mass found (M+, 176.0)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—0.6 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 1.09 area %-96.86 (Max).
  • 17.2 5-(1-Methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00071
  • To a solution of 6-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-pyrazin-2-ylamine (0.51 g, 2.94 mmol) in dry tetrahydrofuran (30 ml), ethoxycarbonylisothiocyanate (0.42 g, 3.23 mmol) is added and heated to 50° C. for 12 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated and suspended in ethanol/methanol (1:1, 50 ml), hydroxylamine hydrochloride (1.02 g, 14.72 mmol) and diisopropylethylamine (1.1 g, 8.83 mmol) are added and heated to 80° C. for 3 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated and the crude mass is taken in water and filtered, washed with water, cold acetonitrile and diethylether to get the product as pale yellow solid (0.05 g, 8%); TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.2;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 8.77 (s, 1H), 8.65 (s, 1H), 8.49 (s, 1H), 8.46 (s, 1H), 6.53 (s, 2H), 3.96 (s, 3H);
  • 17.3 [5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine (“A35”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00072
  • To a solution of 5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine(0.05 g, 0.23 mmol) in dry tert-butanol (5 ml), 4-(4-chlorophenyl)-morpholine (0.068 g, 0.34 mmol), 2-dicyclohexylphosphino-2′-(N,N-dimethylamino)biphenyl (0.009 g, 0.023 mmol), tris(dibenzelideneacetone)dipalladium(0) (0.009 g, 0.01 mmol) and sodiumhexamethyldisilylamide (1M/THF) (0.35 ml) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave 150° C. for an hour. The reaction mixture is filtered through celite washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 10 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.012 g, 13.8%); TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.3;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 9.70 (s, 1H), 8.83 (s, 1H), 8.81 (s, 1H), 8.59 (s, 1H), 8.52 (s, 1H), 7.61 (dd, J=2.04, 7.02 Hz, 2H), 6.98 (d, J=9.08 Hz, 2H), 4.01 (s, 3H), 3.74 (t, J=4.88 Hz, 4H), 3.04 (t, J=4.80 Hz, 4H)
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 377.3)
  • Method: A—10 mM NH4HCO3, B—ACN: Flow—1.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 4.13 area %-96.16 (Max), 97.66 (254 nm);
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 2.19 area %-97.26 (Max), 96.49 (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 18 Synthesis of (5-biphenyl-2-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine (“A36”) 18.1 6-biphenyl-2-yl-pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00073
  • To a solution of 2-amino-6-chloro-pyrazine (0.25 g, 1.93 mmol) in toluene/ethanol (9:1, 10 ml), 2-biphenyl boronic acid (0.42 g, 2.13 mmol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (0.067 g, 0.05 mmol) and cesium carbonate (1.25 g, 3.87 mmol) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave at 130° C. for an hour. The reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.3 g, 63.02%);
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.3.
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 7.68 (s, 1H), 7.58-7.55 (m, 1H), 7.44-7.51 (m, 2H), 7.39-7.41 (m, 1H), 7.23-7.32 (m, 3H), 7.12-7.15 (m, 3H), 6.42 (br s, 2H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 248.3)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—0.6 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.54 area %-98.72 (Max).
  • 18.2 5-biphenyl-2-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00074
  • To a solution of 6-biphenyl-2-yl-pyrazin-2-ylamine (0.3 g, 1.21 mmol) in dry tetrahydrofuran (30 ml), ethoxycarbonylisothiocyanate (0.17 g, 1.33 mmol) is added and heated to 50° C. for 12 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated and suspended in ethanol/methanol (1:1, 50 ml), hydroxylamine hydrochloride (0.54 g, 7.94 mmol) and diisopropylethylamine (0.61 g, 4.74 mmol) are added and heated to 80° C. for 3 hours. The reaction mixture is concentrated and the crude mass is taken in water and filtered, washed with water, cold acetonitrile and diethylether to get the product as pale yellow solid (0.3 g, 63.02%);
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.3;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 8.70 (s, 1H), 7.62-7.67 (m, 3H), 7.54-7.57 (m, 2H), 7.19 (dd, J=2.88, 6.30 Hz, 3H), 7.05-7.08 (m, 2H), 6.42 (br s, 2H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 288.3)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.55 area %-78.24 (Max).
  • 18.3 (5-biphenyl-2-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine (“A36”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00075
  • To a solution 5-biphenyl-2-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine (0.046 g, 0.16 mmol) in dry tert-butanol (5 ml), 4-(4-chlorophenyl)-morpholine (0.047 g, 0.24 mmol), 2-dicyclohexylphosphino-2′-(N,N-dimethylamino)biphenyl (0.006 g, 0.016 mmol), tris(dibenzelideneacetone)dipalladium(0) (0.006 g, 0.006 mmol) and sodiumhexamethyldisilylamide (1M/THF) (0.25 ml) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave 150° C. for an hour. The reaction mixture is filtered through celite washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 10 ml), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by silica column using (230-400) mesh to get the product as yellow solid (0.009 g, 11.76%);
  • TLC: chloroform/methanol (9.5/0.5) Rf—0.3;
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 9.58 (s, 1H), 8.90 (s, 1H), 7.86 (s, 1H), 7.67-7.73 (m, 2H), 7.57-7.61 (m, 2H), 7.42 (d, J=9.04 Hz, 2H), 7.12-7.17 (m, 5H), 6.88 (d, J=9.08 Hz, 2H), 3.72 (t, J=4.96 Hz, 4H), 3.00 (t, J=4.84 Hz, 4H);
  • LCMS: Mass found (M+, 449.3)
  • Method: A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—0.1% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm), +ve mode
  • Rt (min): 3.64 area %-94.69 (Max), 96.26 (254 nm).
  • HPLC
  • Method: A—A—0.1% TFA in H2O, B—% TFA in ACN: Flow—2.0 ml/min.
  • Column: XBridge C8 (50×4.6 mm, 3.5 μm)
  • Rt (min): 3.74 area %-96.04 (Max), 97.10 (254 nm).
  • The following compound is prepared analogously
  • 5-biphenyl-2-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(3,5-dimethoxy-phenyl)-amine (“A37”
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00076
  • 1H NMR: 400 MHz, DMSO-d6: δ [ppm] 9.85 (s, 1H), 8.96 (s, 1H), 7.88 (s, 1H), 7.75-7.77 (m, 1H), 7.66-7.68 (m, 1H), 7.57-7.61 (m, 2H), 7.10-7.16 (m, 5H), 6.85 (d, J=2.16 Hz, 2H), 6.06 (t, J=2.08 Hz, 1H), 3.65 (s, 6H).
  • EXAMPLE 19 Synthesis of 5-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one (“A38”) 19.1 5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00077
  • To a solution of 5-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine (2.0 g, 11.8 mmol) in 1,4-dioxane/water (9:1, 50 mL), 1-methyl-1H-indazole-5yl-boronic acid (3.1 g, 17.7 mmol), 2-dicyclohexylphosphino-2′,4′,6′-triisopropylbiphenyl (0.4 g, 0.7 mmol)), palladium acetate (0.08 g, 0.35 mmol) and potassium carbonate (4.9 g, 35.4 mmol) are added and heated in a pressure tube at 110° C. for 10 h. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 75 mL), the filtrate is concentrated to get the crude product. The crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, MEOH/DCM gradient elution); yield: 42% (1.3 g, yellow solid);
  • LCMS: (method A) 266.2 (M+H), RT. 2.2 min, 80.3% (Max), 92.7% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 8.80 (s, 1H), 8.54 (s, 1H), 8.24-8.21 (m, 2H), 8.03-8.01 (m, 1H), 7.82 (d, J=8.84 Hz, 1H), 6.53 (br s, 2H), 4.11 (s, 3H).
  • 19.2 5-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one (“A38”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00078
  • To a solution of 5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine (250 mg, 0.94 mmol) in dry tert-butanol (8 mL), 5-bromo-2-oxindole (298 mg, 1.41 mmol), 2-(dicyclohexylphosphino)-3,6-dimethoxy-2′-4′-6′-tri-i-propyl-1,1′-biphenyl (50 mg, 0.09 mmol), tris(dibenzelideneacetone)dipalladium(0) (35 mg, 0.037 mmol) and sodiumhexamethyldisilylamide (1M/THF) (3 mL) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave 150° C. for 4 h. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is filtered through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 mL), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by flash column chromatography (silica gel, MEOH/DCM gradient elution); yield: 3% (13 mg, yellow solid); LCMS: (Method A) 397.2 (M+H), RT. 2.9 min, 92.1% (Max), 92.7% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 10.21 (s, 1H), 9.81 (s, 1H), 9.00 (s, 1H), 8.64 (d, J=0.7 Hz, 1H), 8.38 (s, 1H), 8.26 (d, J=0.7 Hz, 1H), 8.11 (dd, J=8.8, 1.68 Hz, 1H), 7.87 (d, J=8.8 Hz, 1H), 7.68 (s, 1H), 7.47 (dd, J=2.2, 8.3 Hz, 1H), 6.74 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 4.13 (s, 3H), 3.48 (s, 2H);
  • HPLC: (method A) RT 3.1 min, 96.3% (Max), 94.9% (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 20 Synthesis of 3-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-benzenesulfonamide (“A39”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00079
  • To a solution of 5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine (250 mg, 0.94 mmol) in dry tert-butanol (8 mL), 3-chlorobenzenesulphonamide (271 mg, 1.41 mmol), 2-dicyclohexylphosphino-2′-(N,N-dimethylamino)biphenyl (37 mg, 0.09 mmol), tris(dibenzelideneacetone)dipalladium(0) (36 mg, 0.039 mmol) and sodiumhexamethyldisilylamide (1M/THF) (3 mL) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave 150° C. for 2 h. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is filtered through celite washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 mL), the filtrate is concentrated and purified by flash column chromatography (silica gel, MEOH/DCM gradient elution); yield: 4% (15 mg, off white solid); LCMS: (method A) 421.0 (M+H), RT. 3.1 min, 99.0% (Max), 99.0% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 10.36 (s, 1H), 9.07 (s, 1H), 8.70 (s, 1H), 8.46 (s, 1H), 8.34 (t, J=1.9 Hz, 1H), 8.27 (s, 1H), 8.15 (dd, J=8.9, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 7.88-7.83 (m, 2H), 7.51-7.47 (m, 1H), 7.39-7.38 (m, 1H), 7.32 (br s, 2H), 4.13 (s, 3H);
  • HPLC: (method A) RT 3.0 min, 98.5% (Max), 97.9% (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 21 Synthesis of 2-methyl-2-(4-{2-[3-methyl-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenylamino]-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl}-phenyl)-propionitrile (“A40”) 21.1 2-[4-(6-amino-pyrazin-2-yl)-phenyl]-2-methyl-propionitrile
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00080
  • To a solution of 2-amino-6-chloro-pyrazine (0.5 g, 3.86 mmol) in toluene/ethanol (9:1, 10 mL), 4-(1-cyano-1-methylethyl)phenyl boronic acid (0.8 g, 4.24 mmol), tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (0.13 g, 0.11 mmol) and cesium carbonate (2.5 g, 7.72 mmol) are added, degassed briefly and irradiated in microwave at 130° C. for 1 h. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is passed through celite, washed with dichloromethane/methanol (1:1, 25 ml), the filtrate is concentrated to get the crude product. The crude product is purified by column chromatography (silica gel, PE/EA gradient elution); yield: 69% (0.63 g, yellow solid);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 8.29 (s, 1H), 8.03 (dd, J=6.6, 1.9 Hz, 2H), 7.85 (s, 1H), 7.61 (dd, J=6.6, 1.8 Hz, 2H), 6.54 (br s, 2H), 1.70 (s, 6H);
  • LCMS: (method A) 239.3 (M+H), RT. 3.0 min, 93.8% (Max), 99.3% (254 nm).
  • 21.2 2-[4-(2-Amino-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl)-phenyl]-2-methyl-propionitrile
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00081
  • To a solution of 2-[4-(6-amino-pyrazin-2-yl)-phenyl]-2-methyl-propionitrile (0.63 g, 2.67 mmol) in dry tetrahydrofuran (20 mL), ethoxycarbonylisothiocyante (0.38 g, 2.93 mmol) is added and heated to 50° C. for 12 h. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is concentrated and suspended in ethanol/methanol (1:1, 50 mL), hydroxylamine hydrochloride (1.5 g, 21.6 mmol) and diisopropylethylamine (2.3 mL, 12.9 mmol) are added and heated to 80° C. for 3 hours. After completion of the reaction (monitored by TLC), the reaction mixture is concentrated and the crude mass is taken in water, triturated and filtered, washed with water (2×10 mL), acetonitrile (1×10 mL), diethylether (2×10 mL) to get the product; yield: 20% (0.15 g, yellow solid);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 8.83 (s, 1H), 8.20 (s, 1H), 8.08 (dd, J=6.6, 1.9 Hz, 2H), 7.71 (dd, J=6.6, 1.9 Hz, 2H), 6.53 (br s, 2H), 1.75 (s, 6H);
  • LCMS: (method A) 279.3 (M+H), RT. 3.0 min, 96.7% (Max), 95.3% (254 nm).
  • 21.3 2-methyl-2-(4-{2-[3-methyl-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenylamino]-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl}-phenyl)-propionitrile (“A40”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00082
  • The compound is prepared analogously to “A1”; yield: 16% (49 mg, pale yellow solid);
  • LCMS: (method A) 467.2 (M+H), RT. 3.5 min, 97.6% (Max), 97.2% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 9.77 (s, 1H), 9.04 (s, 1H), 8.35 (s, 1H), 8.18 (dd, J=6.7, 1.8 Hz, 2H), 7.78-7.76 (m, 2H), 7.55 (d, J=2.4 Hz, 1H), 7.44 (dd, J=8.6, 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 1H), 2.77-2.79 (m, 4H), 2.50 (s, 3H), 2.26-2.24 (m, 4H), 2.23 (s, 3H), 1.77 (s, 6H);
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 3.4 min, 96.0% (Max), 96.3% (254 nm).
  • The following compounds are prepared analogously
  • 5-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one (“A41”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00083
  • Yield: 21% (67 mg, yellow solid);
  • LCMS: (method A) 347.2 (M+H), RT. 2.3 min, 95.0% (Max), 96.8% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 10.24 (s, 1H), 9.79 (s, 1H), 8.84 (s, 1H), 8.82 (s, 1H), 8.61 (s, 1H), 8.51 (s, 1H), 7.68 (s, 1H), 7.51 (dd, J=8.4, 2.2 Hz, 1H), 6.81 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 1H), 4.00 (s, 3H), 3.52 (s, 2H);
  • HPLC: (method A) RT 2.3 min, 96.1% (Max), 96.3% (254 nm).
  • 5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-N-(3-methyl-4-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl)phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-amine (“A42”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00084
  • Yield: 22% (83 mg, brown solid); LCMS: (method A) 404.2 (M+H), RT. 2.4 min, 96.1% (Max), 97.5% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 9.76 (s, 1H), 8.84-8.83 (m, 2H), 8.60 (s, 1H), 8.53 (s, 1H), 7.60 (d, J=2.4 Hz, 1H), 7.48 (dd, J=8.5, 2.5 Hz, 1H), 7.05 (d, J=8.6 Hz, 1H), 4.01 (s, 3H), 2.83-2.81 (m, 4H), 2.68-2.52 (m, 4H), 2.30-2.28 (m, 6H);
  • HPLC: (method A) RT 2.7 min, 99.0% (Max), 99.0% (254 nm).
  • N-(3-(2-((3-methyl-4-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl)phenyl)amino)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl)phenyl)methanesulfonamide (“A43”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00085
  • Yield: 22% (71 mg, yellow solid); LCMS: (Method A) 493.2 (M+H), RT. 2.7 min, 96.6% (Max), 97.5% (254 nm);
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ [ppm] 10.04 (br s, 1H), 9.75 (s, 1H), 9.03 (s, 1H), 8.26 (s, 1H), 7.89 (d, J=1.8 Hz, 1H), 7.81 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 7.58 (t, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 7.49-7.46 (m, 2H), 7.42 (dd, J=8.1, 1.3 Hz, 1H), 6.97 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 3.07 (s, 3H), 2.86-2.77 (m, 4H), 2.55 (s, 3H), 2.49-2.25 (m, 4H), 2.22 (s, 3H);
  • HPLC: (Method A) RT 2.8 min, 95.4% (Max), 97.0% (254 nm).
  • EXAMPLE 22 Synthesis of [6-methyl-5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine (“A44”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00086
  • Step 1
  • To 2-amino-6-chloropyrazine (1 eq) in DMSO and water is added at 0° C. NIS (1.1 eq) in 3 portions. The mixture is stirred in the dark for 72 h. The mixture is poured into water, extracted with EtOAc and evaporated. The crude material is purified via flash column chromatography.
  • Step 2
  • 6-Chloro-5-iodo-pyrazin-2-ylamine (1 eq) is dissolved in dioxane under nitrogen. Ethoxycarbonyl isothiocyanate (1.05 eq) is added and the mixture is stirred for 18 h at rt and monitored by HPLC MS. The solvent is removed in vacuum, and the residue washed with cold cyclohexane yielding the desired thiourea as a solid.
  • Step 3
  • Ethyl N-[(6-chloro-5-iodo-pyrazin-2-yl)carbamothioyl]carbamate (1 eq) is given to a mixture of hydroxylammoniumchlorid (5 eq) and N-ethyldiisopropylamine (3 eq) in ethanol. The mixture is stirred for 2 h at rt and then heated to 60° C. for additional 3 h. The reaction is concentrated and the solids are collected by filtration. Washing with cold water and drying in vacuum at 60° C. gives 5-chloro-6-iodo-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine as a solid.
  • Step 4
  • 5-Chloro-6-iodo-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine (1 eq), 2,4,6-trimethyl-cyclotriboroxane (0.8 eq, solution in THF), palladium (II) acetate (0.03 eq), 2-(dicyclohexylphosphino)-2′,4′,6′-triisopropylbiphenyl (0.1 eq) and potassium carbonate are dissolved in a mixture of acetonitrile and water. The mixture is degassed and heated to 150° C. for 1.5 h under microwave irradiation. The solvent is removed in vacuum and the crude material is purified via flash column chromatography.
  • Step 5
  • 5-Chloro-6-methyl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine (1 eq), 1-methyl-4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-[1,3,2]dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole (1.5 eq), palladium (II) acetate (0.03 eq), 2-(dicyclohexylphosphino)-2′,4′,6′-triisopropylbiphenyl (0.1 eq) and potassium carbonate are dissolved in a mixture of acetonitrile and water. The suspension is briefly degassed with nitrogen and heated to 150° C. by microwave irradiation for 30 minutes. Upon completion, the mixture is concentrated and purified via flash column chromatography.
  • Step 6
  • 6-Methyl-5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine (1 eq.) is dissolved in tert. butanol and 4-(4-chloro-phenyl)-morpholine (1.1 eq) is added. The mixture is briefly degassed with nitrogen before chloro[2-(dicyclohexylphosphino)-3,6-dimethoxy-2′-4′-6′-tri-i-propyl-1,1′-biphenyl][2-(2-aminoethyl)phenyl]Pd(II) (0.014 eq) and LHMDS (2 eq) are added. The mixture is stirred for 2 h at 110° C. and monitored by HPLC. Upon completion the reaction is quenched and concentrated. Purification via preparative HPLC gives the title compound as a solid; HPLC-MS purity (method A): 100%, Rt: 1.52 min, observed [M+H]=391.2;
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO) δ [ppm] 9.57-9.52 (s, 1H), 8.83-8.78 (s, 1H), 8.54-8.49 (s, 1H), 8.24-8.19 (d, J=0.8 Hz, 1H), 7.60-7.53 (d, J=9.0 Hz, 2H), 6.96-6.89 (d, J=9.0 Hz, 2H), 4.03-3.98 (s, 3H), 3.78-3.70 (m, 5H), 3.06-2.99 (m, 4H), 2.68-2.63 (s, 4H).
  • The following compounds are prepared analogously
  • [5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-6-phenyl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine (“A45”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00087
  • The title compound is synthesized using the methods described for “A44”, but using benzene boronic acid in step 4;
  • HPLC-MS purity (method A): 100%, Rt: 1.95 min, observed [M+H]=493.2;
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO) δ [ppm] 9.69-9.64 (s, 1H), 8.98-8.93 (s, 1H), 8.21-8.16 (s, 1H), 7.63-7.56 (d, J=8.9 Hz, 2H), 7.53-7.39 (m, 6H), 7.30-7.25 (s, 1H), 6.99-6.91 (d, J=9.1 Hz, 2H), 6.91-6.85 (d, J=5.5 Hz, 1H), 5.99-5.94 (s, 2H), 3.91-3.86 (s, 3H), 3.78-3.71 (m, 4H), 3.07-3.00 (m, 4H).
  • [5,6-Bis-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine (“A46”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00088
  • The title compound is synthesized using the methods described for “A44” using 1-methyl-4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-[1,3,2]dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole in step 4 as coupling partner;
  • HPLC-MS purity (method A): 100%, Rt: 1.49 min, observed [M+H]=457.2;
  • 1H NMR (500 MHz, DMSO) δ [ppm] 9.63-9.59 (s, 1H), 8.97-8.93 (s, 1H), 8.22-8.18 (s, 1H), 7.77-7.73 (s, 1H), 7.71-7.67 (s, 1H), 7.58-7.52 (d, J=9.0 Hz, 2H), 7.35-7.31 (s, 1H), 6.95-6.89 (d, J=9.1 Hz, 2H), 4.00-3.96 (s, 3H), 3.86-3.82 (s, 3H), 3.77-3.71 (m, 4H), 3.05-2.99 (m, 4H).
  • 1-{4-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-phenyl}-cyclopropanecarbonitrile (“A47”)
  • Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00089
  • 5-(1-Methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamine (1 eq) is coupled under Buchwald Hartwig conditions, using chloro[2-(dicyclohexylphosphino)-3,6-dimethoxy-2′-4′-6′-tri-i-propyl-1,1′-biphenyl]2-(2-aminoethyl)phenyl)Pd(II) (0.05 eq) and LHMDS (2 eq) as catalyst and base with 1-(4-chlorophenyl)-1-cyclopropanecarbonitrile (1.5 eq) in tert.-butanol. Usual work up gives the title compound as a solid; HPLC-MS purity (method A): 100%, Rt: 1.90 min, observed [M+H]=357.2;
  • 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO) δ [ppm] 10.10-10.05 (s, 1H), 8.92-8.87 (s, 1H), 8.85-8.80 (s, 1H), 8.66-8.61 (s, 1H), 8.56-8.51 (d, J=0.8 Hz, 1H), 7.79-7.72 (d, J=8.8 Hz, 2H), 7.38-7.31 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 2H), 4.05-4.00 (s, 3H), 1.73-1.65 (m, 2H), 1.49-1.41 (m, 2H).
  • The following compounds are prepared analogously
  • compound
    nr. name/structure
    “A48”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00090
    “A49”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00091
    “A50”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00092
    “A51”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00093
    “A52”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00094
    “A53”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00095
    “A54”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00096
    “A55”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00097
    “A56”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00098
    “A57”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00099
    “A58”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00100
    “A59”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00101
    “A60”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00102
    “A61”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00103
    “A62”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00104
    “A63”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00105
    “A64”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00106
    “A65”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00107
    “A66”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00108
    “A67”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00109
    “A68”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00110
    “A69”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00111
    “A70”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00112
    “A71”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00113
    “A72”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00114
    “A73”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00115
    “A74”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00116
    “A75”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00117
    “A76”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00118
    “A77”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00119
    “A78”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00120
    “A79”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00121
    “A80”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00122
    “A81”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00123
    “A82”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00124
    “A83”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00125
    “A84”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00126
    “A85”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00127
    “A86”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00128
    “A87”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00129
    “A88”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00130
    “A89”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00131
    “A90”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00132
    “A91”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00133
    “A92”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00134
    “A93”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00135
    “A94”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00136
    “A95”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00137
    “A96”
    Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00138
    compound
    nr. 1H NMR; DMSO-d6; δ [ppm]
    “A48” 500 MHz; 9.63 (s, 1H), 8.84 (d, J = 25.6 Hz, 2H), 8.56 (d, J =
    27.7 Hz, 2H), 7.63-7.56 (m, 2H), 7.00-6.91 (m, 2H), 4.41
    (t, J = 6.4 Hz, 2H), 3.50 (t, J = 4.6 Hz, 4H), 3.13-3.04 (m,
    4H), 2.80 (t, J = 6.4 Hz, 2H), 2.59-2.49 (m, 4H), 2.46-2.39
    (m, 4H), 2.27 (s, 3H).
    “A49” 400 MHz; 10.26 (s, 1H), 9.77 (s, 1H), 8.85 (d, J = 11.36 Hz,
    2H), 8.62 (s, 1H), 8.53 (s, 1H), 7.64 (s, 1H), 7.56-7.53 (m,
    1H), 6.80 (d, J = 8.36 Hz, 1H), 4.41 (t, J = 6.40 Hz, 2H), 3.51-
    3.49 (m, 6H), 2.79 (t, J = 6.48 Hz, 2H), 2.44-2.32 (m, 4H).
    “A50” 400 MHz, CDCl3; 8.83 (s, 1H), 8.71 (s, 1H), 8.40 (s, 1H), 8.31
    (s, 1H), 7.49-7.45 (m, 2H), 7.13 (d, J = 8.44 Hz, 1H), 6.89 (s,
    1H), 4.40 (t, J = 6.48 Hz, 2H), 3.68 (t, J = 4.64 Hz, 4H), 3.19-
    3.05 (m, 4H), 2.98-2.74 (m, 6H), 2.47-2.51 (m, 7H), 2.37 (s,
    3H).
    “A51” 400 MHz, CDCl3; 8.81 (s, 1H), 8.69 (s, 1H), 8.39 (s, 1H), 8.28
    (s, 1H), 7.47-7.45 (m, 2H), 7.10 (d, J = 8.56 Hz, 1H), 6.87 (s,
    1H), 4.30 (t, J = 7.56 Hz, 2H), 2.95 (t, J = 4.68 Hz, 4H), 2.68-
    2.51 (m, 4H), 2.42-2.34 (m, 6H), 1.93-1.87 (m, 2H), 1.68-1.63
    (m, 1H), 1.01 (d, J = 6.64 Hz, 6H).
    “A52” 500 MHz; 9.82 (s, 1H), 8.88 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 2H), 8.63 (s, 1H),
    8.56 (s, 1H), 7.76-7.69 (m, 1H), 7.66 (dd, J = 8.4, 2.2 Hz,
    1H), 6.98 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 1H), 4.48-4.29 (m, 2H), 3.59-3.49
    (m, 4H), 3.13 (s, 3H), 2.87-2.74 (m, 4H), 2.49-2.39 (m,
    4H).
    “A53” 500 MHz; 9.42 (s, 1H), 8.73 (s, 1H), 8.26 (s, 1H), 7.96 (s, 1H),
    7.71-7.65 (m, 2H), 7.59 (s, 1H), 7.44 (s, 1H), 6.93-6.86 (m,
    2H), 3.88 (s, 3H), 3.06 (t, J = 4.9 Hz, 4H), 2.26 (s, 3H).
    “A55” 400 MHz; 9.76 (s, 1H), 8.88 (s, 1H), 8.47 (s, 1H), 7.81 (d, J =
    3.28 Hz, 1H), 7.61 (d, J = 9.00 Hz, 2H), 6.97 (d, J = 9.08 Hz,
    2H), 6.54-6.53 (m, 1H), 3.74 (t, J = 4.88 Hz, 4H), 3.04 (t, J =
    4.76 Hz, 4H), 2.47 (s, 3H).
    “A56” 400 MHz, CDCl3; 8.82 (s, 1H), 8.69 ( br s, 1H), 8.38 (s, 1H),
    8.34 (s, 1H), 7.56-7.53 (m, 2H), 7.00 (d, J = 9.60 Hz, 2H),
    6.85 (s, 1H), 4.50-4.35 (m, 2H), 3.90 (t, J = 4.84 Hz, 4H),
    3.80-3.60 (m, 4H), 3.15 (t, J = 4.68 Hz, 4H), 3.00-2.85 (m,
    2H), 2.61-2.48 (m, 4H).
    “A57” 400 MHz; 10.46 (s, 1H), 8.97 (s, 1H), 8.84 (s, 1H), 8.68 (s,
    1H), 8.52 (s, 1H), 8.30 (t, J = 1.72 Hz, 1H), 7.92 (dd, J = 8.36,
    1.44 Hz, 1H), 7.56 (t, J = 8.08 Hz, 1H), 7.40 (d, J = 7.60 Hz,
    1H), 4.01 (s, 3H).
    “A58” 400 MHz; 10.28 (s, 1H), 9.89 (s, 1H), 8.88 (s, 1H), 8.78 (s,
    1H), 8.23 (d, J = 3.84 Hz, 1H), 7.79 (s, 1H), 7.57 (dd, J = 8.42,
    2.16 Hz, 1H), 7.23 (d, J = 3.84 Hz, 1H), 6.80 (d, J = 8.36 Hz,
    1H), 3.83 (s, 2H), 3.62 (t, J = 4.44 Hz, 4H), 3.54 (s, 2H), 2.50-
    2.40 (m, 4H).
    “A59” 400 MHz; 9.75 (s, 1H), 8.85 (s, 1H), 8.80 (s, 1H), 8.60 (s, 1H),
    8.52 (s, 1H), 7.37 (d, J = 2.60 Hz, 1H), 7.13 (dd, J = 8.78,
    2.60 Hz, 1H), 6.83 (d, J = 8.76 Hz, 1H), 4.26-4.24 (m, 2H),
    4.21-4.19 (m, 2H), 3.99 (s, 3H).
    “A60” 400 MHz; 10.29 (s, 1H), 8.93 (s, 1H), 8.85 (s, 1H), 8.66 (s,
    1H), 8.59-8.56 (m, 3H), 7.91-7.85 (m, 4H), 7.71 (d, J = 6.12
    Hz, 2H), 4.03 (s, 3H).
    “A61” 400 MHz; 9.96 (s, 1H), 8.87 (s, 1H), 8.82 (s, 1H), 8.62 (s, 1H),
    8.53 (s, 1H), 7.69 (d, J = 8.48 Hz, 2H), 7.27 (d, J = 8.44 Hz,
    2H), 4.01 (s, 3H), 3.56 (t, J = 4.52 Hz, 4H), 3.40 (s, 2H), 2.38-
    2.30 (m, 4H).
    “A62” 400 MHz, CDCl3; 8.83 (s, 1H), 8.48 (s, 1H), 8.12 (d, J = 3.80
    Hz, 1H), 7.61 (d, J = 8.88 Hz, 2H), 7.21-7.04 (m, 1H), 7.02-
    6.96 (m, 3H), 3.92-3.74 (m, 11H), 3.16 (t, J = 4.68 Hz, 4H),
    2.75-2.05 (m, 3H).
    “A63” 400 MHz; 9.74 (s, 1H), 9.00 (s, 1H), 8.63 (d, J = 2.32 Hz, 1H),
    8.42-8.39 (m, 2H), 7.62-7.56 (m, 3H), 6.92 (d, J = 9.12 Hz,
    2H), 5.01-4.97 (m, 1H), 3.90-3.85 (m ,2H), 3.73 (t, J = 4.96
    Hz, 4H), 3.59-3.54 (m, 2H), 3.01 (t, J = 4.76 Hz, 4H), 2.06-
    2.04 (m, 2H), 1.74-1.66 (m, 2H).
    “A64” 400 MHz; 10.15 (s, 1H), 8.90 (s, 1H), 8.83 (s, 1H), 8.65 (s,
    1H), 8.53 (s, 1H), 7.77 (d, J = 2.44 Hz, 1H), 7.62 (dd, J = 8.90,
    2.52 Hz, 1H), 7.31 (d, J = 8.92 Hz, 1H), 4.01 (s, 3H), 2.31 (s,
    3H).
    “A65” 400 MHz; 9.90 (s, 1H), 9.03 (s, 1H), 8.87 (s, 1H), 8.84 (s, 1H),
    8.62 (s, 1H), 8.53 (d, J = 0.36 Hz, 1H), 7.63 (d, J = 2.32 Hz,
    1H), 7.49 (dd, J = 8.58, 2.44 Hz, 1H), 7.24 (d, J = 8.60 Hz,
    1H), 3.34 (s, 3H), 3.27-3.23 (m, 1H), 2.25-2.18 (m, 5H), 2.14-
    2.10 (m, 2H), 1.94-1.90 (m, 1H), 1.89-1.82 (m, 1H).
    “A66” 400 MHz; 10.28 (s, 1H), 8.92 (s, 1H), 8.83 (s, 1H), 8.66 (s,
    1H), 8.54 (s, 1H), 7.80 (dd, J = 6.90, 1.84 Hz, 2H), 7.45 (dd, J =
    6.94, 1.74 Hz, 2H), 4.02 (s, 3H), 3.65-3.60 (m, 4H), 3.58-
    3.52 (m, 4H).
    “A67” 500 MHz; 9.76 (s, 1H), 8.84 (s, 1H), 8.83 (s, 1H), 8.59 (s,
    1H), 8.54 (s, 1H), 7.48 (d, J = 2.4, 1H), 7.20 (dd, J = 8.6, 2.4,
    1H), 6.91 (d, J = 8.6, 1H), 4.00 (s, 3H), 3.85 (s, 3H), 2.99 (s,
    4H), 2.68 (s, 4H), 2.39 (s, 3H).
    “A68” 400 MHz; 9.88 (s, 1H), 8.85 (d, J = 10.36 Hz, 2H), 8.61 (s,
    1H), 8.54 (s, 1H), 7.60 (s, 1H), 7.47 (d, J = 8.20 Hz, 1H), 7.17
    (d, J = 8.24 Hz, 1H), 4.01 (s, 3H), 3.58-3.50 (m, 4H), 3.35-
    3.28 (m, 2H), 2.40-2.30 (m, 7H).
    “A69” 400 MHz; 10.11 (s, 1H), 8.91 (s, 1H), 8.84 (s, 1H), 8.64 (s,
    1H), 8.55 (s, 1H), 8.18 (t, J = 5.76 Hz, 1H), 7.64 (s, 1H), 7.57
    (dd, J = 8.38, 1.96 Hz, 1H), 7.36 (d, J = 8.36 Hz, 1H), 4.01 (s,
    3H), 3.15-3.08 (m, 2H), 2.41 (s, 3H), 1.03-0.98 (m, 1H), 0.45-
    0.40 (m, 2H), 0.24-0.20 (m, 2H).
    “A70” 400 MHz; 10.34 (s, 1H), 8.93 (s, 1H), 8.86 (s, 1H), 8.65 (s,
    1H), 8.55 (s, 1H), 8.10 (t, J = 5.80 Hz, 1H), 7.87 (d, J = 8.56
    Hz, 1H), 7.68 (d, J = 1.68 Hz, 1H), 7.30 (dd, J = 8.60, 1.80 Hz,
    1H), 4.00 (s, 6H), 3.18 (t, J = 5.96 Hz, 2H), 1.06-1.03 (m, 1H),
    0.45-0.41 (m, 2H), 0.35-0.20 (m, 2H).
    “A71” 400 MHz; 10.10 (s, 1H), 8.90 (d, J = 1.52 Hz, 1H), 8.83 (s,
    1H), 8.64 (d, J = 1.44 Hz, 1H), 8.54 (d, J = 0.88 Hz, 1H), 8.14
    (d, J = 3.28 Hz, 1H), 7.62 (s, 1H), 7.55 (d, J = 8.32 Hz, 1H),
    7.33 (d, J = 8.40 Hz, 1H), 4.01 (s, 3H), 2.81-2.80 (m, 1H),
    2.38 (s, 3H), 0.67-0.65 (m, 2H), 0.52-0.50 (m, 2H).
    “A72” 400 MHz; 10.32 (s, 1H), 8.92 (s, 1H), 8.84 (s, 1H), 8.64 (s,
    1H), 8.54 (s, 1H), 7.92 (d, J = 4.08 Hz, 1H), 7.80 (d, J = 8.56
    Hz, 1H), 7.65 (d, J = 1.64 Hz, 1H), 7.29 (dd, J = 8.56, 1.72 Hz,
    1H), 3.99 (s, 3H), 3.95 (s, 3H), 2.84-2.80 (m, 1H), 0.70-0.67
    (m, 2H), 0.56-0.53 (m, 2H).
    “A73” 400 MHz; 10.12 (s, 1H), 8.90 (s, 1H), 8.84 (s, 1H), 8.64 (s,
    1H), 8.54 (s, 1H), 7.69 (d, J = 1.88 Hz, 1H), 7.58 (dd, J = 8.32,
    2.08 Hz, 1H), 7.17 (d, J = 8.32 Hz, 1H), 4.01 (s, 3H), 3.70-
    3.64 (m, 4H), 3.55-3.46 (m, 2H), 3.25-3.17 (m, 2H), 2.26 (s,
    3H).
    “A74” 400 MHz; 11.20 (br s, 1H), 9.01 (s, 1H), 8.85 (s, 1H), 8.73 (s,
    1H), 8.58 (s, 1H), 3.99 (s, 3H), 3.18-3.15 (m, 2H), 2.74-2.68
    (m, 2H), 1.88 (d, J = 11.00 Hz, 2H), 1.70-1.66 (m, 2H).
    “A75” 500 MHz; 9.71 (s, 1H), 8.85 (d, J = 17.3, 2H), 8.58 (d, J = 15.5,
    2H), 7.38 (d, J = 2.4, 1H), 7.27 (dd, J = 8.6, 2.4, 1H), 6.90 (d,
    J = 8.6, 1H), 4.38 (t, J = 6.5, 2H), 3.83 (s, 3H), 3.51 (t, J = 4.7,
    4H), 2.92 (s, 4H), 2.79 (t, J = 6.5, 2H), 2.48-2.39 (m, 8H),
    2.22 (s, 3H).
    “A76” 500 MHz; 9.78 (s, 1H), 8.86 (d, J = 13.8, 2H), 8.58 (d, J = 16.4,
    2H), 7.44 (d, J = 2.4, 1H), 7.29 (dd, J = 8.5, 2.4, 1H), 6.94 (d,
    J = 8.6, 1H), 4.28 (t, J = 7.3, 2H), 3.85 (s, 3H), 3.28-2.90 (m,
    8H), 2.67 (s, 3H), 1.77 (q, J = 7.0, 2H), 1.63-1.50 (m, 1H),
    0.94 (d, J = 6.6, 6H).
    “A77” 500 MHz; 9.74 (s, 1H), 8.94 (s, 1H), 8.84 (s, 1H), 8.61 (d,
    J = 6.6, 2H), 7.41 (d, J = 2.4, 1H), 7.28 (dd, J = 8.5, 2.4, 1H),
    6.91 (d, J = 8.6, 1H), 4.62-4.53 (m, 1H), 4.05-3.98 (m, 2H),
    3.84 (s, 3H), 3.53 (td, J = 11.7, 2.2, 2H), 2.99 (s, 4H), 2.81-
    2.53 (m, 4H), 2.38 (s, 3H), 2.14-2.07 (m, 2H), 2.07-1.96
    (m, 2H).
    “A78” 400 MHz; 9.97 (s, 1H), 8.85 (d, J = 11.32 Hz, 2H), 8.58 (d, J =
    22.92 Hz, 2H), 7.54 (s, 1H), 7.21 (s, 2H), 3.99 (s, 3H), 3.85 (s,
    3H), 3.55-3.49 (m, 6H), 2.41-2.29 (m ,4H).
    “A79” 400 MHz; 8.82 (d, J = 18.92 Hz, 2H), 8.59 (s, 1H), 8.51 (s,
    1H), 8.27 (s, 1H), 7.91 (d, J = 8.64 Hz, 1H), 6.67 (s, 1H), 6.57
    (d, J = 8.76 Hz, 1H), 3.99 (s, 3H), 3.84 (s, 3H), 3.16-3.05 (m,
    4H), 2.45-2.39 (m, 4H), 2.22 (s, 3H).
    “A80” 400 MHz; 9.84 (s, 1H), 8.66 (s, 1H), 8.81 (s, 1H), 8.58 (d, J =
    15.44 Hz, 2H), 7.42 (s, 1H), 7.21-7.14 (m, 2H), 6.57 (d, J =
    7.72 Hz, 1H), 4.00 (s, 3H), 3.76 (t, J = 4.84 Hz, 4H), 3.12 (t, J =
    4.72 Hz, 4H).
    “A81” 400 MHz; 9.90 (s, 1H), 9.22 (s, 1H), 8.85 (d, J = 12.76 Hz,
    2H), 8.62 (s, 1H), 8.54 (s, 1H), 7.63 (d, J = 2.16 Hz, 1H), 7.48
    (dd, J = 8.64, 2.36 Hz, 1H), 7.26 (d, J = 8.60 Hz, 1H), 4.00 (s,
    3H), 2.21 (s, 3H), 2.02 (s, 3H).
    “A82” 400 MHz; 9.90 (s, 1H), 9.10 (s, 1H), 8.85 (d, J = 13.40 Hz,
    2H), 8.62 (s, 1H), 8.53 (s, 1H), 7.62 (d, J = 1.84 Hz, 1H), 7.48
    (dd, J = 8.50, 2.20 Hz, 1H), 7.22 (d, J = 8.64 Hz, 1H), 4.00 (s,
    3H), 2.96 (d, J = 12.36 Hz, 2H), 2.49-2.40 (m, 2H), 2.18 (s,
    3H), 1.99-1.96 (m, 2H), 1.69 (d, J = 10.64 Hz, 2H), 1.56-1.46
    (m, 2H).
    “A83” 400 MHz; 9.91 (s, 1H), 9.18 (s, 1H), 8.87 (s, 1H), 8.84 (s, 1H),
    8.62 (s, 1H), 8.53 (s, 1H), 7.63 (d, J = 2.20 Hz, 1H), 7.49 (dd,
    J = 8.50, 2.32 Hz, 1H), 7.23 (d, J = 8.60 Hz, 1H), 4.01 (s, 3H),
    3.92-3.89 (m, 2H), 3.39-3.35 (m, 2H), 2.66-2.59 (m, 1H), 2.19
    (s, 3H), 1.71-1.65 (m, 4H).
    “A84” 400 MHz; 9.97 (s, 1H), 9.05 (s, 1H), 8.86 (d, J = 13.56 Hz,
    2H), 8.61 (s, 1H), 8.55 (s, 1H), 7.73 (d, J = 8.64 Hz, 1H), 7.61
    (d, J = 2.08 Hz, 1H), 7.16 (dd, J = 8.66, 2.12 Hz, 1H), 3.99 (s,
    3H), 3.89 (s, 3H), 3.30-3.10 (m, 2H), 2.83-2.68 (m, 3H), 1.89-
    1.86 (m, 2H), 1.76-1.70 (m, 2H).
    “A85” 400 MHz; 9.95 (s, 1H), 9.05 (s, 1H), 8.86 (d, J = 11.20 Hz,
    2H), 8.61 (s, 1H), 8.55 (s, 1H), 7.72 (d, J = 8.64 Hz, 1H), 7.60
    (d, J = 1.80 Hz, 1H), 7.14 (dd, J = 7.10, 2.08 Hz, 1H), 3.99 (s,
    3H), 3.89 (s, 3H), 2.04 (s, 3H).
    “A86” 400 MHz; 9.80 (d, J = 11.68 Hz, 2H), 9.00 (s, 1H), 8.24 (s,
    1H), 7.54-7.49 (m, 3H), 7.38 (t, J = 8.08 Hz, 1H), 7.06-7.03
    (m, 2H), 6.81 (d, J = 8.60 Hz, 1H), 3.74 (s, 3H), 2.95-2.80 (m,
    8H), 2.20 (s, 3H).
    “A87” 400 MHz; 10.12 (s, 1H), 9.75 (s, 1H), 8.92 (s, 1H), 8.26 (s,
    1H), 8.05 (d, J = 8.72 Hz, 2H), 7.53 (d, J = 2.32 Hz, 1H), 7.07
    (dd, J = 8.58, 2.44 Hz, 1H), 6.95 (d, J = 1.96 Hz, 2H), 6.83 (d,
    J = 8.60 Hz, 1H), 3.77 (s, 3H), 2.95-2.82 (m, 4H), 2.45-2.37
    (m, 4H), 2.20 (s, 3H).
    “A88” 400 MHz; 9.69 (s, 1H), 8.84 (s, 1H), 8.77 (s, 1H), 8.72 (s, 2H),
    8.59 (s, 1H), 8.50 (d, J = 0.36 Hz, 1H), 3.99 (s, 3H), 3.67 (t, J =
    5.08 Hz, 4H), 2.36 (t, J = 4.96 Hz, 4H), 2.21 (s, 3H).
    “A89” 400 MHz; δ 9.95 (s, 1H), 8.96 (s, 1H), 8.86 (d, J = 12.80 Hz,
    2H), 8.61 (s, 1H), 8.55 (s, 1H), 7.75 (d, J = 8.64 Hz, 1H), 7.60
    (d, J = 2.00 Hz, 1H), 7.16 (dd, J = 8.70, 2.12 Hz, 1H), 3.99 (s,
    3H), 3.89-3.88 (m, 5H), 3.40-3.36 (m, 1H), 3.33-3.30 (m, 1H),
    2.78-2.69 (m, 1H), 1.68-1.62 (m, 4H).
    “A90” 400 MHz, +TFA; 9.63 (s, 1H), 9.57 (s, 1H), 9.25-9.23 (m, 2H),
    9.07 (s, 1H), 8.35-8.25 (m, 1H), 7.53 (d, J = 8.96 Hz, 1H),
    4.65-4.52 (m, 2H), 4.47 (s, 3H), 4.20-4.10 (m, 2H), 4.09-4.03
    (m, 2H), 3.65-3.50 (m, 2H), 3.20 (s, 3H).
    “A91” 400 MHz; 9.76 (s, 1H), 8.90 (s, 1H), 8.30 (s, 1H), 8.11 (d, J =
    8.96 Hz, 2H), 7.57 (d, J = 2.36 Hz, 1H), 7.12 (d, J = 9.08 Hz,
    2H), 7.06 (dd, J = 8.56, 2.36 Hz, 1H), 6.83 (d, J = 8.60 Hz,
    1H), 3.78-3.76 (m, 7H), 3.28-3.26 (m, 4H), 2.95-2.83 (m, 4H),
    2.47-2.40 (m, 4H), 2.22 (s, 3H).
    “A92” 400 MHz; 9.79 (s, 1H), 8.96 (s, 1H), 8.29 (s, 1H), 8.14 (d, J =
    8.84 Hz, 2H), 7.54 (d, J = 2.16 Hz, 1H), 7.15 (d, J = 8.88 Hz,
    2H), 7.07 (dd, J = 8.58, 2.20 Hz, 1H), 6.83 (d, J = 8.60 Hz,
    1H), 3.86 (s, 3H), 3.77 (s, 3H), 3.41-3.38 (m, 4H), 2.98-2.80
    (m, 4H), 2.25 (s, 3H).
    “A93” 400 MHz; 10.22 (br s, 1H), 9.86 (s, 1H), 8.99 (s, 1H), 8.31 (s,
    1H), 8.16 (d, J = 8.68 Hz, 2H), 7.62 (d, J = 1.84 Hz, 1H), 7.39
    (d, J = 8.64 Hz, 2H), 7.04 (dd, J = 8.62, 2.00 Hz, 1H), 6.87 (d,
    J = 8.56 Hz, 1H), 3.78 (s, 3H), 3.11 (s, 3H), 3.10-2.90 (m, 6H),
    2.68-2.58 (m, 2H), 2.49 (s, 3H).
    “A94” 400 MHz; 9.83 (s, 1H), 9.07 (s, 1H), 8.39-8.34 (m, 3H), 7.97
    (dd, J = 6.78, 1.80 Hz, 2H), 7.69 (d, J = 4.92 Hz, 1H), 7.51 (d,
    J = 2.36 Hz, 1H), 7.04 (dd, J = 8.56, 2.36 Hz, 1H), 6.82 (d, J =
    8.60 Hz, 1H), 3.78 (s, 3H), 2.98-2.82 (m, 4H), 2.50-2.42 (m,
    7H), 2.19 (s, 3H).
    “A95” 400 MHz; 10.05 (br s, 1H), 9.85 (s, 1H), 9.04 (s, 1H), 8.26 (s,
    1H), 7.83 (d, J = 7.88 Hz, 2H), 7.56 (t, J = 7.92 Hz, 1H), 7.50
    (d, J = 2.24 Hz, 1H), 7.42-7.40 (m, 1H), 7.13 (dd, J = 8.56,
    2.20 Hz, 1H), 6.87 (d, J = 8.60 Hz, 1H), 3.75 (s, 3H), 3.12-
    3.07 (m, 11H), 2.71 (s, 3H).
    “A96” 400 MHz; 9.86 (s, 1H), 9.08 (s, 1H), 8.53 (s, 1H), 8.39-8.36
    (m, 2H), 7.98 (d, J = 8.20 Hz, 1H), 7.85 (t, J = 7.88 Hz, 1H),
    7.64-7.60 (m, 1H), 7.37 (d, J = 2.28 Hz, 1H), 7.24 (dd, J =
    8.56, 2.28 Hz, 1H), 6.87 (d, J = 8.60 Hz, 1H), 3.72 (s, 3H),
    3.25-2.95 (m, 8H), 2.70-2.60 (m, 3H), 2.46-2.45 (m, 3H).
  • Pharmacological Data
  • TABLE 2
    GCN2 inhibition of some representative
    compounds of the formula I
    IC50 IC50 IC50 IC50
    Com- GCN2 SYK Com- GCN2 SYK
    pound (enzyme (enzyme pound (enzyme (enzyme
    No. assay) assay) No. assay) assay)
    “A1” C −18@3 * “A26”
    “A2” A −29@3 “A27” B  −6@3
    “A3” B  −9@3 “A28” A  −2@3
    “A4” A A “A29” B
    “A5” B A “A30” A −33@3
    “A6” A B “A31” B A
    “A7” C B “A32” B −35@3
    “A8” B B “A33” B
    “A9” B B “A34” B B
    “A10” A B “A35” A A
    “A11” B B “A36” −4@10 B
    “A12” A “A37”  3@10 B
    “A13” A A “A38” A
    “A14” A B “A39” A
    “A15” A B “A40” A
    “A16” A  1.5@3 “A41” A
    “A17” A B “A42” A
    “A18” A  −5@3 “A43” A
    “A19” B “A44” C B
    “A20” B  1@3 “A45”  2@10 A
    “A21” B “A46” −8@10 B
    “A22” A −15@3 “A47” A A
    “A23” B “A48” A C
    “A24”  1@3 “A49” B −19@3
    “A25” B  −8@3 “A50” A −32@3
    “A51” A A “A61” A B
    “A52” B −32@3 “A62” A  −5@3
    “A53” B −23@3 “A63” B −30@3
    “A54” B “A64” A B
    “A55” A A “A65” A C
    “A56” B B “A66” A B
    “A57” B C “A67” A B
    “A58” A −34@3 “A68” A B
    “A59” A B “A69” A B
    “A60” B A “A70” A −12@0.3
    “A71” A B “A81” A B
    “A72” A C “A82” A B
    “A73” A B “A83” A C
    “A74” C  4@3 “A84” A C
    “A75” A −21@3 “A85” A B
    “A76” A B “A86” A A
    “A77” A B “A87” A A
    “A78” A B “A88” A −13@3
    “A79” C  −9@3 “A89” A C
    “A80” A −26@1 “A90” A
    “A91” A B
    “A92” A A
    “A93” A B
    “A94” A B
    “A95” A B
    “A96” B
    IC50: <1 μM = A
    1-5 μM = B
    5-10 μM = C
    * 18@3 means −18% at 3 μM
    100% corresponds to zero effect
    −50% corresponds to IC50
  • The compounds shown in Table 1 are particularly preferred compounds according to the invention.
  • The following examples relate to medicaments:
  • EXAMPLE A Injection Vials
  • A solution of 100 g of an active ingredient of the formula I and 5 g of disodium hydrogenphosphate in 3 l of bidistilled water is adjusted to pH 6.5 using 2 N hydrochloric acid, sterile filtered, transferred into injection vials, lyophilised under sterile conditions and sealed under sterile conditions. Each injection vial contains 5 mg of active ingredient.
  • EXAMPLE B Suppositories
  • A mixture of 20 g of an active ingredient of the formula I with 100 g of soya lecithin and 1400 g of cocoa butter is melted, poured into moulds and allowed to cool. Each suppository contains 20 mg of active ingredient.
  • EXAMPLE C Solution
  • A solution is prepared from 1 g of an active ingredient of the formula I, 9.38 g of NaH2PO4.2H2O, 28.48 g of Na2HPO4.12H2O and 0.1 g of benzalkonium chloride in 940 ml of bidistilled water. The pH is adjusted to 6.8, and the solution is made up to 1 I and sterilised by irradiation. This solution can be used in the form of eye drops.
  • EXAMPLE D Ointment
  • 500 mg of an active ingredient of the formula I are mixed with 99.5 g of Vaseline under aseptic conditions.
  • EXAMPLE E Tablets
  • A mixture of 1 kg of active ingredient of the formula I, 4 kg of lactose, 1.2 kg of potato starch, 0.2 kg of talc and 0.1 kg of magnesium stearate is pressed in a conventional manner to give tablets in such a way that each tablet contains 10 mg of active ingredient.
  • EXAMPLE F Dragees
  • Tablets are pressed analogously to Example E and subsequently coated in a conventional manner with a coating of sucrose, potato starch, talc, tragacanth and dye.
  • EXAMPLE G Capsules
  • 2 kg of active ingredient of the formula I are introduced into hard gelatine capsules in a conventional manner in such a way that each capsule contains 20 mg of the active ingredient.
  • EXAMPLE H Ampoules
  • A solution of 1 kg of active ingredient of the formula I in 60 l of bidistilled water is sterile filtered, transferred into ampoules, lyophilised under sterile conditions and sealed under sterile conditions. Each ampoule contains 10 mg of active ingredient.

Claims (13)

1. Compounds of the formula I
Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00139
in which
R1 denotes Ar, COHet or Het,
R2 denotes H, Ar1, NHHet or Het,
R3 denotes H or A′,
R4 denotes H, A, Ar1, Het, Hal, NHAr1 or CN,
Ar denotes phenyl or naphthyl which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, A, Cyc, [C(R3)2]pOA, [C(R3)2]pOH, CN, NHCOHet1, NHCOA, NHCO[C(R3)2]pCyc, CONH[C(R3)2]pCyc, [C(R3)2]pN(R3)2, [C(R3)2]pHet1, NR3SO2A, SO2N(R3)2, S(O)nA, COHet1, O[C(R3)2]mN(R3)2 and/or O[C(R3)2]pHet1,
Ar1 denotes phenyl which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, A, phenyl, CONH2, [C(R3)2]pOR3, [C(R3)2]pN(R3)2, [C(R3)2]p—CN, [C(R3)2]pHet1 and/or O[C(R3)2]pHet1,
Het denotes furyl, thienyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, thiazolyl, triazolyl, tetrazolyl, pyridyl, pyrimidyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazinyl, indolyl, isoindolyl, benzimidazolyl, indazolyl, quinolyl, 1,3-benzodioxolyl, benzothiophenyl, benzofuranyl, imidazopyridyl, dihydroindolyl, 2,3-dihydro-benzo[1,4]dioxinyl or furo[3,2-b]pyridyl which is unsubstituted or mono-, di- or trisubstituted by Hal, A, [C(R3)2]pOR3, [C(R3)2]p—N(R3)2, [C(R3)2]pHet1, NO2, CN, [C(R6)2]pCOOR3, CON(R3)2, NR3COA, NR3SO2A, SO2N(R3)2, S(O)nA, COHet1, O[C(R3)2]mN(R3)2, O[C(R3)2]pHet1 and/or ═O,
Het1
denotes dihydropyrrolyl, pyrrolidinyl, azetidinyl, oxetanyl, tetrahydroimidazolyl, dihydropyrazolyl, tetrahydropyrazolyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, dihydropyridyl, tetrahydropyridyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, hexahydropyridazinyl, hexahydropyrimidinyl, [1,3]dioxolanyl, tetrahydropyranyl, pyridyl or piperazinyl, which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, CN, OH, OA, COOA, CONH2, S(O)nA, S(O)nAr, COA, A and/or ═O,
A
denotes unbranched or branched alkyl with 1-10 C-atoms, wherein one or two non-adjacent CH- and/or CH2-groups may be replaced by N-, O- and/or S-atoms and wherein 1-7H-atoms may be replaced by F or Cl,
Cyc
denotes cyclic alkyl with 3-7 C-atoms, which is unsubstituted or monosubstituted by [C(R3)2]pOH or CN,
A′
denotes unbranched or branched alkyl with 1, 2, 3 or 4 C-atoms,
Hal
denotes F, Cl, Br or I,
n
denotes 0, 1 or 2,
m
denotes 1, 2 or 3,
p denotes 0, 1, 2, 3 or 4,
and pharmaceutically acceptable solvates, salts, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios.
2. Compounds according claim 1 in which
R1 denotes Ar, COHet or Het,
R2 denotes H, Ar1, NHHet or Het,
R3 denotes H or A′,
R4 denotes H, A, Ar1, Het, Hal, NHAr1 or CN,
Ar denotes phenyl which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, A, Cyc, [C(R3)2]pOA, [C(R3)2]pOH, CN, NHCOHet1, NHCOA, NHCO[C(R3)2]pCyc, CONH[C(R3)2]pCyc, [C(R3)2]pHet1, SO2N(R3)2, NR3SO2A, O[C(R3)2]pHet1, COHet1, and/or S(O)nA,
Ar1 denotes phenyl which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by Hal, A, phenyl, CONH2, [C(R3)2]pCN, [C(R3)2]pOR3 and/or [C(R3)2]pHet1,
Het denotes furyl, thienyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, thiazolyl, triazolyl, tetrazolyl, pyridyl, pyrimidyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazinyl, indolyl, isoindolyl, benzimidazolyl, indazolyl, quinolyl, 1,3-benzodioxolyl, benzothiophenyl, benzofuranyl, imidazopyridyl, dihydroindolyl, 2,3-dihydro-benzo[1,4]dioxinyl or furo[3,2-b]pyridyl which is unsubstituted or mono-, di- or trisubstituted by A, [C(R3)2]pHet1, [C(R3)2]pN(R3)2 and/or ═O,
Het1
denotes dihydropyrrolyl, pyrrolidinyl, azetidinyl, oxetanyl, tetrahydroimidazolyl, dihydropyrazolyl, tetrahydropyrazolyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, dihydropyridyl, tetrahydropyridyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, hexahydropyridazinyl, hexahydropyrimidinyl, [1,3]dioxolanyl, tetrahydropyranyl, pyridyl or piperazinyl, which is unsubstituted or mono- or disubstituted by A,
A
denotes unbranched or branched alkyl with 1-10 C-atoms, and wherein 1-7H-atoms may be replaced by F or Cl,
Cyc
denotes cyclic alkyl with 3-7 C-atoms, which is unsubstituted or monosubstituted by [C(R3)2]pOH or CN,
A′
denotes unbranched or branched alkyl with 1, 2, 3 or 4 C-atoms,
Hal
denotes F, Cl, Br or I,
n
denotes 0, 1 or 2,
p denotes 0, 1, 2, 3 or 4,
and pharmaceutically acceptable solvates, salts, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios.
3. Compounds according to claim 1, selected from the group
No. Name “A1” (4-methanesulfonyl-phenyl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A2” (3-methoxy-phenyl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A3” [5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]- pyridin-3-yl-amine “A4” [5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]- [3-methyl-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-amine “A5” 3,3-dimethyl-6-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5- a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one “A6” (2-dimethylaminomethyl-1H-benzoimidazol-5-yl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H- indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A7” 3-(5-quinolin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino)- benzenesulfonamide “A8” [3-methyl-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-(5-quinolin-3-yl- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-amine “A9” 3,3-dimethyl-6-(5-quinolin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2- ylamino)-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one “A10” (2-dimethylaminomethyl-1H-benzoimidazol-5-yl)-(5-quinolin-3-yl- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-amine “A11” (4-methanesulfonyl-phenyl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A12” [5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]- pyridin-3-yl-amine “A13” 3,3-dimethyl-6-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5- a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one “A14” (2-dimethylaminomethyl-1H-benzoimidazol-5-yl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H- pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A15” 5-[5-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2- ylamino]-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one “A16” [5-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]- pyridin-3-yl-amine “A17” [3-methyl-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-[5-(4-morpholin-4- yl-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A18” (6-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(4-methoxy-phenyl)- amine “A19” (6-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-fluoro-phenyl)- amine “A20” (6-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-pyridin-3-yl-amine “A21” (6-chloro-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(4-fluoro-phenyl)- amine “A22” (6-bromo-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-methoxy-phenyl)- amine “A23” (6-cyano-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-methoxy-phenyl)- amine “A24” (3-methoxy-phenyl)-(6-methyl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)- amine “A25” pyridin-3-yl-(6-pyridin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]- amine “A26” (3-methoxy-phenyl)-(6-o-tolyl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)- amine “A27” [5-(4-fluoro-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-pyridin-3- yl-amine “A28” (3-methoxy-phenyl)-(5-phenyl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)- amine “A29” N6-(4-fluoro-phenyl)-N2-pyridin-3-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5- a]pyrazine-2,6-diamine “A30” (3-methoxy-phenyl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A31” (4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-[5-(1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5- a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A32” Synthesis of (4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-(5-quinolin-3-yl- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-amine “A33” (4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-(5-quinolin-6-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5- a]pyrazin-2-yl)-amine “A34” 2-Methyl-2-{4-[2-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenylamino)- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl]-phenyl}-propionitrile “A35” [5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]- (4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine “A36” (5-biphenyl-2-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(4-morpholin-4- yl-phenyl)-amine “A37” (5-biphenyl-2-yl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl)-(3,5-dimethoxy- phenyl)-amine “A38” 5-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2- ylamino]-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one “A39” 3-[5-(1-methyl-1H-indazol-5-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2- ylamino]-benzenesulfonamide “A40” 2-methyl-2-(4-{2-[3-methyl-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)- phenylamino]-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl}-phenyl)- propionitrile “A41” 5-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2- ylamino]-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one “A42” 5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-N-(3-methyl-4-(4-methylpiperazin-1- yl)phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-amine “A43” N-(3-(2-((3-methyl-4-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl)phenyl)amino)- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl)phenyl)methanesulfonamide “A44” [6-methyl-5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5- a]pyrazin-2-yl]-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine “A45” [5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-6-phenyl-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5- a]pyrazin-2-yl]-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine “A46” [5,6-Bis-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin- 2-yl]-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine “A47” 1-{4-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2- ylamino]-phenyl}-cyclopropanecarbonitrile “A48” [4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-{5-[1-(2-morpholin-4-yl- ethyl)-1H-pyrazol-4-yl]-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl}-amine “A49” 5-{5-[1-(2-morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-1H-pyrazol-4-yl]- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino}-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one “A50” [3-methyl-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-{5-[1-(2-morpholin- 4-yl-ethyl)-1H-pyrazol-4-yl]-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl}- amine “A51” {5-[1-(3-methyl-butyl)-1H-pyrazol-4-yl]-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5- a]pyrazin-2-yl}-[3-methyl-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]- amine “A52” 1-methyl-5-{5-[1-(2-morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-1H-pyrazol-4-yl]- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino}-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one “A53” N2-[4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-N5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol- 4-yl)-[1,2,4] triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazine-2,5-diamine “A54” 3-{2-[3-methyl-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenylamino]- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl}-benzamide “A55” [5-(5-methyl-furan-2-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-(4- morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine “A56” {5-[1-(2-morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-1H-pyrazol-4-yl]-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5- a]pyrazin-2-yl}-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine “A57” 3-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2- ylamino]-benzonitrile “A58” 5-[5-(5-morpholin-4-ylmethyl-thiophen-2-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5- a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-1,3-dihydro-indol-2-one “A59” (2,3-dihydro-benzo[1,4]dioxin-6-yl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A60” [5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]- (4-pyridin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine “A61” [5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]- (4-morpholin-4-ylmethyl-phenyl)-amine “A62” [5-(5-morpholin-4-ylmethyl-thiophen-2-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5- a]pyrazin-2-yl]-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine “A63” 5-[2-(4-morpholin-4-yl-phenylamino)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin- 5-yl]-2-(tetrahydro-pyran-4-yloxy)-benzonitrile “A64” [5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]- (3-methyl-4-trifluoromethoxy-phenyl)-amine “A65” cyclobutanecarboxylic acid {2-methyl-4-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4- yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-phenyl}-amide “A66” {4-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2- ylamino]-phenyl}-morpholin-4-yl-methanone “A67” [3-methoxy-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-[5-(1-methyl-1H- pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A68” (3-methyl-4-morpholin-4-ylmethyl-phenyl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H- pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A69” N-cyclopropylmethyl-2-methyl-4-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-benzamide “A70” N-cyclopropylmethyl-2-methoxy-4-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-benzamide “A71” N-cyclopropyl-2-methyl-4-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-benzamide “A72” N-cyclopropyl-2-methoxy-4-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-benzamide “A73” {2-methyl-4-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5- a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-phenyl}-morpholin-4-yl-methanone “A74” piperidine-4-carboxylic acid [5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amide “A75” [3-methoxy-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-{5-[1-(2- morpholin-4-yl-ethyl)-1H-pyrazol-4-yl]-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5- a]pyrazin-2-yl}-amine “A76” [3-methoxy-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-{5-[1-(3-methyl- butyl)-1H-pyrazol-4-yl]-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl}-amine “A77” [3-methoxy-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-{5-[1-(tetrahydro- pyran-4-yl)-1H-pyrazol-4-yl]-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl}- amine “A78” (3-methoxy-4-morpholin-4-ylmethyl-phenyl)-[5-(1-methyl-1H- pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A79” [2-methoxy-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-[5-(1-methyl-1H- pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A80” [5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]- (3-morpholin-4-yl-phenyl)-amine “A81” N-{2-methyl-4-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5- a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-phenyl}-acetamide “A82” piperidine-4-carboxylic acid {2-methyl-4-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol- 4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-phenyl}-amide “A83” tetrahydro-pyran-4-carboxylic acid {2-methyl-4-[5-(1-methyl-1H- pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-phenyl}- amide “A84” piperidine-4-carboxylic acid {2-methoxy-4-[5-(1-methyl-1H- pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-phenyl}- amide “A85” N-{2-methoxy-4-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5- a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-phenyl}-acetamide “A86” 3-{2-[3-methoxy-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenylamino]- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl}-phenol “A87” 4-{2-[3-methoxy-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenylamino]- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl}-phenol “A88” [2-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-pyrimidin-5-yl]-[5-(1-methyl-1H- pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A89” tetrahydro-pyran-4-carboxylic acid {2-methoxy-4-[5-(1-methyl-1H- pyrazol-4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-ylamino]-phenyl}- amide “A90” [6-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-pyridin-3-yl]-[5-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol- 4-yl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A91” [3-methoxy-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-[5-(4-morpholin-4- yl-phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A92” [3-methoxy-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenyl]-[5-(4-methoxy- phenyl)-[1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-2-yl]-amine “A93” N-(4-{2-[3-methoxy-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenylamino]- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl}-phenyl)-methanesulfonamide “A94” 4-{2-[3-methoxy-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenylamino]- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl}-N-methyl-benzenesulfonamide “A95” N-(3-{2-[3-methoxy-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenylamino]- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl}-phenyl)-methanesulfonamide “A96” 3-{2-[3-methoxy-4-(4-methyl-piperazin-1-yl)-phenylamino]- [1,2,4]triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazin-5-yl}-N-methyl-benzenesulfonamide
and pharmaceutically acceptable solvates, salts, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios.
4. Process for the preparation of compounds of the formula I according to claim 1 and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, characterised in that
a compound of the formula II
Figure US20150051202A1-20150219-C00140
in which R2 and R4 have the meanings indicated in claim 1,
is reacted with a compound of the formula III

R1-L  III
in which R1 has the meaning indicated in claim 1 and
L denotes Cl or Br,
and/or
a base or acid of the formula I is converted into one of its salts.
5. A medicament composition comprising at least one compound of the formula I of claim 1 and/or pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, tautomers and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, and optionally an pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, excipient or vehicle.
6. A method for the treatment and/or prevention of inflammatory conditions, immunological conditions, autoimmune conditions, allergic conditions, rheumatic conditions, thrombotic conditions, cancer, infections, neurodegenerative diseases, neuroinflammatory diseases, cardiovascular diseases, and metabolic conditions, the method comprising administering to a subject in need thereof an effective amount of a compound of claim 1.
7. A method according to claim 6 for the treatment and/or prevention of cancer,
where the cancer to be treated is a solid tumour or a tumour of the blood and immune system.
8. A method according to claim 7, where the solid tumour originates from the group of tumours of the epithelium, the bladder, the stomach, the kidneys, of head and neck, the esophagus, the cervix, the thyroid, the intestine, the liver, the brain, the prostate, the uro-genital tract, the lymphatic system, the stomach, the larynx, the bones, including chondosarcoma and Ewing sarcoma, germ cells, including embryonal tissue tumours, and/or the lung, from the group of monocytic leukaemia, lung adenocarcinoma, small-cell lung carcinomas, pancreatic cancer, glioblastomas, neurofibroma, angiosarcoma, breast carcinoma and/or maligna melanoma.
9. A method according to claim 6 for the treatment and/or prevention of diseases selected from the group rheumatoid arthritis, systemic lupus, asthma, multiple sclerosis, osteoarthritis, ischemic injury, giant cell arteritis, inflammatory bowel disease, diabetes, cystic fibrosis, psoriasis, Sjögrens syndrome and transplant organ rejection.
10. A method according to claim 6 for the treatment and/or prevention of diseases selected from the group Alzheimer's disease, Down's syndrome, hereditary cerebral hemorrhage with amyloidosis-Dutch Type, cerebral amyloid angiopathy, Creutzfeldt-Jakob disease, frontotemporal dementias, Huntington's disease, Parkinson's disease.
11. A method according to claim 6 for the treatment and/or prevention of diseases selected from the group leishmania, mycobacteria, including M. leprae, M. tuberculosis and/or M. avium, leishmania, plasmodium, human immunodeficiency virus, Epstein Barr virus, Herpes simplex virus, hepatitis C virus.
12. A medicament composition comprising at least one compound of the formula I of claim 1 and/or pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios, and at least one further medicament active ingredient.
13. Set (kit) consisting of separate packs of
(a) an effective amount of a compound of the formula I of claim 1 and/or pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, salts and stereoisomers thereof, including mixtures thereof in all ratios,
and
(b) an effective amount of a further medicament active ingredient.
US14/382,678 2012-03-07 2013-02-14 Triazolopyrazine derivatives Abandoned US20150051202A1 (en)

Applications Claiming Priority (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
EP12001568 2012-03-07
EP12001568.0 2012-03-07
PCT/EP2013/000440 WO2013131609A1 (en) 2012-03-07 2013-02-14 Triazolopyrazine derivatives

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20150051202A1 true US20150051202A1 (en) 2015-02-19

Family

ID=47715983

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US14/382,678 Abandoned US20150051202A1 (en) 2012-03-07 2013-02-14 Triazolopyrazine derivatives

Country Status (12)

Country Link
US (1) US20150051202A1 (en)
EP (1) EP2822948B1 (en)
JP (1) JP6049768B2 (en)
CN (1) CN104159901B (en)
AR (1) AR090240A1 (en)
AU (1) AU2013230286B2 (en)
CA (1) CA2866450C (en)
ES (1) ES2579981T3 (en)
HK (1) HK1203948A1 (en)
IL (1) IL234466A (en)
TW (1) TW201341384A (en)
WO (1) WO2013131609A1 (en)

Cited By (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2018119440A1 (en) 2016-12-22 2018-06-28 Calithera Biosciences, Inc. Compositions and methods for inhibiting arginase activity
EP3498693A4 (en) * 2016-08-10 2020-01-01 Takeda Pharmaceutical Company Limited Heterocyclic compound
US11945799B2 (en) 2020-06-09 2024-04-02 Ip2Ipo Innovations Limited 4-ethynylpyridine derivatives useful as GCN2 inhibitors

Families Citing this family (19)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
BR112015030774A2 (en) * 2013-06-10 2017-07-25 Bayer Pharma AG new compounds for cancer treatment
MA39186A1 (en) * 2013-12-19 2017-11-30 Novartis Ag Derivatives of [1,2,4] triazolo [1,5-a] pyrimidine used as protozoan proteasome inhibitors for the treatment of parasitic diseases such as leishmaniasis
ES2750956T3 (en) 2014-02-13 2020-03-30 Incyte Corp Cyclopropylamines as LSD1 inhibitors
SG11201606689VA (en) 2014-02-13 2016-09-29 Incyte Corp Cyclopropylamines as lsd1 inhibitors
EP3392244A1 (en) 2014-02-13 2018-10-24 Incyte Corporation Cyclopropylamines as lsd1 inhibitors
US9527835B2 (en) 2014-02-13 2016-12-27 Incyte Corporation Cyclopropylamines as LSD1 inhibitors
US9695180B2 (en) 2014-07-10 2017-07-04 Incyte Corporation Substituted imidazo[1,2-a]pyrazines as LSD1 inhibitors
US9695167B2 (en) 2014-07-10 2017-07-04 Incyte Corporation Substituted triazolo[1,5-a]pyridines and triazolo[1,5-a]pyrazines as LSD1 inhibitors
WO2016007731A1 (en) 2014-07-10 2016-01-14 Incyte Corporation Imidazopyridines and imidazopyrazines as lsd1 inhibitors
WO2016007727A1 (en) 2014-07-10 2016-01-14 Incyte Corporation Triazolopyridines and triazolopyrazines as lsd1 inhibitors
US10590086B2 (en) * 2014-11-03 2020-03-17 Iomet Pharma Ltd. Pharmaceutical compound
NZ735998A (en) 2015-04-03 2024-08-30 Incyte Holdings Corp Heterocyclic compounds as lsd1 inhibitors
NZ740186A (en) 2015-08-12 2024-07-05 Incyte Holdings Corp Salts of an lsd1 inhibitor
AR109452A1 (en) 2016-04-22 2018-12-12 Incyte Corp PHARMACEUTICAL FORMULATION OF AN LSD1 INHIBITOR AND TREATMENT METHOD
IL312674A (en) 2018-01-29 2024-07-01 Merck Patent Gmbh Gcn2 inhibitors and uses thereof
AU2019211485A1 (en) 2018-01-29 2020-08-06 Merck Patent Gmbh GCN2 inhibitors and uses thereof
CN113166153B (en) * 2018-07-05 2024-11-01 因赛特公司 Fused pyrazine derivatives as A2A/A2B inhibitors
US10968200B2 (en) 2018-08-31 2021-04-06 Incyte Corporation Salts of an LSD1 inhibitor and processes for preparing the same
CN115819425A (en) * 2022-12-22 2023-03-21 五邑大学 Triazolo hexa-nitrogen heterocyclic-2-amine compound and preparation method and application thereof

Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20110190269A1 (en) * 2010-02-01 2011-08-04 Karlheinz Baumann Gamma secretase modulators

Family Cites Families (18)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
GB9624482D0 (en) 1995-12-18 1997-01-15 Zeneca Phaema S A Chemical compounds
ES2194181T3 (en) 1996-02-13 2003-11-16 Astrazeneca Ab DERIVATIVES OF QUINAZOLINE AS VEGF INHIBITORS.
DK0885198T3 (en) 1996-03-05 2002-03-25 Astrazeneca Ab 4-anilinoquinazoline derivatives
GB9718972D0 (en) 1996-09-25 1997-11-12 Zeneca Ltd Chemical compounds
GB9714249D0 (en) 1997-07-08 1997-09-10 Angiogene Pharm Ltd Vascular damaging agents
GB9900334D0 (en) 1999-01-07 1999-02-24 Angiogene Pharm Ltd Tricylic vascular damaging agents
GB9900752D0 (en) 1999-01-15 1999-03-03 Angiogene Pharm Ltd Benzimidazole vascular damaging agents
US7030123B2 (en) 2000-05-31 2006-04-18 Astrazeneca Ab Indole derivatives with vascular damaging activity
AU6623201A (en) 2000-07-07 2002-02-05 Angiogene Pharm Ltd Colchinol derivatives as angiogenesis inhibitors
JP2004502766A (en) 2000-07-07 2004-01-29 アンギオジェン・ファーマシューティカルズ・リミテッド Colhinol derivatives as vascular damaging agents
DE602004008303T2 (en) 2003-07-16 2008-05-08 Janssen Pharmaceutica N.V. TRIAZOLOPYRIMIDIN DERIVATIVES AS INHIBITORS OF GLYCOGENSYNTHASEKINASE-3
CN101022799A (en) 2004-07-19 2007-08-22 约翰·霍普金斯大学 FLT3 inhibitors for immune suppression
CN101103035A (en) 2005-01-14 2008-01-09 詹森药业有限公司 Triazolopyrimidine derivatives as glycogen synthase kinase 3 inhibitors
CN101454326A (en) * 2006-05-31 2009-06-10 加拉帕戈斯股份有限公司 Triazolopyrazine compounds useful for the treatment of degenerative & inflammatory diseases
TWI453207B (en) * 2008-09-08 2014-09-21 Signal Pharm Llc Aminotriazolopyridines, compositions thereof, and methods of treatment therewith
CN102459258B (en) * 2009-06-05 2015-11-25 赛福伦公司 The preparation of 1,2,4-triazolo [1,5a] pyridine derivate and purposes
ES2512840T3 (en) * 2010-01-15 2014-10-24 Janssen Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Novel substituted bicyclic triazole derivatives as gamma-secretase modulators
JP5951610B2 (en) * 2010-08-27 2016-07-13 メルク パテント ゲゼルシャフト ミット ベシュレンクテル ハフツングMerck Patent Gesellschaft mit beschraenkter Haftung Triazolopyrazine derivatives

Patent Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20110190269A1 (en) * 2010-02-01 2011-08-04 Karlheinz Baumann Gamma secretase modulators

Cited By (5)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
EP3498693A4 (en) * 2016-08-10 2020-01-01 Takeda Pharmaceutical Company Limited Heterocyclic compound
US10696651B2 (en) 2016-08-10 2020-06-30 Takeda Pharmaceutical Company Limited Heterocyclic compound
WO2018119440A1 (en) 2016-12-22 2018-06-28 Calithera Biosciences, Inc. Compositions and methods for inhibiting arginase activity
EP3842442A1 (en) 2016-12-22 2021-06-30 Calithera Biosciences, Inc. Compositions and methods for inhibiting arginase activity
US11945799B2 (en) 2020-06-09 2024-04-02 Ip2Ipo Innovations Limited 4-ethynylpyridine derivatives useful as GCN2 inhibitors

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
TW201341384A (en) 2013-10-16
WO2013131609A1 (en) 2013-09-12
AU2013230286A1 (en) 2014-10-16
CN104159901B (en) 2016-10-26
ES2579981T3 (en) 2016-08-18
HK1203948A1 (en) 2015-11-06
CN104159901A (en) 2014-11-19
AU2013230286B2 (en) 2016-12-22
IL234466A (en) 2016-09-29
CA2866450A1 (en) 2013-09-12
EP2822948A1 (en) 2015-01-14
EP2822948B1 (en) 2016-04-06
CA2866450C (en) 2020-02-18
AR090240A1 (en) 2014-10-29
JP6049768B2 (en) 2016-12-21
JP2015509512A (en) 2015-03-30

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
EP2822948B1 (en) Triazolopyrazine derivatives
US9725462B2 (en) Pyridopyrimidine derivatives as protein kinase inhibitors
EP2994471B1 (en) Macrocycles as kinase inhibitors
CA2903903C (en) Triazolo[4,5-d]pyrimidine derivatives for the treatment of diseases such as cancer
EP2817313B1 (en) Furopyridine derivatives
US9409914B2 (en) Triazolo[4,5-d]pyrimidine derivatives
US9073944B2 (en) Cyclic diaminopyrimidine derivatives

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AS Assignment

Owner name: MERCK PATENT GMBH, GERMANY

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:SCHIEMANN, KAI;DEUTSCH, CARL;HOELZEMANN, GUENTER;AND OTHERS;SIGNING DATES FROM 20140512 TO 20140710;REEL/FRAME:033660/0815

STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION